0% found this document useful (0 votes)
103 views

06B STD Specifications CE 2021

The document outlines standard specifications for civil engineering works. It contains sections covering general specifications, materials and construction, roads and drains, sewers, earthworks, and appendices. The specifications provide requirements and guidelines for civil engineering construction projects.

Uploaded by

Lai Kok Uei
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
103 views

06B STD Specifications CE 2021

The document outlines standard specifications for civil engineering works. It contains sections covering general specifications, materials and construction, roads and drains, sewers, earthworks, and appendices. The specifications provide requirements and guidelines for civil engineering construction projects.

Uploaded by

Lai Kok Uei
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 183

STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS

FOR

CIVIL ENGINEERING WORKS

(2021 EDITION)
Published by Housing & Development Board, Republic of Singapore. No part of this document may be reproduced
or copied in any form or by any means without the prior written permission of the publisher.
STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS FOR CIVIL ENGINEERING WORKS

CONTENTS

Page

SECTION 1 GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS 1-1

TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS

SECTION 2 MATERIALS, WORKMANSHIP AND CONSTRUCTION IN GENERAL 2-1

SECTION 3 CONSTRUCTION AND WORKMANSHIP FOR ROADS AND DRAINS 3-1

SECTION 4 CONSTRUCTION AND WORKMANSHIP FOR SEWERS 4-1

SECTION 5 CONSTRUCTION AND WORKMANSHIP FOR EARTHWORKS 5-1

SECTION 6 LIST OF APPENDICES 6-1

SUMMARY OF UPDATES TO STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS FOR CIVIL ENGINEERING WORKS


(2021 EDITION)

The contents of this index on this page shall not be deemed to be part of the Specifications or be taken into consideration
in the interpretation or construction thereof or of the Contract.

HDB, being a ISO 14001 certified organisation, is committed to be the leader in environment management. The details of HDB's
environmental policy can be found in the Corporate Philosophy at HDB Website http://www.hdb.gov.sg
SECTION 1 : GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS

CONTENTS

Page

1.1 GENERAL
1.1.1 Definitions, Abbreviations and Interpretations 1-1
1.1.2 Payment of Employer's Bills, Expenses, Etc 1-2
1.1.3 Compliance with Technical Guidelines For Fire Safety In Temporary 1-2
Buildings In Construction Worksites
1.1.4 Stamp Duties 1-2
1.1.5 Contract Payment by GIRO/EPS 1-3
1.1.6 Goods & Services Tax 1-3
1.1.7 Provisional Sums 1-3
1.1.8 Prime Cost Sums 1-3
1.1.9 Reserved 1-4
1.1.10 Bribery 1-4
1.1.11 Overclaim Leading to Overpayment 1-4
1.1.12 Work Methods 1-4
1.1.13 Office For Use By SO Rep 1-4
1.1.14 Precautionary Measures To Be Taken During A Disease Pandemic 1-5
1.1.15 Temporary Sanitary Facilities 1-5
1.1.16 Working Area, Position, Lines etc 1-6
1.1.17 TOL Fee for Land Outside Contract Boundary 1-6
1.1.18 Liaison with Town Council on Use of Common Property for Site Office 1-7
and/or Store
1.1.19 Assignment of Copyright of Photographs, Etc. 1-8
1.1.20 Clearance Of Site, Turf And Topsoil 1-8
1.1.21 Preservation of Existing Trees During Construction & Development 1-8
1.1.22 Research Work 1-9
1.1.23 Site Management 1-10
1.1.24 Reserved 1-10
1.1.25 Signboards 1-10
1.1.26 Air Pollution Control 1-10
1.1.27 Provision Of Bins For Waste And Debris 1-10
1.1.28 Periodic Cleaning Up 1-11
1.1.29 Pest Control and Surveillance 1-11
1.1.30 Temporary Services 1-11
1.1.31 Care of the Works and Materials 1-11
1.1.32 Fencing and Lighting 1-11

The contents of this index on this page shall not be deemed to be part of the Specifications or be taken into consideration
in the interpretation or construction thereof or of the Contract.
SECTION 1 : GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
CONTENTS

Page

1.1.33 Cables/Services Detection 1-12


1.1.34 Damage to Public/Private Property 1-12
1.1.35 Cleaning and Maintenance of Roads and Drains 1-13
1.1.36 Access Roads and Protective Crossings 1-13
1.1.37 Demolition and Making Good 1-13
1.1.38 Breaking Up Of Existing Work 1-14
1.1.39 Excavation Of Service Trenches And Storage of Cable Ducts 1-14
1.1.40 Reinstatement of Service Trenches 1-14
1.1.41 Dumping of Debris and Rubbish 1-15
1.1.42 Inspection of Works Prior to Certified Completion 1-15
1.1.43 Cleaning Upon Substantial Completion 1-16
1.1.44 Rectification of Defect During Defects Liability Period 1-16
1.1.45 Noise Nuisance 1-16
1.1.46 Recovery of Legal Costs For Court Proceedings 1-16
1.1.47 Machinery Boundary 1-16
1.1.48 Compliance with Covid-Safe Restart Criteria 1-17
1.1.49 Work Site Computer Equipment 1-17
1.1.50 Extension of Time 1-21
1.1.51 Assessment of Extension of Time Due To Exceptionally Inclement Weather 1-21
1.1.52 Insurance Policies 1-22
1.1.53 Contract Documents On Site 1-24
1.1.54 Lightning Protection To Temporary Structures And Metal Structures 1-24
1.1.55 Environmental Public Health Measures 1-24
1.1.56 Trade Subcontractors 1-25
1.1.57 Work On MRT Reserve Area 1-25
1.1.58 Stationery For Resident Technical Officer 1-26
1.1.59 Earth Control Measures 1-27
1.1.60 Electronic Submission For Progress Payments Claims And Request
For Variation Works 1-30
1.1.61 Land Survey Services For CE Works 1-31
1.1.62 Disposal of artificial obstructions and/or Unexploded Explosive Ordnance (UXO) 1-34
1.1.63 Deployment of Portable Traffic Light System for Shared Right of Way 1-34
1.1.64 Prohibition of Dogs in Construction Sites / Working Areas / TOL Sites 1-35
1.1.65 Deployment of Auxiliary Police Officers (APO) 1-35

1.2 MATERIALS - GENERAL


1.2.1 Metric Components 1-36
1.2.2 Materials And Workmanship 1-36
1.2.3 Approval Of Samples and Trade Names 1-36
1.2.4 Samples 1-38
1.2.5 Precautions Against Materials Being Taken Out of Site 1-38
1.2.6 Approval For Use of Ready Mixed Concrete 1-38

The contents of this index on this page shall not be deemed to be part of the Specifications or be taken into consideration
in the interpretation or construction thereof or of the Contract.
SECTION 1 : GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS

CONTENTS

Page

1.3 LABOUR
1.3.1 Labour Laws 1-39
1.3.2 Keeping Records of Workmen 1-39
1.3.3 Employment of Illegal Immigrants 1-39
1.3.4 Employment of Civil Engineers 1-39

1.4 CONSTRUCTION EQUIPMENT


1.4.1 Maintenance Of Construction Equipment 1-42
1.4.2 Contractor's Construction Equipment 1-42
1.4.3 Movement of Construction Equipment 1-43
1.4.4 Age Limit for Mobile Crane 1-43

1.5 SAFETY
1.5.1 Site Safety Measures 1-44
1.5.2 Safety Infringement 1-54
1.5.3 Reporting Of Accidents and Dangerous Occurrence 1-54
1.5.4 Approved Construction Equipment 1-55
1.5.5 Gas Cylinders and Related Equipment 1-55
1.5.6 Erection of Temporary Structures 1-55
1.5.7 Submission of Proposal and Certificate of Supervision 1-55
1.5.8 Excavation 1-56
1.5.9 Storage of Diesel, Oil and Chemical 1-56
1.5.10 Provision of Equipment, Apparatus, Devices, Etc 1-56

1.6 NUISANCE AND IRREGULARITIES


1.6.1 Nuisance And Irregularities 1-58

1.7 IMPLEMENTATION OF EUROCODES (SS EN / BS EN) 1-59

The contents of this index on this page shall not be deemed to be part of the Specifications or be taken into consideration
in the interpretation or construction thereof or of the Contract.
GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS
CE Spec
Page 1-1

HOUSING & DEVELOPMENT BOARD

SECTION 1 : GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS

1.1 GENERAL

1.1.1 Definitions, Abbreviations And Interpretations

In the Specifications, the following words and expressions shall have the meanings hereby assigned to
them except where the context otherwise requires :

"SO Rep" shall mean Superintending Officer's Representative.

"as approved" shall mean as approved by the Superintending Officer's Representative.

"as directed" shall mean as directed by the Superintending Officer's Representative.

"or other approved" shall mean as approved by the Superintending Officer's Representative and
as further defined in subclause 1.2.3 "Approval Of Samples And Trade
Names".

"as required" or shall mean as required or as shown or as indicated or as specified in


"as shown" or the Drawings and/or Specifications.
"as indicated" or
"as specified"

The following abbreviations are used in the Specifications :

ASTM = American Society for Testing and Material


BS = British Standard
BCA = Building and Construction Authority
BCD = Building Control Division
cm = centimetre
cm2 or cm2 = square centimetre
cm3 or cm3 = cubic centimetre
CP = Code of Practice
DIN = Deutche Industrie - Normen
ENV = Ministry of the Environment
FSSD = Fire Safety and Shelter Department
g = gram
HDB = Housing & Development Board
IDA = Info-communications Development Authority of Singapore
ISO = International Organization for Standardization
kg = Kilogram
KN or kN = Kilonewton
LTA = Land Transport Authority
m = metre
m2 or m2 = square metre
m3 or m3 = cubic metre
mm2 or mm2 = square millimetre
mm3 or mm3 = cubic millimetre
Max or max = maximum
MOM = Ministry of Manpower
MRT = Mass Rapid Transit
N = newton
No. or no. = number
NEA = National Environment Agency
NParks = National Parks Board
Min or min = minimum
PE = Professional Engineer registered under the Professional Engineers Board,
Singapore

CE21/S1.DOC(1)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-2

1.1.1 Definitions, Abbreviations And Interpretations (Cont'd)

PowerGrid or Grid = Powergrid Ltd


PUB = Public Utilities Board
PTL = Public Telecommunications Licensees
RC or rc = Reinforced Concrete
SPRING Singapore = Standards, Productivity & Innovation Board
SAC = Singapore Accreditation Council
SLA = Singapore Land Authority
SINGLAS = Singapore Laboratory Accreditation Scheme
SPSL = SP Services Ltd
SS = Singapore Standard
ºC = degree Celsius
% = percent
+ = plus or minus
≤ = less than or equal
≥ = greater than or equal
< = less than
> = greater than
v/v = measured by volume
w/w = measured by weight
µm = micrometre

Words importing the singular also include the plural and vice versa where the context requires.

The clause headings in the Specifications shall not be deemed to be part thereof or be taken into
consideration in the interpretation or construction thereof or of the Contract.

All clauses in the Specifications shall be deemed to be directed at the Contractor unless expressly
specified otherwise and the Contractor shall perform and/or comply with such instructions, directions,
requirements and obligations specified in the Specifications and required under the Contract.

All Acts of Parliament, statutes, regulations, bye-laws, orders, local and foreign standards and codes of
practice specified shall be deemed to refer to the latest and shall be deemed to include any
amendments, and/or modifications and/or additions and/or re-enactments thereto.

1.1.2 Payment Of Employer's Bills, Expenses, Etc

The Contractor shall duly and punctually pay to the Employer the billed and any other expenses incurred
by the Employer in respect of the supply of materials, services, etc.

The Contractor shall pay to the Employer interest at the rate of 7.5% per annum or such other rate as
may be determined from time to time by the Employer in respect of any arrears of payment or other
outstanding sums due and payable to the Employer, from the due dates until payment in full is received
by the Employer.

The Employer reserves the right to set off such bills and expenses against monies due or becoming
due to the Contractor before payment of the balance, if any to the Contractor. In this respect, all
Employer's bills and other expenses due from the Contractor shall have priority over debts due to third
parties.

1.1.3 Compliance With The Technical Guidelines For Fire Safety In Temporary Buildings In Construction
Worksites

The Contractor shall comply with the Technical Guidelines for Fire Safety in Temporary Buildings in
Construction Worksites, including any amendment thereto, issued by the FSSD, Singapore Civil
Defence Force. In this connection, the Contractor's PE shall endorse on the plans for all temporary
buildings to certify compliance with the said FSSD Guidelines.

1.1.4 Stamp Duties

The Contractor shall have all documents required by or arising out of or in connection with this Contract
properly stamped to comply with the Stamp Duties Act. The costs and expense arising out of this
obligation, including all stamp duties required, shall be borne by the Contractor and shall be deemed to
have been allowed for in the Contract Sum.

CE21/S1.DOC(2)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-3

1.1.5 Contract Payment By GIRO/EPS

All payments under the Contract by the Employer to the Contractor shall be effected through the Inter-
bank GIRO System and/or other Electronic Payment Systems.

The Contractor shall submit all the necessary forms, such as Inter-bank GIRO (IBG) form, etc., duly
completed and signed, to the Finance Department, HDB, HDB Hub, 480 Lorong 6 Toa Payoh,
Singapore 310480; within fourteen days from the date of the Letter of Acceptance to effect payments
through such Systems.

In the event the payment arrangement through such Systems terminates for whatever reasons, the
Contractor shall re-submit all the necessary forms to the Finance Department within 14 days from the
date of the termination.

The preceding requirements shall not be applicable to payments by the Employer to the Contractor in
approved foreign currencies, where required under the Contract.

1.1.6 Goods & Services Tax

The Contractor shall not include in the rates and prices quoted in the Contract Sum, the GST chargeable
for the supply of goods, services or works required in the Contract. All rates and prices quoted shall be
exclusive of the GST.

The Employer shall reimburse the Contractor any GST charged on the goods, services or works
supplied.

The Contractor shall declare his GST status in his Tender. The Contractor shall clearly indicate whether
he is, or whether he will be a taxable person under the GST Act. The Contractor shall, if available,
furnish the GST registration number to the Employer.

The Contractor will be deemed to be a taxable person if no declaration to the contrary is made in the
Form of Tender. The Contractor who declares himself to be a non-taxable person under the GST Act
but who becomes a taxable person after he has been awarded the Contract shall forthwith inform the
Employer of his change in GST status. The Contractor shall be entitled to reimbursement by the
Employer of any GST charged on the goods, services or works he supplies after his change in GST
status.

1.1.7 Provisional Sums

Where Provisional Sum Items are included in the Contract, they shall be inclusive of all costs necessary
in carrying out or supplying the work, materials or goods. These Provisional Sum Items shall be inclusive
of the Contractor's profit and overheads but shall be net of trade and cash discounts.

1.1.8 Prime Cost Sums

Where Prime Costs Sums (P.C. Sums) are provided for any work, materials or goods, these sums shall
be inclusive of carriage but exclusive of the Contractor's profit and attendance. These P.C. Sums shall
also be net of trade and cash discounts.

Allow and separately price for profit and attendance in respect of such P.C. Sums in the Form of Tender.

P.C. Sums shall be deducted from the Contract Sum and in lieu thereof shall be added the sums due
to the Contractor for the said work, materials or goods. The sum allowed by the Contractor in the
Contract for attendance in respect of any P.C. Sums shall be fixed regardless of whether the actual
sum expended is greater or less than the P.C. Sums. In respect of profit, the amount to be paid shall
be the percentage quoted against the actual sum expended in relation to the P.C. Sums.

Should the work, materials or goods for which a P.C. Sums is provided in the Contract be not required,
or if the Employer chooses to carry out or supply the aforesaid work, materials or goods by his own
workmen or by other contractors, which the Employer is contractually entitled so to choose, then such
P.C. Sums together with the profit and attendance allowed by the Contractor in the Contract shall be
deducted in full from the Contract Sum.

Should the Contractor himself be engaged or instructed to carry out or supply any work, materials or
goods under a P.C. Sums, the profit and attendance allowed by the Contractor in the Contract in respect
of the P.C. Sums shall be deducted in full from the Contract Sum. In such event, the amount to be paid
for the work, materials or goods shall be inclusive of the Contractor's overheads and profit for the work,
materials and goods.

CE21/S1.DOC(3)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-4

1.1.9 Reserved

1.1.10 Bribery

During the currency of this Contract, the Contractor and his authorized agents or representatives shall
not offer or attempt to offer any bribes, commission or gift to the Employer's employees. Should it be
discovered that bribes, commission or gift have been given to any of the Employer's employees, the
employment of the Contractor under this Contract may be terminated. The decision of the
Superintending Officer with regard to the interpretation and implementation of this subclause shall be
final and binding on and conclusive against the Contractor.

1.1.11 Overclaim Leading To Overpayment

If at any time during the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are
imposed under the Contract, the Contractor is found to have over-claimed and was paid for more than
the value of the Permanent Works carried out and/or approved unfixed materials at the Site, the SO
Rep shall be empowered to deduct from the Contractor's subsequent payments the sum overpaid
together with the Employer's charges, and interest calculated at 7.5% per annum

1.1.12 Work Methods

Submit to the SO Rep for his approval the work methods of the trades as required by the SO Rep to
ensure good workmanship. A marking system, where applicable showing inter alia, the control, grid
and level reference lines shall be included in the work methods.

The Contractor shall ensure that sub-contractors engaged comply with the work methods approved by
the SO Rep.

Should it appear to the SO Rep at any time that the work methods proposed will not ensure good
workmanship in the Works, the SO Rep may require the Contractor to make at his own cost and
expense such modifications to the original work methods as the SO Rep may consider necessary or
appropriate.

Use or employ only workers who are skilled and capable of executing the Works in accordance with the
work methods approved.

Approval by the SO Rep of the Contractor's work methods, revised work methods or any details and
information provided under this subclause shall not in any way affect, relieve or vary the Contractor's
liabilities or obligations under the Contract.

1.1.13 Office For Use By SO Rep

A separate air-conditioned modular container site office, separate from the Contractor's site office, of at
least 18 square metres with two tables of at least 1.5 m length and four chairs, a steel cabinet, a fire
extinguisher of minimum 5A Rating, a white board of minimum 600mm x 900mm size and soft boards
covering the entire office walls shall be provided for the use of the SO Rep. The modular container site
office shall be submitted for approval by the SO Rep. The design of the office shall comply with the
Technical Guidelines For The Fire Safety In Temporary Buildings In Construction Sites, including any
amendment thereto, issued by FSSD and the Building Control (Temporary Buildings) Regulations
including any latest requirements by BCA.

The following shall also be included in the site office :

(i) False ceiling with concealed lightings (min 8 no. 40w fluorescent lighting).

(ii) Power points : min 1 no. 15 amp for air conditioner, 2 no. 13 amp socket and 2 no. light switches.

(iii) Lightning protection system complying with latest edition of Singapore Standards SS 555 and/or
any latest requirements by the BCA.

CE21/S1.DOC(4)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-5

1.1.13 Office For Use By SO Rep (Cont’d)

One telephone with call transfer facility shall be provided during the Time for Completion and any time
period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract. If the Contractor fails to provide the
telephone, the SO Rep will make the arrangement and all costs and expenses shall be deducted from
payment due or becoming due to the Contractor.

Install a First Aid Kit and other safety appliances as directed. The First Aid Kit shall be adequately
stocked with medicine for first aid at the site office.

Provide "No Smoking" Stickers, ear plugs and a rubber stamp indicating particulars of the Contract for
site use.

The Contractor shall allow for the maintenance of the site office and all the facilities, furniture and fittings
therein in a clean and good working condition to the satisfaction of SO Rep. The Contractor shall pay
all charges for the provision and use of the telephone and electricity at the site offices during the Time
for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract. The
Contractor shall be responsible for making arrangement and to obtain the approvals from the relevant
authorities for the erection of site office and the related temporary facilities. Temporary Occupation
Licence, fees, rental charges and all related costs in connection with the above shall be borne by the
Contractor.

1.1.14 Precautionary Measures To Be Taken During A Disease Pandemic

The contractor shall be required to implement necessary precautionary measures as advised by the
Ministry of Health or other relevant Authorities during a disease pandemic. Based on the
recommendations from the government's advisory, the contractor shall follow up expeditiously to plan
for such contingency and stock up necessary supplies or equipment (eg thermometers) so as to be able
to implement the required measures in a short notice.

1.1.15 Temporary Sanitary Facilities

Within 21 days from the date of the Letter of Acceptance, the Contractor shall provide temporary
sanitary facilities with adequate lighting on site in suitable structures to be approved by the SO Rep.
The Contractor may use the Employer's Standard Drawings as a guide in designing the temporary
sanitary facilities. The temporary sanitary facilities shall contain water closets and shower
compartments in the proportion of 1 closet and 1 shower to every 25 workmen, for the duration of the
Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract.
In addition, the Contractor shall provide separate sanitary facilities with water closet and shower
compartment for use by the Employer's officers. Prior written approval by the SO Rep shall be obtained
before erection of these facilities.

The water closets shall be of a type, make and pattern approved by the PUB. Provide and lay glazed
wall tiles or other approved material to the internal walls of the temporary sanitary facilities up to a height
of 1.8m from the floor. The doors to the cubicles of the temporary sanitary facilities shall be of approved
material.

All waste discharge from the water closets and all waste water from the temporary sanitary facilities and
from the Site shall be discharged into a public sewer. Arrange with the PUB to carry out connection
work from the temporary sanitary facilities to the public sewer and pay all charges and maintenance in
connection therewith. The Contractor shall be responsible for all damage to and shall indemnify the
Employer against all liabilities in respect of such sewer connections.

Where a public sewer is not available or where it is not possible to connect to a public sewer, provide
and install temporary septic tanks of a type, pattern and capacity approved by the PUB, to serve the
water closets, showers and baths. Drawings of such septic tanks may be obtained from the PUB.

CE21/S1.DOC(5)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-6

1.1.16 Working Area, Position, Lines Etc

Where the Temporary Working Area is indicated in the Drawings, the Contractor will be allowed the
working space and he shall confine his operations and temporary facilities such as site offices and
sheds as he may require for executing the Works, within the area indicated. The Contractor shall be
required to take out a Temporary Occupation Licence (TOL) from the Singapore Land Authority or Lands
Management Section, HDB, for occupying the land as his temporary working area. The Contractor shall
pay all TOL fees, and bear all costs and expenses for the use and maintenance of and access to his
temporary working area and comply with all the conditions imposed by the Singapore Land Authority or
Lands Management Section, HDB. Where the Contractor opts not to use the Temporary Working Area,
or use a smaller Temporary Working Area than that indicated in the Drawings, there shall be no cost
adjustment to the Contract Sum.

Where no Temporary Working Area is indicated in the Drawings, the Contractor shall check on the
availability of land and apply to the Singapore Land Authority or Lands Management Section, HDB or
other relevant authority, for the use of land as temporary working area required for his operations and
setting up of temporary facilities such as site offices and sheds as he may require for executing the
Works. The Contractor shall pay all charges, TOL fees and bear all costs and expenses for the use
and maintenance of and access to the said land and comply with all the conditions imposed by the
Singapore Land Authority or Lands Management Section, HDB, or other relevant authority.

The Temporary Working Area allocated shall only be used solely for the purpose of executing Works
under the Contract. The whole of the Temporary Working Area shall be vacated and the land made
good on Substantial Completion.

In arriving at the Contract Sum the Contractor shall be deemed to have used as a basis the levels which
are shown on the various cross-sections and longitudinal sections of the Drawings relative to the
existing ground levels in determining his quantities of excavation or filling for the completed Works.

The precise positions, lines, depths and directions of the Works are indicated within all practicable limit.

If the Contractor wishes to make ground tests or other similar tests, then he shall state the extent and
manner of carrying out these tests and obtain the approval of the SO Rep before he proceeds.

Where trial borings or tests have been made by the Employer, the results may be made available to the
Contractor. The results or any other information on strata is given in good faith but the Employer
accepts no responsibility for the accuracy or reliability of such information. In all cases the Contractor
shall be deemed to have satisfied himself as to the type of strata and ground conditions that he may
encounter during the Works.

Should the Contractor not agree with any level of existing land or other property as given in the
Drawings, he shall submit his objection in writing within 2 weeks from the date of the Letter of
Acceptance. Otherwise, the Drawings shall be taken as correct for the purposes of setting out and
determination of variations (if any).

Note that all existing ground levels are given as spot levels or contours on plan and that straight lines
on the sections represent the average ground levels. Any small differences of levels therefore shall not
be regarded as sufficient reason for the Contractor to disagree with the information as shown on the
Drawings.

1.1.17 TOL Fee For Land Outside Contract Boundary

Where the Contractor requires land outside the contract boundary for the setting up of Construction
Equipment and other temporary facilities for the Works, the Contractor shall check on the availability of
such land and apply to the relevant Authority or Lands Management Section of HDB for the use of such
land. In the event the relevant Authority or HDB's Lands Management Section allows the Contractor
the use of such land, the Contractor shall at his own cost and expense comply with all the terms and
conditions, pay all TOL (Temporary Occupation Licence) fees, bear all costs and expenses for the use
and maintenance of and access to the said land imposed by the relevant Authority or HDB's Lands
Management Section.

Such land allocated shall solely be used for the purpose of executing Works under the Contract.

Any payment for unused materials or goods stored at such land shall be subject to the provisions in
Option Module B "Unused Materials or Goods not Delivered to Site" of the Conditions.

CE21/S1.DOC(6)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-7

1.1.18 Liaison With Town Council On Use Of Common Property For Site Office and/or Store

Consult with the SO Rep on the location of the site office and submit an application through the SO Rep
to the Town Council to obtain permission before putting up the site office and/or store. The application
shall include the following :

(a) Contractor's covering letter.

(b) Site plan of proposed location of site office and/or store.

(c) Layout plan with site indication of the site office and/or store.

(d) Letter of undertaking with the following conditions :

(i) To put up and maintain the site office signboard.

(ii) To open a PUB account for the use of water and electricity at the site office, if it is required
by the Town Council.

(iii) To maintain the cleanliness and orderliness of the site office and/or store and its
surrounding areas during the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated
damages are imposed under the Contract.

(iv) To reinstate any damage caused during the Time for Completion and any time period
where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract.

(v) To remove the site office and/or store and reinstate the site to its original condition within
3 weeks from the Date of Substantial Completion.

and any other conditions that the Town Council may impose.

If the location is not approved by the Town Council, amend and resubmit the application through the
SO Rep.

Ensure that those areas occupied by and surrounding the site office and/or store are maintained for the
duration of the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under
the Contract. Upon Substantial Completion, remove the site office and/or store and reinstate the site
to original condition within 3 weeks from the Date of Substantial Completion.

After the SO Rep has inspected the site and assessed that the area where the site office and/or store
were erected has been reinstated to original condition, arrange for the Town Council to take over.

All cost, expenses and sums incurred by the Contractor howsoever arising or consequent upon shall
be deemed to be included in the Contract Sum.

CE21/S1.DOC(7)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-8

1.1.19 Assignment Of Copyright Of Photographs, Etc

The Contractor shall assign to the Employer, the copyright of the photographs (including the
prints/slides/transparencies/ negatives) taken and all documents prepared under this Contract.

The Employer shall have unfettered rights to use or reproduce all the photographs (including the
prints/slides/transparencies/negatives) taken and all documents prepared by the Contractor under this
Contract for any purpose other than for the purpose for which the Contract was entered into.

In the event that the Contractor engages third parties to take the photographs (including the
prints/slides/transparencies/negatives) or prepare the documents, the Contractor shall procure the
assignment of the copyright from such third parties to himself and thereafter, assign the copyright to the
Employer.

The Contractor and/or any third parties are strictly prohibited from using or reproducing any of the
photographs (including the prints/slides/transparencies/negatives) taken and all documents prepared
under this Contract in any other publication or for any other purpose whatsoever.

1.1.20 Clearance Of Site, Turf And Topsoil

Clear the Site at such time and to the extent required by the SO Rep and take down hedges, trees,
hack up belukar, roots and any other obstruction from Site. All such waste materials removed shall be
disposed off as directed. Should the quantity of work involved appear greater than that shown on the
Drawings the Contractor shall make due allowance in the Contract Sum to cover such work and no
adjustment to the Contract Sum shall be made.

When digging and cutting of turfed ground are carried out, the turf and topsoil shall first be removed
and stored nearby for re-use as directed. Turf and topsoil shall not be taken away from Site without
prior permission of the SO Rep and they shall remain the property of the Employer.

1.1.21 Preservation Of Existing Trees During Construction & Development

Where any existing tree(s) on the Site is stipulated to be preserved (hereinafter referred to as "preserved
trees" for the purpose of this subclause), the Contractor shall take all necessary precautions to avoid
damage or injury to such trees and its roots and comply with the following requirements :

(A) Treatment Of Preserved Trees In Area Of Fill

(i) Tolerable Depth Of Fill

The area around preserved trees shall not be filled more than 300 mm in depth.

(ii) Construction Of Well Around Trees

Well not exceeding 1m in depth shall be constructed around preserved trees. The
minimum diameter of well shall be 6 times the diameter of preserved trees measured at
the trunk 0.5m above ground level. Details of well shall be as shown in the Drawings.

(B) Treatment Of Preserved Trees In Area of Cut

(i) Tolerable Depth Of Cut

The area around preserved trees shall not be cut to a depth exceeding 300 mm.

(ii) Retention Of Raised Planter Around Tree

An area around preserved trees shall be retained as raised planter to conserve the root
system. The minimum diameter of raised planter shall be 6 times the diameter of
preserved trees measured at the trunk 0.5m above ground level. Details of retention of
raised planter are as shown in the Drawings.

CE21/S1.DOC(8)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-9

1.1.21 Preservation Of Existing Trees During Construction & Development (Cont'd)

(C) Protection Of Existing Trees From Physical Damage By Equipment Etc During Construction

(i) All preserved trees shall be protected against damage during construction operation by
suitable fencing or armouring. The protection of preserved trees shall be placed before
commencing any excavation or grading operation/work and shall be maintained in repair
for the duration of the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages
are imposed under the Contract, unless otherwise directed. The extent of fencing shall
be determined by the SO Rep. Fencing shall be erected all round not less than 1.2m from
the trunk of preserved trees.

Individual preserved trees near heavy construction traffic shall be wrapped with gunny
sacks and 50 mm x 100 mm planks worn vertically as armour around the trunk and spaced
at no more than 50 mm apart to a height of 1.5m above ground.

(ii) Any damage to preserved trees root system shall be repaired immediately by the
Contractor under the supervision of a qualified horticulturist. Roots that are exposed
and/or damaged during grading operations shall be cut off immediately and the inside of
the exposed and/or damaged area cleaned; cut surfaces shall be treated with approved
sealing compound and topsoil spread over the exposed root area.

(iii) Any damage to preserved trees branches shall be treated in accordance with the
Drawings.

(iv) If any preserved trees are severely injured by mechanical equipment, etc., the SO Rep
shall impose charges against the Contractor in accordance with Clause 1.6 "Nuisance
and Irregularities".

(D) Health & Condition Of Preserved Trees

(i) The Contractor shall ensure that :

(a) Compaction of soil around preserved trees shall be avoided.


(b) No material shall be stored within the root system.
(c) There shall be no spillage of any nature within the spread of the preserved trees.
(d) There shall be no parking of vehicles underneath the preserved trees.
(e) There shall be no dumping of excavated materials, concrete, equipment etc. within
the spread of the preserved trees crown.
(f) Soil around preserved trees is properly cultivated to ensure that adequate supply
of air and water get to the roots.
(g) The site is drained in periods of heavy rainfall and irrigated during periods of
drought.

(ii) The Contractor shall also carry out any other routine maintenance of the preserved trees
eg. branch trimming, pesticide spraying etc. as instructed by the SO Rep.

(iii) If the growth of the preserved trees is stifled, the Contractor shall inter-alia bear the cost
of making good. Charges in accordance with Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities"
shall also be imposed against the Contractor.

1.1.22 Research Work

The Contractor shall provide and render all necessary assistance to the SO Rep or other authorised
persons conducting research work or procuring publicity materials on any aspects of the construction
work in progress. When directed by the SO Rep, the Contractor shall also provide all brochures,
quotations, sub-contract agreements, invoices, etc from his sub-contractors, suppliers and specialists
for goods and services provided for the Works, all at the Contractor's cost and expense.

CE21/S1.DOC(9)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-10

1.1.23 Site Management

Within 14 days from the date of the Letter of Acceptance, submit to the SO Rep for his approval the
following details on site planning :

(a) Site organisation structure


(b) Names and roles of Contractor's staff
(c) Manpower schedule for each trade
(d) Materials purchase and delivery schedule for each trade
(e) Schedule of heavy equipment
(f) Schedule of Construction

Furnish the SO Rep with such further details and information as the SO Rep may require in regard to
the above items.

At least 14 days before the supply of the materials by manufacturers/suppliers, the Contractor shall
submit the names of the manufacturers and suppliers to the SO Rep.

At least 14 days before the commencement of the Works by the subcontractors, the Contractors shall
submit the names and roles of his subcontractors to the SO Rep.

Should it appear to the SO Rep at any time that the proposed site planning is not able to ensure a
smooth progress of and good workmanship in the Works, the SO Rep is empowered to require the
Contractor to make at the Contractor's own cost and expense all necessary modifications to the plans.

Approval by the SO Rep of the Contractor's site planning details, revised site planning and further
information provided under this subclause shall not in any way affect, relieve or vary the Contractor's
liabilities or obligations under the Contract.

1.1.24 Reserved

1.1.25 Signboards

Where erection of signboards with more than one language is required, all translations shall be carried
out by competent translators approved by the SO Rep. All completed signboards shall be approved by
the SO Rep before they are erected.

1.1.26 Air Pollution Control

Comply with the relevant provisions of the Clean Air (Amendment) Act and/or requirements of other
relevant Authorities.

Take all necessary measures to abate the discharge of smoke, fumes or obnoxious gases or excessive
noise from Construction Equipment on the Site. When notified by the SO Rep that a particular
Construction Equipment or equipment is discharging excessive smoke, fumes or obnoxious gases, stop
the use of that Construction Equipment, and replace the same with acceptable Construction Equipment.
No claims from the Contractor shall be entertained on account of the foregoing requirements. In
addition, the SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose
charges against the Contractor.

1.1.27 Provision Of Bins For Waste And Debris

The Contractor shall provide proper bulk bins of adequate size for storage of construction waste and
debris in compliance with the requirements of ENV.

CE21/S1.DOC(10)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-11

1.1.28 Periodic Cleaning Up

All rubbish and debris shall be cleared from the Site from time to time as they accumulate or as directed
by the SO Rep. Particular attention shall be directed to those areas where other trades or statutory
boards' contractors will be working in.

1.1.29 Pest Control And Surveillance

Engage a Pest Control Operator who is registered with the BCA under the Work Head for Pest Control
and NEA under the Control of Vector and Pesticide Act to provide comprehensive pest control and
surveillance work on the Site. Submit the name of the Pest Control Operator and proof of BCA/NEA
registration to the SO Rep for approval prior to carrying out the work. The SO Rep may disapprove the
Pest Control Operator selected by the Contractor and the Contractor shall not be entitled to any claims
arising from such decision.

Pest control measures and surveillance programme shall fully comply with the requirements of the NEA
as well as the following :

(a) Submit a detailed pest control and surveillance programme inclusive of “Source Reduction
Regime/Strategy”, “Water bearing receptacle removal team” at the Site to the respective NEA’s
regional office and the SO Rep prior to commencement of the Works. The frequency of fogging
shall be in accordance with the requirements of the NEA. Fogging is to be carried out only by
licensed Pest Operator using approved chemical.

(b) Maintain a site register containing an up-to-date record of pest control and surveillance work that
has been carried out. The site register shall be made available and ready for inspection by the
SO Rep when required.

(c) Submit monthly summarised returns of the site records required by NEA to the respective NEA
regional office.

The work required under this subclause shall include all necessary measures to prevent the Site from
becoming conducive to the breeding or harbouring of vectors. Carry out site checks at least once a
week to detect and remove breeding and harbouring grounds. If breeding or harbouring of vectors is
found at the Site, enforcement action may be taken against the Contractor by the NEA. The SO Rep
may also exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose charges against
the Contractor.

1.1.30 Temporary Services

The Contractor shall provide and maintain all temporary services necessary for the execution of the
Works. Give all notices and pay all dues in connection therewith. All water required for use on the
Works shall be provided by the Contractor.

1.1.31 Care Of The Works And Materials

The Contractor shall be responsible for the care of the Works and safe keep all materials delivered to
the Site by the specialists, suppliers or sub-contractors against all risks arising from weather,
negligence, damage or loss until Substantial Completion is certified by the SO Rep. Allow for all
necessary watching and security lighting.

1.1.32 Fencing And Lighting

Where necessary, the Contractor shall provide and fix adequate temporary fencing for fencing off the
Works during construction on any part or parts of the sewers, drains, excavations, etc under the
Contract and remove the fencing on Substantial Completion.

Provide temporary cross bridges with proper handrails and lights over the trenches at such points and
at such distances apart as in the opinion of the SO Rep may be necessary to give proper foot and
vehicle access.

Fencing and cross bridges shall be provided on such lengths of the sewers, drains, excavations, etc
where children and others must be prevented from falling into the trenches, drains and excavations.

CE21/S1.DOC(11)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-12

1.1.33 Cables/Services Detection

Visit and examine the Site carefully and ascertain its nature and make provision in the Contract Sum
for the type of ground conditions, constraints and underground services.

Provide cables/services detecting devices to locate all existing cables/services prior to the
commencement of excavation or any other work such as driving of piles, piling of earth electrode and
lightning conductors or poles and columns which are liable to damage existing buried services. Engage
PUB licensed cables/services detection workers to carry out all cables/services detection work. The
proposed line of excavation or area of other work shall be checked for existing services in a systematic
manner by making sufficient passes in a grid formation to cover the entire area of work. The Contractor's
attention is drawn to the requirements of the PowerGrid and IDA. The Contractor shall comply fully with
the relevant provisions of the Public Utilities Act and Telecommunication Act or any amendment or re-
enactment thereof.

The Contractor shall comply fully with the Licensing Scheme for telecommunication cable detection
workers by the IDA. Under the licensing scheme, the Contractor is required to engage qualified licensed
telecommunication cable detection workers to locate all existing telecommunication cables/services
before the commencement of excavation and earthworks (piling, dredging, boring, levelling, tunnelling,
jacking, driving of any earth rod/casing/tube into the ground, etc) as defined under the
Telecommunications Act 1999. The Contractor shall comply fully with the relevant provisions of the
Telecommunications Act 1999 or any amendment or re-enactment thereof.

The extent of the checking carried out shall be properly documented and countersigned by the SO Rep.
Notwithstanding the precautions taken, the Contractor shall be liable for all costs and charges incurred
if he damages any cables/services. The Contractor shall pay all charges, fees and bear all costs and
expenses incurred in complying with the relevant provisions of the Telecommunications Act 1999 and
Public Utilities Act or any amendment or re-enactment thereof.

The Contractor shall seek assistance from the relevant Government Department or Statutory Boards if
he has any query on the location of existing cables/services belonging to the Government Department
or Statutory Boards. In the case of PowerGrid cables/services, the Contractor may seek assistance
from the Cable Damage Prevention Unit, PowerGrid. For telecommunication cables/services, the
Contractor may seek assistance from the telecommunication system licensees, PTL, SingTel, SCV and
StarHub.

Notify the SO Rep where mains, pipe or conduit are encountered with during excavation and where any
excavation is carried out adjacent to or under any existing cable, pipe, structure; or any other such work
that may be affected by subsidence as the SO Rep may direct, regardless of whether such work is
shown in the Drawings or not. If it becomes essential, in the opinion of the SO Rep to permanently
support the Works, build supports of grade 15 concrete or take such steps as the SO Rep may direct.
Under such cases, the Contractor shall be paid for this additional work unless in the opinion of the SO
Rep, such additional work has been necessitated by the Contractor's negligence, lack of foresight or
faulty workmanship.

In the event that damages have been caused to the public services due to the Contractor's work or
otherwise, all expenditure for such necessary repairs etc incurred by the relevant public Authorities shall
be borne by the Contractor regardless of whether such repairs are due to accident or otherwise. The
cost and expense for such repairs shall be deducted from monies due or becoming due to the
Contractor or by direct payment by the Contractor to the Authorities.

If, in the opinion of the SO Rep, it is essential to permanently divert any cable, pipe or other services,
such diversions shall be paid for by the Employer. Provided always that such diversions do not form
part of the Works.

1.1.34 Damage To Public/Private Property

In the event that damage is caused to public/private services or property such as cables, pipes, fittings
and fixtures etc. by the Contractor whether by accident or otherwise leading to black-outs or other
nuisance or inconvenience to the public or is likely to bring the Employer into disrepute, all costs and
expenses incurred for necessary reinstatement or repairs shall be recoverable by the Employer by
deduction from monies due or becoming due to the Contractor or as a debt due by the Contractor to
the Employer. In addition, the SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and
Irregularities" to impose charges against the Contractor.

CE21/S1.DOC(12)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-13

1.1.35 Cleaning And Maintenance Of Roads And Drains

The Contractor shall maintain the cleanliness of public roads and drains used by his vehicles throughout
the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the
Contract. Construct washing bay for the cleaning of earth-laden lorries before they leave the Work Site.
Clean up all deposits left by the vehicles on the road and employ sufficient workers for this operation
every day. Earth droppings shall not be allowed to remain overnight either on the carriageways,
pavements or in the drains. Where it is not feasible to remove deposits during normal working hours,
carry out the cleaning operation during the hours between midnight and 6.00 a.m.

The Contractor shall be responsible for paying any fines imposed by the relevant authorities eg. Public
Health Department, Traffic Police etc.

Ensure that the flow of traffic on the roads and access is maintained at all times during the Time for
Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract. Provide
such flagmen, approved signs and signalling equipment as may be necessary day and night to control
the traffic to the satisfaction of the SO Rep and the appropriate Controlling Authority. In the planning
and execution of any Temporary or Permanent Works which may affect the traffic flow and/or access
to the Site or other properties, co-operate closely with the SO Rep and the appropriate Controlling
Authority.

Whenever required, remove with due compliance, Construction Equipment, machinery, staging and
other materials which may interfere with traffic and the use of roads, footpaths or open spaces on the
Site or adjacent thereto.

Take every practical precaution to avoid interference with the flow of storm water through the drain,
canal, culverts and other side drains etc. Any spoil, rubble, timber, rubbish or other materials which may
fall into or brought into the drain, canal, culvert and other side drains etc by the storm water shall be
removed forthwith.

All necessary water tight flumes, cofferdams, chutes and/or other approved methods of controlling the
flow of water shall be adequate for this purpose and subject to the approval of the SO Rep. Such works
shall be constructed in a rigid, workmanlike manner, sufficient to withstand water pressure at its highest
level.

If the SO Rep considers that any temporary structure erected is obstructing the flow to an extent more
than necessary, making it liable to cause flooding in the event of a rain storm, he may, one hour after
notifying the Contractor or the Contractor's Representative, employ other labour and Construction
Equipment to demolish such structures. All costs and expenses incurred shall be deducted from any
monies, due or becoming due to the Contractor.

The Contractor shall be liable for and indemnify the Employer against any actions, claims, costs and
demands for damages caused by the Contractor's non-compliance of maintenance of roads and drains,
flooding, slips, subsidences or other failures resulting from non-compliance by the Contractor with
respect to the above. In addition, the SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and
Irregularities" to impose charges against the Contractor.

1.1.36 Access Roads And Protective Crossings

The Contractor shall repair and maintain all access roads serving the Site and provide temporary
protective crossings over existing drains, channels, footways, etc throughout the Time for Completion
and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract. Making good all
damage and/or clearing away on Substantial Completion to the satisfaction of the relevant Authorities
and SO Rep.

1.1.37 Demolition And Making Good

The Contractor shall take care when demolishing or cutting away existing work such that no adjacent
work is unnecessarily damaged in any way. Make good any work so damaged.

Old materials may not be re-used in the new work, except where so specified or as directed.

Exposed raw faces of existing concrete or brickwork which will not have new work built on them shall
be made good with cement, rendering or new brickwork and finished to a neat, straight, vertical or plane
surface in harmony with the adjoining surface.

CE21/S1.DOC(13)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-14

1.1.38 Breaking Up Of Existing Work

If it is found necessary to break up existing pavement, road or footpath, etc for constructional purposes
as required under the Contract, such intention of doing so shall be conveyed to the SO Rep prior to
commencement of work. If construction work is to be carried out on public roads, first obtain permission
from LTA. In the event that normal flow of traffic is interrupted due to the Works in progress, minimise
the inconvenience caused to the public by constantly cleaning the roadway such that a steady flow of
traffic is maintained. Temporary traffic directional signboards shall be installed at strategic points if
required.

All existing work broken up by the Contractor shall be made good to the satisfaction of the SO Rep.

The reinstatement shall comply with all the requirements of LTA. Works which do not conform to the
standard and requirements of the SO Rep or LTA shall be immediately removed and replaced or
extended.

On completion of the reinstatement, maintain all the road surfaces etc., affected during the Time for
Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract. All faults,
settlements etc., developed within this period shall be made good immediately upon receipt of an
instruction from the SO Rep.

Be liable for all claims for injury or damage arising from any Defect in the reinstated road surface during
the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract
and the Defects Liability Period.

Adhere strictly to the requirement set out in the LTA specifications on Road Opening and Reinstatement
of Trenches and the HDB Standard Conditions governing Trench Opening within HDB Estates when
carrying out the Works required under this subclause.

1.1.39 Excavation Of Service Trenches And Storage Of Cable Ducts

Excavate trenches for the laying of services within the contract Site. Such excavations and provision of
cable ducts crossing the road shall be paid for according to the Rates if they are not indicated in the
Drawings.

If cable ducts are to be provided by the Service Department concerned, provide storage space on the
Site and shall be responsible for their loss or damage.

1.1.40 Reinstatement Of Service Trenches

All service trenches for the laying of cables, pipes, etc within the Contract boundary shall be reinstated
immediately after the services have been laid and completed by the Services Authorities.

All backfilling materials for cross or longitudinal trench within completed or partly completed road
carriageway or carpark shall be of approved materials conforming to the following characteristics :

(a) The percentage passing 75 µm B.S. sieve shall be not more than 35%;

(b) The fraction passing through 75 µm sieve shall have liquid limit not exceeding 35 and plasticity
index not exceeding 12;

(c) Dry density shall not be less than 1760 kg per m3.

Dry excavated soil may be used for backfilling only in open field outside road carriageway and carparks.
Backfilled materials shall be mechanically compacted in layers of 200mm and conform with the following
requirements:

(a) Within 500mm of formation level - 95% of max dry density using latest edition of BS 1377;

(b) More than 500mm below formation level - 85% of max dry density using latest edition of BS 1377;

Damages, directly or indirectly caused by the trench to carriageway, kerb, footpath, drain, sidetable, etc
regardless of its existing condition shall be reinstated to conform to the current standard and practice
of HDB.

CE21/S1.DOC(14)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-15

1.1.40 Reinstatement Of Service Trenches (Cont’d)

Edges of all reinstated road pavement shall be cut straight with a power-saw. The saw-cut shall be of
a minimum depth of 75mm and edge of cut shall be at least 150mm from the edge of the trench
depending on the extent of damages to the road surface.

Unless otherwise stated, the reinstated road pavements shall consist of the following :

(a) 150mm asphalt premix

(b) 350mm compacted crusher run road base binded with granite fines

(c) The layer below the road base to the bottom of trench shall be made up of compacted granite
fines/cement dust.

The level of reinstated road shall be allowed a tolerance of + 5mm from the existing road surface level
when measured with a 3m straight edge.

Reinstatement of footpath shall cover the full width of the footpath.

For turfed area, the reinstatement shall conform to the relevant clauses and subclause on turfing in the
Specifications.

The Contractor shall be paid for work done under this subclause priced in accordance with the Contract
and the Rates.

All backfilling materials not conforming to or not compacted according to this Specifications shall be
removed and replaced with approved materials and recompacted to the stipulated standard.

1.1.41 Dumping Of Debris And Rubbish

Dispose of all unwanted debris, rubble or excess earth at approved dumping grounds and bear the cost
of all charges levied for the use of the dumping grounds.

If the Contractor dumps debris, rubble or excess earth on land owned by the Employer or the
Government without written permission, he shall have to remove all debris, rubble or excess earth from
such land at his own cost and expense. In addition, the SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause
1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose charges against the Contractor.

1.1.42 Inspection Of Works Prior To Certified Completion

Conduct detailed checks on the Works and rectify all Defect before arranging for the SO Rep to inspect
the Works for the purpose of certifying Substantial Completion. Ensure that all items to be incorporated
into the Works have been so incorporated before such inspection by the SO Rep. The SO Rep may
not inspect the Works if any of the abovesaid items are not incorporated into the Works. The Contractor
shall not be entitled to any claims and to any extension of time on account of such failure to ensure that
all items are incorporated into the Works.

After the first inspection by the SO Rep, the SO Rep shall give the Contractor a list of outstanding Defect
and the Contractor shall rectify all Defect on the list within seven days.

If any of the Defect in the list is not rectified on the second inspection by the SO Rep, the SO Rep may
exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose a charge against the
Contractor. The Contractor shall be given another seven days to rectify these Defect. Should any of
these Defect be found not rectified on the third inspection, the Employer may employ and pay another
contractor to rectify the Defect and all costs and expenses incurred by the Employer shall be recovered
from the Contractor. In addition, the SO Rep may exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and
Irregularities" to impose a further charge against the Contractor.

CE21/S1.DOC(15)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-16

1.1.43 Cleaning Upon Substantial Completion

On Substantial Completion, the Contractor shall remove all rubbish, Construction Equipment and
surplus materials, wash and scrub clean all floors, pavings, drains and all parts of the Works and leave
the Works in a clean and hygienic condition. The Site and periphery shall be cleared of all rubbish left
from the Contractor's work.

1.1.44 Rectification Of Defect During Defects Liability Period

The Contractor shall within fourteen working days from the date of the written notification by the SO
Rep repair, rectify and make good to the satisfaction of the SO Rep all Defect, imperfections, shrinkages
and other faults arising from or out of the use of materials or workmanship not in accordance with the
Contract or from neglect or failure by the Contractor to comply with any obligation on his part under the
Contract, which may become manifest.

If the Contractor fails to carry out his obligation as aforesaid, the SO Rep shall exercise his rights under
Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose a charge on the Contractor.

Without prejudice to the foregoing provisions, the Employer shall have the right to engage other
person(s) or contractor(s) to repair, rectify and make good all such Defect, imperfections, shrinkages
and other faults if the same are not repaired, rectified and make good after fourteen working days from
the date of written notification by the SO Rep and the cost and expense incurred shall be recovered
from the Contractor. In addition, the SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and
Irregularities" to impose a further charge on the Contractor.

1.1.45 Noise Nuisance

Judicious management and control over the activities within the Site shall be exercised by the
Contractor for the abatement of noise nuisance. All necessary actions shall be taken to ensure
compliance to the latest noise control regulations imposed by the ENV or any relevant authorities.

1.1.46 Recovery Of Legal Costs For Court Proceedings

All legal costs, charges and expenses (including but not limited to solicitors' fees as between solicitor
and client) incurred by the Employer for the purpose of or incidental to the enforcement by the Employer
of any rights and remedies under the Contract or any other contracts between the Employer and the
Contractor or in respect of any garnishee proceedings which may be brought or commenced against
the Employer by the Contractor's creditors may be deducted by the Employer from monies due or
becoming due to the Contractor including any retention monies, financial bonds or security deposits or
other bonds.

1.1.47 Machinery Boundary

The Contractor shall comply with the Mass Rapid Transit Corporation Code Of Practice For Railway
Protection when the works are carried out within Mass Rapid Transit Corporation protection zone.
Submit proposals on effective measures for the protection of Mass Rapid Transit above ground
structure together with the detail of activities of mobile cranes, tower cranes and other mechanical
equipment adjacent to Mass Rapid Transit line structures to the SO Rep for approval at least one month
prior to the use of such equipment. No jib or lifting appliance or any other moving or stationery part of
the mechanical equipment shall encroach within 6m on plan from the edge of the nearest Mass Rapid
Transit above-ground or at-grade structure unless the equipment is restricted to work beneath the
structure. The foundation of the mechanical equipment shall be certified structurally sound and
adequate by the Contractor's professional engineer prior to its installation.

Auto cut-off system shall be installed for tower cranes to prevent the top of boom to swing closer than
6m from edge of viaduct structure. The jibs of the cranes must always be pointed away from Mass
Rapid Transit line structure. The temporary access shall be stable and level for machinery to move on.
Regular checks shall be carried out to ensure that all mechanised equipment are in good working
condition at all times. Only experienced, trained and competent operators shall be employed for mobile
cranes, tower cranes and other mechanical equipment. Temporary height restriction gantry with
signboard shall be installed 6m away from the edge of both sides of viaduct structure for any access
passing underneath the Mass Rapid Transit line structures.

CE21/S1.DOC(16)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-17

1.1.48 Reserved

1.1.49 Work Site Computer Equipment

Provide the following computer hardware, accessories and software within the Time for Completion for
the exclusive use of the SO Rep :

Computer Hardware and Accessories (hereinafter referred to as `the Hardware' for


the purposes of this clause including sub-clauses) :
 1 number Pentium 4 PC;
 1 number A4 Laser Printer;
 1 number A4 Color Scanner;
 1 number Broadband Modem with Broadband Communication Line, or a 56Kbps Data/Fax
Modem with 1 additional Telephone Line, or a Wireless Device as required by the SO Rep;
 1 number Uninterruptible Power System;
 1 number PC Screen Filter;
 10 numbers 3.5 inch Floppy Diskettes;
Computer Software (hereinafter referred to as `the Software' for the purposes of
this Clause including sub-clauses) :
 1 number Microsoft Windows 2000 Professional Edition, or latest version;
 1 number Microsoft Office 2000 Professional Edition, or latest version;
 1 number Norton Internet Security software Version 3.0, or later,
 1 number F-Secure Anti-Virus version 5.40, or later.

Hardware previously approved for HDB work sites shall also be accepted provided that the approved
PC is upgraded to (1) 512 MB RAM and installed with a 30 GB hard disk, a 48-speed CDROM drive
and a 250MB Zip Drive, or better, (2) the modem is a broadband modem or 56Kbps modem, or a
wireless device as required by the SO Rep. Software previously approved for HDB worksites shall be
upgraded to the versions as described in this Clause.

Ensure that the Hardware and Software are in good working condition to the satisfaction of the SO Rep,
and pay for all maintenance and license fees for the Hardware and Software throughout the period from
one week before contract commencement until three weeks after the Date of Substantial Completion.
Also pay for all expendable items including 80g per m2 A4 printing papers, toner cartridges, image drum,
diskettes, screen cleaning kits, subscription, excess-hours usage and service maintenance fees related
to communication devices etc during the same period. Also provide the necessary furniture, including
separate table and chair for the computer equipment, and light partitions if required and as approved
by the SO Rep. Also provide plastic dust covers, accessories, adequate power supply including
uninterruptible power system and additional telephone line at the Contractor's own expense to
accommodate and facilitate the usage of the Hardware and Software. Provide a communication device,
either an broadband device, a 56Kbps modem device or a wireless device as required by the SO Rep.
Pay for such device, all related charges including installation, registration, connection, subscription,
usage, service maintenance, and expendable items including batteries etc for the device.

Submit specifications and details of the Hardware and Software for approval by the SO Rep TWO
WEEKS before contract commencement and BEFORE the purchase or leasing of the Hardware and
Software. Also make and pay for such necessary arrangement for the hardware and software to be
tested at the relevant Consultant’s office and subsequent delivery to work site upon request by the SO
Rep.

Ensure that only authorised software are used with the Hardware and obtain written approval from the
SO Rep before installing any software other than the ones specified herein into the Hardware. Also
ensure that the Hardware and Software are not used for any other purpose unless approved in writing
by the SO Rep.

If the Contractor fails to make available the Hardware and Software by one week before contract
commencement or fails to rectify within 3 days any hardware or software faults, the SO Rep will make
the necessary arrangement to acquire or to rectify and all expenses thus incurred shall be deducted
from the payment due to or becoming due to the Contractor.

Make all necessary arrangement and provision for securing the Hardware and Software in the site
office. Replace any stolen or missing Hardware and Software within 3 days of such occurrence, failing
which the SO Rep will make the necessary arrangement to acquire the Hardware and Software and all
expenses thus incurred shall be deducted from the payment due to or becoming due to the Contractor.

CE21/S1.DOC(17)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-18

1.1.49 Work Site Computer Equipment (Cont’d)

Make and pay for such necessary arrangement for the hardware to be delivered to the relevant
Consultant’s office for trouble-shooting of PC problems, software upgrade and removal, and subsequent
delivery to work site upon request by the SO Rep.

All the Hardware and Software except the Zip disks, floppy diskettes, computer printed materials,
working files and HDB application files created or installed by the SO Rep will be returned to the
Contractor three weeks after the Date of Substantial Completion.

The Hardware shall comply with the following technical specifications :

(a) IBM PC or compatible

Shall be a PCI-bus Intel Pentium 4 PC, certified by Novell Testing Laboratory for working as a
Netware 5.1x client workstation, or belongs to a PC family an earlier model of which was certified
by the same authority, or certified under ISO 9001 or 9002 by the proper authority, or other
approved by the SO Rep.

Able to work with the Local Area Network located at the relevant Consultant’s office through
broadband communication line, telephone line or wireless device. Able to withstand the current
and voltage variations as supplied from ordinary power generator on the Site through
uninterruptible power system. Appropriate protection against rough handling on construction site
and RF interferences.

The PC shall also comply at least with the following specifications :


 Provided with Intel Pentium 4 2.0 GHz or higher processor;
 Provided with 256 KB integrated, full-speed L2 cache;
 Provided with Intel 845 Chipset. or better;
 Provided with at least 512 MB of PC133 SDRAM or better, upgradeable to 3 GB or more.
 Provided with flash system BIOS of the version not earlier than 12 months from the date
of delivery.
 Provided with at least two empty 32-bit PCI expansion slots, one AGP 4x slot, four USB 2.0
ports, one parallel port, two serial ports, and two PS/2 ports.
 Provided with one AGP 4x or higher video card with at least 32 MB of video memory.
 Provided with one Sound Blaster compatible sound card and amplified stereo speakers.
 Provided with one 1.44 MB 3½-inch floppy diskette drive.
 Provided with one 30 GB, 7200 rpm, IDE ATA100 hard drive, or better.
 Provided with one 48x or higher internal IDE CD-ROM drive.
 Provided with one 17-inch SVGA color monitor, 0.28 mm or smaller dot-pitch, 32-bit true color
at 1024 x 768 pixels, 75 Hz or higher vertical frequency and 35 kHz or higher horizontal
frequency.
 Provided with one 104-key Windows keyboard.
 Provided with one Microsoft optical wheel mouse or equivalent with one rubber-based mouse
pad not smaller less than 8-inch by 9½-inch.
 Provided with one power supply of at least 200 watt at 220/230V 50Hz.
 Provided with one Netrust compatible smart card reader.
 Provided with locking device for locking the system chassis and monitor to office furniture
or fixtures.
 Provided with locking device for locking up the system chassis to prevent access to internal
components.
 Preloaded with Microsoft Windows 2000 Professional or later.
 Certified by Microsoft for compatibility with the provided Windows operating system.
 Able to work with the other Hardware and Software as specified in this Specifications.

(b) Laser Printer

Shall be a A4 laser printer, or other approved by the SO Rep. The printer shall also comply with
the following specifications :

 Support PCL language.


 Print at 8 pages per minute.
 Print at 600 x 600 dpi resolution.
 Provided with 45 scalable TrueType fonts, and support downloadable bitmap fonts.
 Provided with 2 MB of RAM in additional to ROM memory.
 Achieve a duty cycle of 2500 single-sided pages per month.
 Provided with USB or Parallel Interface
 Provided with 100-sheet Input Bin and 100-sheet Output Bin for A4-size paper.
 Support A4, letter, legal and executive paper size.
CE21/S1.DOC(18)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-19

1.1.49 Work Site Computer Equipment (Cont’d)

(b) Laser Printer (Cont’d)

 Print on single sheet paper, envelopes, mailing labels and transparencies.


 Support Windows Plug and Play installation.
 Able to work with the Software as specified in this Specifications.

(c) Colour Scanner

Shall be a A4 flatbed colour scanner, or other approved by the SO Rep. The scanner shall also
comply with the following specifications :

 Provided with colour CCD photoelectric device.


 Support A4 and letter document size.
 Support Micro Step Drive technology.
 Support colour 42-bit and grayscale 14-bit scanning depth.
 Scan at 1200 x 2400 dpi optical resolution.
 Scan at 32 sec per page for colour 300dpi A4 page and 11 sec per page for monochrome
300dpi A4 page.
 Provided with USB interface.
 Support film adaptor.
 Able to work with the Software as specified in this Specifications.

(d) Communication Devices

The communication device shall be a broadband modem with a broadband communication line,
or a 56Kbps modem with one additional telephone line, or a wireless device as required by the
SO Rep. The specifications for each mode of communication are specified below :

(i) Broadband Modem Communication

 Shall subscribe to IDA-approved broadband provider in Singapore.


 Shall provide one Broadband Modem, User Guide and Software CD.
 Shall provide Splitter, Microfilters, or Dual-jack Adapter if applicable.
 Shall provide communication line for broadband modem.
 Shall pay for all one-time charges including modem and accessories, registration,
installation, un-installation, un-registration and related fees for the broadband service.
 Shall pay for recurrent charges throughout the period from one week before contract
commencement until three weeks after the Date of Substantial Completion including
subscription fee, usage fee, all excess-hours usage charges, and service maintenance
charges for the broadband service.
 Shall pay for the registration fee, installation fee, subscription fee, usage fee and related
fees for the communication line used for the broadband communication.
 Shall submit monthly broadband subscription bills to the SO Rep for record purpose.
 Shall work with the communication infrastructure installed in the HDB and worked with
the VPN software provided by the HDB.
 Shall be compatible with the proposed hardware and software.

(ii) 56Kbps Modem Communication

 Shall provide a ITU V.90 56Kbps data/fax modem with one additional telephone line.
 Shall pay for all charges related to the use of the telephone line including registration
fee, installation and connection fees, subscription fee, usage and related fees.

The Modem shall also comply with the following specifications :

 Shall pass a file-transfer benchmark test set by the Civil Engineering Department, HDB.
 Shall transmit at speeds up to 56Kbps with throughput up to 115.2Kbps.
 Shall be able to work with Class 1 or Class 2.0 fax software to exchange faxes with
Group III fax machines worldwide at speeds up to 14.4Kbps.
 Shall support basic AT command set.
 Shall be provided with surge protector.
 Shall be compatible with CISCO 3640 ISDN Communication Server.
 Shall be compatible with other proposed Hardware.
 Shall be compatible with ITU V.90 56 Kbps, and ITU V.34 33.6 Kbps.
 Shall be compatible with ITU and Bell standards from 56 Kbps to 1.2 Kbps.
 Shall have V.42/MNP 2-4 error control, V.42 bis/MNP 5 data compression.
 Shall support Windows Plug and Play installation.

CE21/S1.DOC(19)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-20

1.1.49 Work Site Computer Equipment (Cont’d)

(d) Communication Devices (Cont’d)

(iii) Wireless Communication

The proposed Wireless Device shall comprise of a Data Card with support software and
drivers. Shall pay for all charges related to the use of the wireless communication
including registration fee, installation and connection fees, subscription fee, usage and
related fees.

The Wireless Device shall comply with the following specifications :

 Certified by Info-Communications Development Authority of Singapore for use


in Singapore.
 Shall be a GSM or GPRS or 3G device whichever approved by the SO Rep.
 Shall support wireless data communication between the proposed PC and the Computer
Servers located at HDB Hub.
 Provided with all necessary support software for data communication with the Wide Area
Network Servers located at HDB Hub.
 Provide data and fax capability.
 Shall be a PCMCIA card or equivalent.
 Provided with necessary internal or external adapter for the PCMCIA card to work with
the proposed PC;
 Compatible with the proposed hardware and software.

(e) PC Screen Filter

The Proposed PC Screen Filter shall comply with the following specifications :
 Shall be full 17 inch diagonal viewing area.
 Shall eliminate up to 99% VDT glare.
 Shall block minimum 98% ELF/VLF E-Field radiation.
 Shall block ultraviolet ray (UV `A' 90% UV `B' 100%).
 Shall reduce reflection by up to 99%.
 Shall eliminate static charge & dust build up.
 Shall eliminate screen flicker.
 Shall enhance contrast, color and resolution.
 Shall have high efficiency anti-reflective (HEA) & anti-glare coating on both sides of filter.
 Shall be made of durable tempered glass or equivalent.
 Shall be made of flat frame with hangers.
 Shall be life time warranty.

(f) Uninterruptible Power System

The proposed Uninterruptible Power System shall be able to protect the Hardware from voltage
surges and provide a minimum 15 minutes backup time at full load from power failure.

The Uninterruptible Power System shall also comply with the following specification :
 Shall have input voltage of 230 Volt AC.
 Shall have input frequency of 50/60 Hz single phase.
 Shall have output power rating of 600/400 VA/Watts.
 Shall have output voltage of 220 - 230 Volt AC.
 Shall have sine wave output waveform.
 Shall have output frequency of 50/60 Hz.
 Shall sound alarm during power surges and when input power fails.
 Shall have appropriate protection against power surges.
 Shall have maintenance-free spill-proof sealed battery.

CE21/S1.DOC(20)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-21

1.1.50 Extension Of Time

Provided that the Contractor has complied with all the conditions & requirements as prescribed in the
Conditions of Contract and all the relevant and applicable specification clauses, the SO Rep may extend
the Time for Completion for the Works or any phase or part of the Works.

For the avoidance of doubt, all Extension of Time claims to be submitted by the Contractor, and the
assessment and granting of any extension of time by the SO/SO’s Rep shall be based on the calendar
days.

1.1.51 Assessment Of Extension Of Time Due To Exceptionally Inclement Weather

The assessment of exceptionally inclement weather shall not take place until the expiry of the Time for
Completion or extended Time for Completion. Such assessment shall be made on the following basis :

(a) There shall first be assessed the number of wet days on which the Contractor has been
substantially delayed in the carrying out of the Works by rain (hereinafter called "delay days").

(b) A wet day shall be one where the rainfall figure as calculated as described in this sub-paragraph
exceeds 10.2 mm during the 24 hour period used by the Meteorological Service. The rainfall figure shall
be the average island-wide rainfall calculated by the Employer using rainfall records received by the
Employer monthly from the 5 Standard Stations of the Meteorological Service.

(c) The expected number of wet days during the Time for Completion or extended Time for
Completion as the case may be shall be derived from the following table which is deemed to
record the average number of wet days for the respective months based on the Meteorological
Service's records between 2010 and 2019 (hereinafter call "expected wet days") :

Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun


6 4 8 7 7 6
Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec
6 5 6 7 11 10

(d) For each month of the Time for Completion or extended Time for Completion as the case may
be there shall be assessed whether the number of delay days in that month is more than
(positive) or equal to (zero) or less than (negative) the expected wet days in that month.

(e) The positive, zero and negative monthly assessments made in accordance with sub-paragraph
(d) shall then be added together and a net total reached. If such total is a positive number then
such total shall constitute the extension of time for exceptionally inclement weather.

1.1.52 Insurance Policies

The Contractor shall warrant that the insurance policies issued in accordance with Clauses 27 and 28
of the Conditions shall include the following requirements :

(A) Insurance For Work Injury Compensation

(i) The Policy shall be approved policy from designated insurers as required under the Work
Injury Compensation Act or regulations.

(ii) The Contractor shall maintain the insurance to cover the date the Site is handed over to
the Contractor until the expiry of the Defects Liability Period under the contract.

(B) Insurance For Personal Injury And Property Damage

(i) The Policy shall be issued in the joint names of the Employer, the Contractor and all his
sub-contractors.

(ii) The limits of liability shall be read as follows :

(a) In respect of any one accident : $2,000,000.00

(b) Unlimited for the period of insurance

CE21/S1.DOC(21)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-22

1.1.52 Insurance Policies (Cont’d)

(B) Insurance For Personal Injury And Property Damage (Cont’d)

(iii) The period of insurance shall commence from the date the Site is handed over to the
Contractor and shall end upon expiry of the Defects Liability Period under the Contract.
The Policy shall firstly cover the whole of the original Time for Completion plus 6 months
and plus a further 12 months for Defects Liability Period.

(iv) The period of notice for cancellation of the Policy, if such period is stipulated, shall read
30 days.

(v) The Policy shall expressly include coverage of the following risks :

(a) Death, bodily injury or damage to property caused or occasioned by the Insured's
sub-contractors or by such sub-contractors' employees.

(b) Death, bodily injury or damage to property caused or occasioned by or connected


with or arising from the ownership, possession or use by or on behalf of the Insured
of any equipment or machinery not expressly specified in the Schedule of such
equipment or machinery.

(c) Liability assumed by the Insured by agreement, unless such liability would have
attached to the Insured notwithstanding such agreement.

(d) Liability in respect of loss or damage to property belonging to or in the charge or


control of the Insured or of any servant or agent of the Insured.

(e) Liability in respect of injury to or illness of any person or loss or damage to any
property or land or building caused by vibration or removal or weakening of support.

(f) Liability in respect of injury, illness, loss or damage caused by or connected with
or arising from any commodity, article or thing supplied, repaired, altered or treated
by or to the order of the Insured, happening at any of the Insured's premises.

(vi) The Policy shall expressly contain the following endorsements :

(a) "This Policy shall cover all the Contractor's insurance obligations with regard to
personal injuries or death and injury or damage to property real or personal
(including property of the Housing & Development Board but not the Works
themselves) arising out of or in the course of or by reasons of the carrying out of
the Works stated in the Contract between the Housing & Development Board and
the Contractor (name of Contractor to insert)"

(b) "Each of the parties comprising the Insured shall for the purpose of this Policy be
considered as a separate and distinct unit and the words "the Insured" shall be
considered as applying to such party in the same manner as if a separate policy
had been issued to each of the parties and the insurers hereby agree to waive all
rights of subrogation action which they may have or acquire against any of the
aforesaid parties arising out of any accident in respect of which any claim is made
hereunder provided nevertheless that nothing in this clause shall be deemed to
increase the limitation on extent of Insurer's liability in respect of any one accident
or series of accidents as stated in the Schedule".

(c) "This Policy is extended to cover the employees and/or representatives of the
Housing & Development Board, consultants, other professional parties and
Resident Technical Officer whilst on the contract site as third parties".

(d) "Notwithstanding anything stated in the Policy to the contrary, cover under the
Policy shall not be suspended in the event of stoppage of work by the Contractor
on the contract site from any cause for a period not exceeding 90 days. In the event
of partial or total cessation of work, the Insured shall use diligence and do all things
reasonably practicable to protect the insured property. Subject otherwise to the
Terms Exceptions and Conditions of this Policy".

(e) "All deductibles shall be borne by the Contractor".

CE21/S1.DOC(22)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-23

1.1.52 Insurance Policies (Cont’d)

(C) Insurance For Works

(i) The Policy shall be issued in the joint names of the Employer and the Contractor.

(ii) The Works insured shall read the project title given in the Employer's Letter of Acceptance.

(iii) The sum insured shall be the same as the Contract Sum.

(iv) The period of insurance shall commence from the date the Site is handed over to the
Contractor and shall end upon expiry of the Defects Liability Period under the Contract.
The Policy shall firstly cover the whole of the original Time for Completion plus 6 months
and plus a further 12 months for Defects Liability Period.

(v) The period of notice for cancellation of the Policy, if such period is stipulated, shall read
30 days.

(vi) The policy shall expressly contain the following endorsements :

(a) "This Policy shall cover all the Contractor's Works insurance obligations stated in
the Contract between the Housing & Development Board and the Contractor (name
of Contractor to insert)".

(b) "Notwithstanding anything stated in the Policy to the contrary, cover under the
Policy shall not be suspended in the event of stoppage of work by the Contractor
on the contract site from any cause for a period not exceeding 90 days. In the event
of partial or total cessation of work, the Insured shall use diligence and do all things
reasonably practicable to protect the insured property. Subject otherwise to the
Terms Exceptions and Conditions of this Policy".

(c) "All deductibles shall be borne by the Contractor".

1.1.53 Contract Documents On Site

The Contractor shall keep a complete set of the signed Contract documents described in the
Agreement; and a complete set of the further or revised Drawings and instructions referred to in the
Conditions, at the Site. The documents shall be made available for inspection and use by the
Superintending Officer, SO Rep and any other person authorised by the Superintending Officer in
writing.

1.1.54 Lightning Protection To Temporary Structures And Metal Structures

The Contractor shall ensure that all temporary structures such as site office, workers' quarters, site
canteen, carpenter and bar bending sheds, temporary structures with continuous metal such as steel
framework, scaffolding, tower cranes and batching plants and mobile machineries such as crawler
cranes and concrete pumps are adequately and effectively protected from lightning strike at all times.
The lightning protection system shall be in accordance with and complying with latest edition of
Singapore Standards SS 555 and/or any latest requirements by the Building and Construction Authority
(BCA).

Notwithstanding the provisions of latest provision of SS 555, reinforced concrete structure and
foundation shall not be used as lightning conductors or earth electrodes. Lightning conductors shall not
be embedded in any structural component and steel reinforcement shall not be used as part of the
protection system.

CE21/S1.DOC(23)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-24

1.1.55 Environmental Public Health Measures

(a) General Requirements

The Contractor shall allow for the compliance with the Environmental Public Health Act (hereafter
referred to as "the Act" for the purposes of this sub-clause) and its Subsidiary Legislations
including the Environmental Public Health (Employment of Environmental Control Officers) Order
1999, (hereafter referred to as "The Order" for the purposes of this sub-clause) and any
amendment or re-enactment thereto throughout the Time for Completion and any time period
where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract.

(b) Environmental Control Officer (ECO)

The Contractor shall employ Environmental Control Officer (ECO) to comply with the
Environmental Public Health Act - Environmental Public Health (Employment of Environmental
Control Officers) Order 1999. The ECO shall be employed on a full-time basis for Contract Sum
valued above $50 million or on a part-time basis for Contract Sum valued between $10 million
and $50 million. The ECO shall be responsible for monitoring and advising the Contractor on the
following main areas :

(i) Control of disease-bearing vectors and rodents.


(ii) proper management and disposal of solid waste.
(iii) Control of noise and dust pollution.
(iv) Drainage and silt control.
(v) Air and water pollution control.
(vi) General housekeeping management of the project.

The ECO shall conduct regular site checks and take prompt corrective actions to ensure that the
workers' quarters, canteens, toilets, site offices and other facilities and general surroundings of
the Site are kept clean, tidy and hygienic at all times. In addition, the ECO shall also ensure that
the Site is kept mosquito-free at all times.

Any Workplace Safety & Health Officer who is registered with the MOM under the Workplace
Safety & Health Officer Scheme and who is also registered as an ECO with the Director-General
of Public Health, NEA, can be allowed to hold both the appointment of Workplace Safety and
ECO concurrently for the Works at the Site provided that both officers' duties are performed with
the same standard of supervision as that performed by different officers holding such
appointment separately.

If the Works have been certified more than 95% complete, the contractor may write to NEA’s
Regional Office to seek approval to allow the ECO to perform on a part-time basis and copied to
SO rep. There shall be no cost recovery from the contractor if NEA is agreeable to allow the ECO
to perform on a part-time basis.

CE21/S1.DOC(24)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-25

1.1.56 Trade Subcontractors

The contractor must ensure that their appointed first-level sub-contractors have valid Building and
Construction Authority (BCA) or Ministry of Finance (MOF) registration at the time of appointment. If the
appointed first-level sub-contractor is registered with BCA, the contractor must ensure that the
appointed first-level sub-contractor is registered under the appropriate BCA workhead. The list of BCA
workheads can be obtained from BCA website at: http://www.bca.gov.sg/ContractorsRegistry/
contractors_registration_requirements.html

At least 14 days before the commencement of the Works by the subcontractors for the respective
trades, the Contractor shall submit the name of his subcontractors for the Works to the SO Rep. Where
the Contractor changes his subcontractor, he shall also submit such information to the SO Rep.

The Contractor shall be responsible for any eventual delay in the progress of the Works owing to his
failure to ensure the required on-time registration of his subcontractors and no extension to the Time
for Completion shall be granted on account of such delays.

1.1.57 Work On MRT Reserve Area

The Contractor shall provide and practise all precautionary measures for all works near or in within the
MRT reserve area. The Contractor shall comply to all requirements as required by the Land Transport
Authority for any extra precautionary construction activities to safe-guard the existing MRT
structures/property involved. The Contractor shall also provide the PE design details if required to
substantiate the work involved in the MRT Reserve area. All cost shall be borne by the Contractor and
shall be included in the Contract Sum.

The Contractor shall :

(a) Comply with all the general requirements of the Land Transport Authority and any other aspects
of the proposed development that may affect the MRT and its operation.

(b) The Contractor shall note the requirements for the works falls within the Land Transport
Authority’s Railway Protection and Safety Zones as defined in the MRT Railway Protection,
Restricted Activities Regulations 1994 or any amendment or re-enactment thereof. The
Contractor shall comply with all conditions and requirements imposed by Land Transport
Authority including the employment of Professional Engineer (Civil) to supervise all works within
the Railway Protection Zone, engaging a Professional Engineer (Mechanical) to check and certify
cranes and machinery, submission of plans to obtain clearance from Land Transport Authority
before commencement of works, monitoring instrumentation and all other related works. All
costs and expense are deemed to be included in the tender.

CE21/S1.DOC(25)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-26

1.1.58 Stationery For Resident Technical Officer

The Contractor shall provide stationery for use on site by the Employer's officers upon commencement
of the Works. The stationery to be provided shall be in accordance with the following schedule:

Item
Description Quantity
No.
1 Ball Point Pen (Black/Blue/Red) 2 no. each per Resident Technical Officer.

2 Correction Fluid 1 no. per Resident Technical Officer

3 Eraser (Pencil) 1 no. per Resident Technical Officer

4 Exercise Book - 60 pages 1 no. per Resident Technical Officer

5 Glue Tube 1 no. per Resident Technical Officer

6 Hard cover Book – A4 size 1 no. per Resident Technical Officer

Manila File 2 no.

8 Paper Clip :
a) Medium Size a) 2 boxes.
b) Large Size b) 2 boxes.

9 Pen Knife 2 no.

10 Pencil (2B) 2 no. per Resident Technical Officer.

11 Perforator 1 no.

12 Pocket Notebook 1 no. per Resident Technical Officer.

13 Ruler (300 mm) 1 no. per Resident Technical Officer

14 Scissors 1 no.

15 Staple (B3) 1 no.

16 Staples (B3) 1 no.

17 Calculator (without scientific functions) 1 no.

18 Highlighter of Assorted Colours 1 set

19 Scale Ruler 1 no.

20 Writing Pad (A4) 1 no. per Resident Technical Officer.

21 Ear Plugs 1 no. per Resident Technical Officer

22 Measuring Tape 1 no.

23 Measuring Tape of minimum 5 metre 1 no.


length
24 Rubber Stamp (Contract Details) 1 no.

25 Rubber Pad (Violet) 1 no.

Should the Contractor fails to provide any of the aforementioned stationery after the commencement
date of the Time for Completion, the SO Rep shall forthwith purchase and provide the same on the
Contractor's behalf and all costs and expenses for such purchase and provision plus charges shall be
recovered by the Employer from any monies due or becoming due to the Contractor or be recovered
as a debt due by the Contractor to the Employer.

CE21/S1.DOC(26)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-27

1.1.59 Earth Control Measures

The Contractor shall be responsible for preventing silt from being washed into public drains by
implementing effective Earth Control Measures (ECM) for the construction site to meet the requirements
under the latest Sewerage and Drainage Act Cap 294. (Information on ECM requirements can be found
in the Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage and the website www.pub.gov.sg/ECM). The
Contractor shall note that the ECM are for the containment and treatment of silty discharges due to the
impact of rainwater. ECM are not meant for the treatment of wastewater due to construction activities
(such as slurry from tunnelling, pipe-jacking and bore-piling works) which shall be treated to comply
with the requirements under Environmental Protection and Management Act (EPMA) (Chapter 94A).

The Contractor shall submit in his Tender, the schematic ECM plans of the Site for the whole of the
Time for Completion including any time periods where liquidated damages are imposed under the
Contract, taking into account the different phases of construction activities. He shall also provide the
name of the Qualified Erosion Control Professional (QECP) who will be endorsing the ECM plan after
the tender is awarded. These schematic ECM plans shall make the Contractor aware of the ECM
requirements to implement an effective ECM. Notwithstanding the submission of these schematic ECM
plans, the Contractor shall be deemed to have included all costs and expenses for complying with all
the ECM requirements in the Contract Sum

Before construction works commence on site, the Contractor shall engage a QECP to plan and design
the ECM, and he shall install the ECM according to the QECP's design. The ECM plan and design shall
be submitted 1 week after the award of the contract. During the course of the construction works, the
Contractor together with his QECP shall review the ECM proposal regularly to meet the changing needs
of the construction activities. The review shall be carried out on site at least once a month or at intervals
stipulated by the SO Rep. Records of the review shall be submitted to the SO rep. The Contractor shall
improve the ECM as advised by his QECP. The planning and design of the ECM shall meet the
minimum requirements stipulated and in accordance to the Code of Practice on Surface Water
Drainage.

The Contractor shall maintain the ECM for the whole duration of the Time for Completion including any
time periods where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract, to ensure that it is effective at
all times. Proper records detailing the maintenance works and ECM operation, supported by dated
photographs, shall be kept by the Contractor for verification. The records shall be made readily available
to the SO Rep.

The Contractor shall not remove the ECM until all works are completed and upon the advice of his
QECP.

The Contractor shall submit the ECM proposal duly endorsed by his QECP to PUB for records /
clearance. The proposed ECM shall consist of the following four parts:

(a) Project Particulars


The following information shall be provided under the Project Particulars:
(i) Project description;
(ii) Name and address of site occupier;
(iii) Site area and contract period;
(iv) Location map and site plan, and
(v) Construction phases and schedules

(b) Erosion Control Plan

(c) Sediment Control Plan

(d) Site ECM Management System

1.1.59.1 Erosion Control Plan

During construction, the Contractor shall minimize the formation of bare surfaces under the ECM's
Erosion Control Plan. The Plan shall depict graphically the activities, including sequence of work, type
and duration for each phase of construction activities to include the following measures to:

(a) sequence and schedule of the earthworks I demolition works in stages and progressively with
the subsequent construction activities and building works.

(b) minimise site disturbance by keeping site clearance works to a minimum by retaining as much of
the existing vegetation as possible.

(c) pave up the bare surfaces and all construction access by concrete or milled waste or other
suitable materials.
CE21/S1.DOC(27)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-28

1.1.59 Earth Control Measures (Cont’d)

1.1.59.1 Erosion Control Plan (Cont’d)

(d) protect the bare slopes with close-turfing, concrete grouting, or erosion control blanket.

(e) protect the earth stockpiles with erosion control blanket.

(f) restore ground cover over disturbed areas, which are or have become bare, as soon as possible.

(g) cover up the active work surfaces with canvas sheet during rain or at the end of the workday.

1.1.59.2 Sediment Control Plan

The Contractor shall put in place the ECM's Sediment Control Plan, which aims to capture the
sediments washed down from the construction sites. Some of these sediment control measures and
facilities, which must be in place before the works start, shall include but not limited to the following:

(a) concrete-lined cut-off drains (minimum C7 precast channel) along the perimeter of the
construction sites.

(b) silt fence properly installed and embedded onto the ground along the perimeter cut-off drains
(between the construction site and the cut-off drain).

(c) sedimentation basins or any other sediment filtering or settling system of adequate size and
sufficient numbers along the perimeter cut-off drain and before the discharge points into public
drain.

(d) a storage basin / tank may be required to temporarily store the large amount of rainwater falling
on to the whole site before treatment.

(e) a treatment system to treat silty discharge shall be provided before the discharge points into
public drain.

(f) turbidity curtains shall be installed along all the exposed slopes / riverbanks for works in or
adjacent to water bodies, such as canals, rivers, sea or in a reclamation work. The silty discharge
trapped within the turbidity curtain shall be allowed to be settled / treated and removed.

1.1.59.3 Site ECM Management System

The Contractor, shall at the advice of his QECP, put in place a site monitoring and reporting system
including but not limited to the following:

(a) Daily ECM inspection report by the ECM trained site staff

(b) Regular site inspection, ECM review and report by the QECP

(c) Continuous monitoring, recording system and alerts of the treated runoff quality and CCTV with
Silt Imagery Detection System shall be installed at the discharge point (after ECM) before existing
drain and drainage reserve / watercourses.

1.1.59.4 Submission Of Design Basis And Calculations

The QECP shall submit full basis of design back up with design calculations to show clearly how the
perimeter cut-off drains, silt fence, sedimentation basins, storage basin / tank and treatment system are
designed and sized as well as how such design will effectively filter off silt and allow only clean water
to discharge into public drains. The QECP shall also submit the design specifications on the treatment
system which can effectively treat the silty discharge from the construction site.

1.1.59.5 CCTV Requirements with Implementation of Silty Imagery Detection System (SIDS)

The Contractor shall note that ECM shall incorporate Closed Circuit Television (CCTV), continuous
monitoring system, silt fence, treatment plant, etc as and when stipulated by PUB such that no muddy
water, earth or construction materials shall be discharged into the existing drainage / watercourses
at all times.

CE21/S1.DOC(28)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-29

1.1.59 Earth Control Measures (Cont’d)

1.1.59.5 CCTV Requirements with Implementation of Silty Imagery Detection System (SIDS) (Cont’d)

PUB has revised the CCTV requirements to factor in the necessary requirements in order to integrate
the CCTVs with SIDS. The added requirements include painting a small sky blue background at the
discharge outlet as well as setting the CCTV image link for SIDS to grab real-time images from the
servers of the various CCTV vendors. Upon completion of the CCTV installation, the contractor,
with the necessary assistance from his CCTV vendor, would also need to complete and submit
a checklist comprising CCTV Installation and SIDS Interface details, to PUB.

The ECM for all the construction sites shall incorporate all PUB’s CCTV requirements with SIDS.

With SIDS providing the auto-detection and alerts, the contractors shall operate and maintain their
CCTV in good working order and prevent causing silty water discharge into the existing drainage /
watercourses at all times.

All costs to comply with PUB's requirements, including the revised CCTV requirements with
implementation of Silty Imagery Detection System (SIDS) providing the auto-detection and alerts, are
deemed to be included in the Tender Sum.

1.1.59.6 Requirements for Employment of Contractor’s Full Time Earth Control Measures Officer (ECMO)

The Contractor shall employ the site personnel with Earth Control Measures Officer (ECMO)
qualification and stationed them full time on site upon the approval from the SO Rep.

Upon their employment, the ECMO shall be full time on site throughout the construction period including
any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract, unless otherwise approved
by the SO Rep.

The Earth Control Measures Officer is to link up with the Contractor’s QECP, to supervise the operation
and maintenance of the ECM implemented on site, as well as to conduct daily checks on site.

The ECMO’s roles shall include:

(a) Implement ECM Plan according to QECP’s design;


(b) Devise ECM operations;
(c) Maintenance and inspection programme on site; and
(d) Assist the QECP to monitor ECM effectiveness throughout various stages of construction.

The ECMO need not to be the site personnel dedicated solely to perform the ECMO role. The ECMO
role could be covered by the site project manager, project supervisor, Environmental Control Officer
(ECO) or safety office, who has attained the ECMO qualification. The ECMO shall complete and pass
a 1-day ECM course conducted by IES or its affiliates and be registered as a ECMO under the IES
ECMO Registry.

CE21/S1.DOC(29)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-30

1.1.60 Electronic Submission For Progress Payments Claims And Request For Variation Works

The Contractor may be required to use an online web-based electronic submission system provided by
the Employer for the submission of the Monthly Claims for Progress Payment and Claim for
Authorisation / Variation Order (collectively and hereinafter known as e-submission system).

There will be no additional charges to be imposed by Employer for the use of the e-submission system.
If the Employer decided that the e-submission system is to be used, the Contractor shall at his own
expenses arrange to use e-submission system complying with the requirement hereinafter mentioned.

The e-submission system shall be Secured Socket Layer encrypted, password-protected with role-
based workflow security features at the document/form level and have an audit trail.

The e-submission system shall be accessible by all relevant users from the Employer, Superintending
Officer, SO Rep and Contractor concurrently and all data accessed shall be confined to the Project and
the relevant role and scope of works.

All relevant parties in the workflow shall be timely notified by email to complete their respective area of
work.

The e-submission system shall comprise the following modules:

(A) Monthly Claims For Progress Payment

This module allows the Contractor to submit online, the values of the monthly progressive valuation of
work completed for the assessment and certification of the SO Rep as hereinafter described but not
limited to the following:

(a) This module shall capture the monthly detailed breakdown of the scope of works and cost
information as specified in the Contract showing both the Contractor’s claims and the SO Rep’s
corresponding assessment in terms of individual percentage of work done for each work item.

(b) The validation rules shall apply to each item of claim and shall be based on the following rules
or such rules to be given by the SO Rep:

i. The SO Rep's certification should not be more than Contractor’s claim.


ii. The values submitted/certified for current month should not be less than previous
the month’s submission.

(c) The Contractor shall not be allowed to amend the SO Rep’s valuation and vice-versa.

(d) The following data shall be automatically uploaded each month into the e-submission system
and shall include but not limited to the following:

i. Nett Contract Sum (Less Provisional Quantities / Sums)


ii. Probable Actual Contract Value (Adjusted For Variation Orders)
iii. Contractor's Cumulative Total Claim (excludes Loss & Expense)
iv. Contractor's Nett Claim for Month (excludes Loss & Expense)
v. Total SO Rep's Estimated Value Computed (excludes Loss & Expense)
vi. Cumulative Certified Value of Work
vii. Value for each work category for apportionment under respective activity account
codes.

(B) Authorisation / Variation Order

This module shall include but not limited to the following:

(a) Allow the SO Rep to submit an Authorisation / Variation Order for the approval of the SO for
subsequent issue to the Contractor.

(b) Allow the SO Rep to issue to the Contractor an Authorisation Order.

(c) Allow the SO Rep to issue a Variation Order.

All the differences and/or disputes arising under this Clause (including questions relating to
interpretation) shall be determined by the Superintending Officer whose decision shall be final and
binding on and conclusive against the Contractor.

CE21/S1.DOC(30)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-31

1.1.61 Land Survey Services For CE Works

1.1.61.1 General Requirements For Land Survey Services

The contractor shall engage a registered surveyor at its own cost and expense to provide Land Survey
Services to facilitate construction works and to carry out surveys for record purposes or for submission
to authority as and when requested by HDB during construction and post construction stage.

The cost incurred shall include the purchase of information and equipment required for the survey
works. Statutory Board fees such as processing fees chargeable by Urban Redevelopment Authority
(URA) for application of Land and Strata subdivision and prescribed fees payable to the Chief Surveyor,
Singapore Land Authority (SLA), under the Boundaries and Survey Maps Act for the conduct of
Cadastral Survey of Land will be borne by HDB.

The Contractor shall be held fully responsible for the accuracy of all the survey works carried out by its
registered surveyor and for ensuring the works fully comply with the following ;

(a) The technical requirements and standards in the conduct of the surveys as specified in the
latest version of the Land Surveyors Board “Directive on Engineering and Hydrographic
Survey Practices”;

(b) The technical requirements and standards in the conduct of the surveys as specified in the
latest Singapore Land Authority (SLA) “CS Directive on Cadastral Survey Practices”;

(c) Circulars and Notices that are issued from time to time by the Chief Surveyor, Singapore,
SLA and Land Surveyors Board;

(d) All field works and office works are executed by the registered surveyor or qualified staff
under the Registered Surveyor direct supervision and direction;

(e) All documents and survey works pertaining to the survey are certified and dated by the
Registered Surveyor supervising the survey;

(f) The latest SLA’s Standard and Specifications for 3D Topographic Surveying (Mapping) in
Singapore;

(g) The Registered Surveyor shall verify SVY21 datum and establishment of ISN markers,
horizontal and vertical controls, at least 3 levels control benchmarks;

(h) Singapore Height Datum (SHD) in survey plans shall be 0.000m;

(i) All Registered Surveyors shall use the Singapore Height Datum in survey plans where
measurement of vertical distance from the Singapore Height Datum is involved. The
statement “Reduced Levels are based on Singapore Height Datum = 0.000m” shall be
shown in survey plans.

1.1.61.2 Engineering Survey Services

All forms of land survey services required for the purpose of facilitating the planning and construction
works or survey works requested by HDB in relation to the construction of the project are to be performed
by the contractor’s registered surveyor.
1.1.61.3 For Projects With Contract Sum Of $50 Million And More

For projects with contract sum of $50 million and more, the contractor’s Resident Surveyor or Lead
Surveyor performing land surveying works on site must be a registered Technical Member of Singapore
Institute of Surveyors & Valuers (SISV) from 1 Jan 2017 onwards.

CE21/S1.DOC(31)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-32

1.1.61 Land Survey Services For CE Works (Cont’d)

1.1.61.4 Setting Out Survey (Construction Stage)

The Contractor’s Registered Surveyor shall carry out survey setting out works including transferring and
protecting of all reference pegs for the smooth execution of work on a full time basis throughout the
Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract.
The Contractor shall be held fully responsible for the accuracy of such setting out.

1.1.61.5 Survey Of Completed Works (Post Construction Stage)

Prior to certification of completion of the Works, the Contractor’s Registered Surveyor shall carry out
"as-built" survey of the substantial completed works as directed by the SO Rep.

The survey includes the verification of SVY 21 datum and establishment of horizontal and vertical
controls, spot leveling, site features and boundaries details, establishment of at least 3 level control
benchmarks (TBM’s) near to the designated site, preparation of cadastral based map information for
overlaying onto the topographical plan, including the provision of digital files, DWG format, DGN format
and DTM site model in the format as specified by HDB.

Details of the surveys, where applicable;

(a) All visible details pertaining to the project are to be surveyed;

(b) For sewer work, the sewer alignment, the manhole cover levels and invert levels, the tumbling
bay & backdrop levels shall be surveyed. The type of manhole and direction of flow shall be
reflected in the plan;

(c) For drains work, the drain alignment, the invert levels and coping / top levels shall be surveyed
generally at 20m intervals. For cascading drain, the drops between upstream & downstream
levels shall be surveyed. Covered drains with iron grating shall be reflected in the plan;

(d) For roads work, the longitudinal alignment, the cross-sectional spot levels at centre, edges, and
sidetable at 20m intervals, at intersection and at all changes of grades shall be surveyed. Road
spot levels, scupper drains & drop-inlet chambers top and invert levels, shall be surveyed. Trees
along roadside table shall be surveyed and prescribed accordingly;

(e) Vertical and horizontal levels of corners of the roof of bus shelters, linkways, pedestrian
overhead bridges shall be surveyed;

(f) Saplings and trees where required shall be surveyed and described accordingly. Trees to be
surveyed including girth size, height and species;

(a) Road names, road signage, traffic markings, arrows, lanes, wordings, etc painted on roads
surface shall be surveyed.

(b) Street lamp posts and lamp posts number shall be surveyed and described accordingly;

(c) A Digital Terrain Model (DTM) site model shall be generated by the Contractor Registered
Surveyor. It shall be provided in Revit. format or any other format and version as specified by
HDB. The creation of DTM site model shall refer to the DTM layer as specified in Appendix C
under the latest version of SLA’s “Standard and Specifications for 3D Topographic Mapping in
Singapore”;

(d) The extent of the as built survey shall cover at least 10m beyond the contract boundary or half
of the road reserve width, whichever is applicable.

CE21/S1.DOC(32)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-33

1.1.61 Land Survey Services For CE Works (Cont’d)

1.1.61.6 Submission Of Survey Plans

The Registered Surveyor shall produce and submit the following to the SO Rep including subsequent
amendment, if any, for construction stage and post-construction stage respectively :

(a) Three CD ROMs each containing the DTM site model in the format as specified by HDB and
survey plans in both DWG format and DGN format;

(b) Inside the same three CD ROMs, the survey plans in pdf format. Every pdf format drawing shall
show Registered Surveyor’s endorsement on the plans;

(c) One set of A1 size hardcopy plans and A1 size tracings in 1:500/1:1000 scale with
Registered Surveyor’s endorsement.

The setting-out survey plans shall be submitted to the SO Rep not more than one (1) week prior to actual
commencement of the works.

The as-built survey plans shall be submitted to the SO Rep not more than four (4) weeks upon
certification of completion of the works.

Should the Contractor fail to carry out the survey within the stipulated time, the SO Rep reserves the
right to engage other surveyors to carry out the survey and preparation of survey plans. All costs and
expenses resulting from the Contractor's failure or arising thereof shall be recovered from the Contractor.

1.1.62 Disposal Of Artificial Obstruction And/Or Unexploded Explosive Ordnance (UXO)

In the event artificial obstructions and/or Unexploded Explosive Ordnance (UXO) are found during the
course of Construction Works, the Contractor shall immediately inform the Singapore Police Force
(SPF), relevant authorities and the SO Rep. He shall also immediately follow up on appropriate safety
measures and provision of security personal if required by SPF, relevant authorities and/or SO Rep to
ensure site safety.

If the discovered UXO is classified by SPF or relevant Authorities as “unsafe” to remove, the removal
shall be managed by SPF or relevant Authorities, working closely with the Contractor and/or SO Rep.

If the discovered UXO is classified by SPF or relevant Authorities as “safe” to remove, the Contractor
shall engage an Explosive Ordnance Disposal (EOD) specialist with Arms and Explosive (A&E) Licence
registered by the SPF to remove UXO. The EOD specialist shall investigate and identify the UXO
correctly, evaluate, classify and obtain necessary approvals / permits for removal, transfer, temporary
storage and disposal of UXO according to the requirements by the Authorities.

The contractor shall submit all the cost incurred in engaging EOD specialist for removal, transfer,
temporary storage and disposal of “safe” UXO to the Employer.

1.1.63 Deployment Of Portable Traffic Light System For Shared Right Of Way

The successful tenderer is to note the guidelines on the mandatory use of portable traffic light system
for shared right of way for all road works. This is to improve productivity by leveraging on technology.

The updated Code of Practice for Traffic Control at Work Zone can be downloaded in LTA website under
sub-sections, “Industry Matters”, “Development Building”, “Construction & Utility Works”, “Street
Proposals and Works on Public Streets”.

The manually-operated stop/go signs will no longer be allowed for such traffic control.

CE21/S1.DOC(33)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-34

1.1.64 Prohibition of Dogs in Construction Sites / Working Areas / TOL Sites

The Contractor shall not rear or keep dogs at the Site for any purposes or under any circumstances
whether or not the dogs are licensed with the relevant Authorities. The feeding of stray dogs beyond
contract boundary by any site personnel is also prohibited.

The Contractor shall be responsible for complying with this requirement and shall take the necessary
measures which include but not limited to the followings:

(a) Providing designated waste bins with covers for food waste disposal at worker rest areas and
other areas where workers will likely take their meals. The waste bins should remain closed at
all times to prevent dogs from foraging the disposed food.

(b) Ensuring that the waste collector remove the food waste from the Site on a daily basis.

(c) Putting up notices at prominent areas within the Site as well as on the external face of the
hoarding to remind workers and members of the public not to feed stray dogs.

(d) Having a system of regular site checks which should also cover the secluded spots within the
Sites where stray dogs could hide, such as under storage containers. The Contractor shall keep
a record of such checks indicating the days, time and names of site personnel conducting the
checks. The records shall be made accessible to HDB and the SO Rep upon request.

(e) Having a system of regular reminders to all site personnel (security guards (if any) inclusive) on
this requirement.

(f) Inform the relevant Authorities immediately for assistance if the presence of stray dogs is found
within or at the vicinity of sites.

If the Contractor is found to have breached the above requirement, the SO Rep may exercise his
contractual rights and impose demerit points and an administrative charge as specified in Clause on
“Nuisance And Irregularities”.

1.1.65 Deployment of Auxiliary Police Officers (APO)

The Contractor shall engage Auxiliary Police Officers as and when directed by the relevant Authorities,
with experience / track record to carry out traffic management on roads for all works, in compliance with
LTA’s requirements.

CE21/S1.DOC(34)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-35

1.2 MATERIALS - GENERAL

1.2.1 Metric Components

All components for incorporation into the Works shall be in metric units. However, when metric
components are not available, their equivalent in imperial units may, subject to the approval of the SO
Rep, be used and such substitution shall not constitute a variation to the Contract.

1.2.2 Materials And Workmanship

When directed, furnish the SO Rep with approved documents to prove that materials are as specified.
The documents shall include but not limited to any or all of the following, such that the authenticity of
the materials can be easily ascertained :

(a) shipping documents

(b) serial numbers

(c) warranty certificates

In the event that any documents submitted are not original copies, they shall be duly certified by the
originating parties. No information within the documents shall be tampered with, unless it is clearly
discernible that the items are not related to the materials specified in the Contract.

Where specific brand and model number are specified, or where alternative brands and model numbers
are offered by the Contractor and accepted by the SO Rep, it shall be deemed that the finished products
are entirely of original make by the registered Manufacturer and are fully supported by the
Manufacturer's warranty. In the event that any alteration is made to the goods by a local agent or any
other intermediary, the approval of the SO Rep shall be sought and the result of the alteration shall be
fully supported by the Manufacturer such that the Manufacturer's warranty is maintained.

All references to local or foreign standards and/or Codes of Practice shall be deemed to be inclusive of
the prevailing amendments to these standards and/or Codes of Practice.

Samples of materials shall be submitted to the SO Rep for approval before order is placed with the
supplier.

Such approval by the SO Rep shall not relieve the Contractor of its obligations under the Contract. The
Contractor shall ensure that the materials are free from any defects, damages or any other flaws.

1.2.3 Approval Of Samples And Trade Names

Where trade names or catalogue numbers are specified in the Specifications and/or shown in the
Drawings, they are intended only to serve as a guide to the respective type and quality of material
required. Other material proposed by the Contractor may be used subject to the prior approval of the
SO Rep. In this respect, the Contractor shall submit samples of the proposed material to the SO Rep
for approval.

CE21/S1.DOC(35)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-36

1.2 MATERIALS – GENERAL (CONT’D)

1.2.3 Approval Of Samples And Trade Names (Cont'd)

When a sample is approved by the SO Rep and subsequently work is carried out in accordance with
this approved sample, any cost difference resulting from the higher price of the approved sample as
compared with the price of the material as required and/or as shown shall not be payable to the
Contractor, unless the change of material is ordered by the SO Rep. With the exception of lighting
luminares, where the requirements for cost recovery are provided for differently, in the event that the
price of the approved sample is lower than that of the material as required and/or as shown, the cost
difference shall be recovered by the Employer by way of contract variation in accordance with the
following table :

Recovery (or Non-Recovery) by the Employer from the Contractor in the event that the price of the
approved material is lower than that of the material as required and/or as shown

Material proposed
Material as required
S/N by the Contractor and approved Cost Adjustment
and/or as shown
by the SO Rep

1. On the HDB Materials List On the HDB Materials List No cost recovery

)
2. On the HDB Materials List Not On the HDB Materials List
)
)
Not On the HDB Materials On the HDB Materials List
) Cost Recovery
3. List
) by the Employer
) from the
Not On the HDB Materials Not On the HDB Materials List
) Contractor
4. List
)
)
)
)

For lighting luminaires, in the event that the price of the approved sample is lower than that of the
material as required and/or as shown, the cost difference shall be recovered by the Employer by way
of contract variation regardless of whether or not the approved sample and/or the material as required
and/or as shown are shown in the HDB Materials List

For the purposes of this subclause only, the applicable HDB Materials List shall be the prevailing HDB
Materials List applicable at the time the Contractor submit the material for approval by the SO Rep.

Where cost recovery is required, the basis for such adjustment shall be the difference between the price
of the proposed material and that of the material as required and/or as shown (where one type of
material is specified) or that of the cheapest of the materials as required and/or as shown (where more
than one type of material is specified).

The Contractor shall point out to the SO Rep all items in the approved sample which do not comply with
the Specifications and/or Drawings.

Notwithstanding approval of the sample by the SO Rep, the Contractor shall be liable for any items in
the sample which do not comply with the Specifications and/or Drawings and which the Contractor has
failed to point out to the SO Rep.

Where the Contract requires the Contractor to obtain materials from the HDB Materials List or where it
is specified that materials provided are subject to the approval of the SO Rep, such requirements shall
not in any way affect, vary or relieve the Contractor's obligations under the Contract.

The Contractor shall ensure that the materials used or selected by them:
(a) are free from defects, damages or faults;
(b) are of merchantable quality and fit for their intended purpose; and
(c) comply with the Specifications and/or Drawings.

CE21/S1.DOC(36)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-37

1.2 MATERIALS – GENERAL (CONT’D)

1.2.4 Samples

Samples of materials specified and proposed to be provided shall be submitted for the approval of the
SO Rep as required. The SO Rep shall retain samples as and when approved by him and shall be at
liberty to reject all materials not corresponding with the approved samples.

1.2.5 Precautions Against Materials Being Taken Out Of Site

The Contractor shall be responsible for the safe custody of cement and all other materials delivered to
the Site and ensure adequate protection and prevention of such materials from being taken out of the
Site. The SO Rep will not accept any excuse for materials taken out of the Site by the Contractor, his
foreman or other individual even without the knowledge of the Contractor who shall be deemed to have
provided for proper control against such malpractice. If it is established that cement or any other
material is taken out of the construction site without specific written approval from the SO Rep, this shall
be deemed to be an irregularity and inter-alia, the right of the Contractor to compensation for price
fluctuations for all materials shall lapse.

1.2.6 Approval For Use Of Ready-Mixed Concrete

The Contractor shall obtain ready-mixed concrete from any of the pre-approved suppliers. Provide the
name and address of the ready-mixed concrete suppliers to the SO Rep. The use of ready-mixed
concrete shall be subject to the terms and conditions set by the SO Rep. All Delivery Orders for the
ready-mixed concrete delivered to the Site shall be endorsed by the Employer’s Resident Technical
Officer and submitted to the SO Rep.

CE21/S1.DOC(37)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-38

1.3 LABOUR

1.3.1 Labour Laws

Pay workmen promptly, and observe workmen's working hours and holidays in accordance with current
laws and regulations. Keep records and produce them for inspection by the SO Rep.

1.3.2 Keeping Records Of Workmen

The Contractor shall comply with all labour laws regarding the engagement of non-citizen workmen.
Work Permits from MOM must be obtained for these workmen. Liable for and indemnify the Employer
in respect of all actions against the Employer for employing foreign workmen without permits.

Keep proper records of all workmen engaged on Site. These records shall include the following
information :

(a) Name of Workmen (and alias if any)

(b) Identity Card No./Passport No.

(c) Address

(d) Work Permit No., if any

(e) Expiry date of work permit

This information must be recorded before any workman is allowed to commence duty. Severe action
will be taken by the SO Rep if the Contractor fails to record any of the abovementioned information of
any worker found at the Site.

1.3.3 Employment Of Illegal Immigrants

For the purpose of this subclause, "illegal immigrant" means any person who enters the Republic of
Singapore in contravention of the provisions of the Immigration Act or any statutory modification or re-
enactment thereof.

The Contractor shall ascertain the legitimacy of all Foreign Workers employed by any sub-contractor
prior to employment and throughout the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated
damages are imposed under the Contract. Clarifications as to the legitimacy of Foreign Workers may
be made with the Immigration Authority, the Ministry of Manpower and/or Police.

Ensure that no illegal immigrants are employed by him and/or any sub-contractor in the execution of
the Works. The Employer shall not be responsible for any such act or acts by the Contractor and/or
any of his sub-contractors and the Contractor shall indemnify the Employer for all consequences arising
thereof.

1.3.4 Employment Of Civil Engineers

The Contractor shall employ Civil Engineers with recognised and approved engineering degree or
professional diploma acceptable for registration with the Professional Engineers' Board, to supervise
the Works and manage the Site on a full-time basis throughout the Time for Completion and any time
period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract. The said Civil Engineers shall be
stationed on Site on a full-time basis and shall be expected to manage the project efficiently and ensure
a high standard of workmanship and site organisation.

CE21/S1.DOC(38)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-39

1.3 LABOUR (CONT’D)

1.3.4 Employment Of Civil Engineers (Cont'd)

The number of Civil Engineers to be employed for the purpose of this subclause shall be in accordance
with the following table :

Number of Civil
Type of Contract Contract Sum Engineers to be
employed per Contract

Roads, Carparks, Sewers,


Drains, Bridges,
More than or equal to $3.0 million 1
Earthworks & Other
Related Works

Less than or equal to $50 million 2

More than $50 million but less than or 3


Reclamation
equal to $100 million

More than $100 million 5

Less than or equal to $40 million 2

More than $40 million but less than or 3


Bored & Steel Piling
equal to $60 million

More than $60 million 4

All contracts regardless of Contract 1


Soil Investigation
Sum Value

Include in the Contract Sum all costs and expenses to be incurred for compliance with the requirements
stipulated in this subclause.

In the event of the Contractor not employing the number of engineers required by the Contract or not
employing such engineers for the period or periods required by the Contract, without prejudice to the
Employer's rights under the Contract, the Contractor shall be indebted to the Employer at the rate of
$6,400 per month per engineer not employed and such indebtedness shall be deducted by the
Employer from any monies due or becoming due to the Contractor or be recovered by the Employer as
a debt due from the Contractor. This rate shall be deemed to have been fully agreed and accepted by
the Contractor and the Employer as the cost and expense allowed by the Contractor for the employment
of an engineer for each month. For the purpose of this subclause a Civil Engineer shall be employed
by the Contractor for at least 20 days within a calendar month before he can be considered as being
employed for that particular month under the Contract. In the event that the first and last calendar
month of the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under
the Contract have less than twenty days, the Civil Engineers shall be employed for the full number of
days in the said first and last calendar month.

Notwithstanding other provisions in this subclause, if the Contractor incurs additional cost and expense
over and above the agreed rate specified herein in complying with the requirements stipulated in this
subclause, the Contractor alone shall bear such additional cost and expense in full.

Submit to the SO Rep within one month from the date of the Letter of Acceptance, the names, identity
card numbers and documentary evidence of the educational qualifications of the said Civil Engineers.
The employment of the said Civil Engineers shall be subject to the approval of the SO Rep.

CE21/S1.DOC(39)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-40

1.3 LABOUR (CONT’D)

1.3.4 Employment Of Civil Engineers (Cont'd)

In addition, fulfill the following requirements :

(a) The Civil Engineers employed shall be on the Contractor's monthly payroll. Keep records
indicating the number of days the engineers are employed for each month and the monthly
contributions to CPF. Such information may be proof of employment of the Civil Engineers and
shall be submitted to the SO Rep upon request;

(b) A letter from every Civil Engineer employed shall be submitted to the SO Rep to testify that he
is employed full-time for this Contract only;

(c) Further to (b) above, if any Civil Engineer is found supervising more than one running contracts,
the particular Civil Engineer will be barred from supervising all the Employer's contracts for a
period of two years from the date of the breach.

It shall be the Contractor's duty to bring to the attention of the engineers the requirements of this
subclause.

The SO Rep may consider request by the Contractor in writing to release his Civil Engineer from the
obligation of this subclause if the Contract has been certified more than 95% complete. It shall be up
to the absolute discretion of the SO Rep to decide whether the Contractor's Civil Engineer can be
released and the number of Civil Engineers to be released from the Contractor's contractual obligation
under this subclause. A written approval from the SO Rep shall be obtained in this respect.

All differences and/or disputes arising under this subclause (including questions relating to
interpretation) shall be determined by the Superintending Officer whose decision shall be final and
binding on and conclusive against the Contractor.

CE21/S1.DOC(40)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-41

1.4 CONSTRUCTION EQUIPMENT

1.4.1 Maintenance Of Construction Equipment

All Construction Equipment provided to the Site shall be kept in good working order at all times and the
Contractor shall comply with all statutory regulations in relation to the said Construction Equipment.

During the progress of the Works, the Contractor shall put the Construction Equipment to proper use
and carry out regular maintenance to avoid any breakdown. No extension of Time for Completion shall
be granted for any breakdown or misuse of the Construction Equipment.

(a) Mobile Crane

Before operating a mobile crane on the Site, the Contractor shall submit the following:

(i) Record of latest overhaul servicing of the crane. The latest overhaul servicing of the crane shall
be conducted within one year before transferring it to the Site;

(ii) Record of checking the connecting devices between parts/components and the condition of the
parts/components by an Authorised Examiner. Any Defect found in the checking shall be rectified
immediately; and

(iii) Certificate of test/thorough visual examination of the lifting equipment by the Authorised
Examiner.

The Contractor shall maintain the crane in good working order at all times on the Site. Document and
keep all records and certificates of checking and testing in the site office for inspection by the SO Rep
upon request. The Contractor shall:

(i) Required a licensed crane operator to check the crane daily before operation. The licensed crane
operator shall have a Certificate of Competence;

(ii) Engage a competent mechanic to conduct servicing of the crane once in every three months:
and

(iii) Engage the Authorised Examiner to carry out test and visual examination on the crane once in
every six months.

(b) Authorised Examiner

For the purposes of this Clause including all related clauses, the Authorised Examiner is any person
who is approved by the Commissioner for Workplace Safety and Health of the Ministry of Manpower by
a Certificate in writing for the purpose of carrying out examinations and tests on lifting equipment in
accordance with the Workplace Safety & Health (General Provisions) Regulations.

1.4.2 Contractor's Construction Equipment

All mechanical Construction Equipment used in the execution of the Works shall be of such type, size
and of such method of working as the SO Rep shall approve.

The approval by the SO Rep for the use of mechanical Construction Equipment will not be unreasonably
withheld, but if in the opinion of the SO Rep, any circumstances which make it desirable that the use of
a Construction Equipment should be suspended either temporarily or permanently, the Contractor shall
change the method of performing the Works affected at his own cost and expense and he shall be
deemed to have no cause for claim against the Employer on account of having to carry out the Works
by another method nor shall he be deemed to have cause for claim if any other instruction issued by the
SO Rep results in the mechanical Construction Equipment having either to stand idle for a period of any
duration whatsoever or to be removed.

This sub clause shall apply also to Construction Equipment which, in the opinion of the SO Rep, are not
as quiet in operation as warranted by the circumstances.

Use every possible means to prevent noise and annoyance to the residents of the neighbourhood in
which the Works and the Contractor's worksites are situated and all Construction Equipment and
machinery shall be of such design and so arranged to be reasonably free of noise in working.

CE21/S1.DOC(41)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-42

1.4 CONSTRUCTION EQUIPMENT (CONT’D)

1.4.2 Contractor's Construction Equipment (Cont'd)

In the event of air compressors or pneumatic tools being used on the Works, if and when required,
arrange for such compressors or tools to be fitted with silencers of approved design or adopt other
means approved by the SO Rep for the purpose of reducing noise as far as possible.

The Contractor shall not be allowed to make any extra claim for work or cost and expense incurred in
complying with the requirements of this subclause.

(a) Lorry Crane

All lorry cranes deployed to HDB worksites shall be equipped with Stability Control System (SCS).

During the operation of the crane, the SCS shall:

(i) Continuous monitor the stability of the lorry crane such as detection of its outriggers position and
the weight of the load it is carrying; and

(ii) Upon detection of any unsafe situation such as over-moment or instability of the lorry crane,
immediately prohibits further operation of the crane, except to allow manoeuvring to bring the
crane into the safe zone.

The SCS shall be equipped with both visual and audio alarm to warn operator and persons in the vicinity
of the crane when the SCS detects any unsafe situation.

The SCS shall be tamper-proof, and not be easily bypassed.

The SCS shall be designed such that in the event of sensors or system failure, the crane shall not be
able to operate until the fault has been rectified.

1.4.3 Movement Of Construction Equipment

All heavy machinery and other Construction Equipment, such as excavator, grader, mixer etc required
for the Works shall not be removed from Site without approval from the SO Rep notice. If progress of
work is held up due to the absence of certain particular machinery, the Employer shall be at liberty to
bring in the required machinery from other sources and the cost and expense thus incurred plus the
Employer's charges shall be recovered from monies due or becoming due to the Contractor or as a debt
due by the Contractor to the Employer.

1.4.4 Age limit for Mobile Crane and Barge Crane

The age of the mobile and barge crane used on the Site shall not exceed 15 years.

CE21/S1.DOC(42)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-43

1.5 SAFETY

1.5.1 Site Safety Measures

The Contractor shall ensure that the requirements of the Regulations and the following requirements
are strictly complied with at all times :

(a) General Requirements

The Contractor shall allow for the compliance with the Workplace Safety And Health Act
(hereafter referred to as the “the Act” for the purposes of this clause including all subclauses
under it) and its Subsidiary Legislations including the provisions of the Workplace Safety and
Health (Construction) Regulations (hereafter referred to as the “the Regulations” for the purposes
of this clause including all subclauses under it) and any amendment or re-enactment thereto.

The subsidiary legislations are:-


a) The Workplace Safety and Health (General Provisions) Regulations
b) The Workplace Safety and Health (Registration of Factories) Regulations
c) The Workplace Safety and Health (First-Aid) Regulations
d) The Workplace Safety and Health (Exemption) Order
e) The Workplace Safety and Health (Composition of Offences) Regulations
f) The Workplace Safety and Health (Incident Reporting) Regulations
g) The Workplace Safety and Health (Risk Management) Regulations
h) The Workplace Safety and Health (Workplace Safety and Health Officers) Regulations

Precedent to the commencement of the Works, the Contractor shall first obtain a Certificate Of
Registration, under the Act and its subsidiary legislation, The Workplace Safety And Health
(Registration Of Factories) Regulations

It shall be the duty of the Contractor to comply with all such requirements of the Act and its
Subsidiary Legislation, as affect him or any person or persons employed by him, and as related
to any work, act or operation performed or about to be performed by him. The Contractor shall
not permit any person to do anything not in accordance with the generally accepted principles of
safe and sound practice.

The Contractor shall ensure a safe environment on the Site at all times. All safety provisions
shall be properly maintained and shall not be removed without the written approval of the SO
Rep. Ensure that necessary and sufficient precautions are taken by the workmen when safety
provisions are used. The Contractor shall not allow any of the safety provision to be used, unless
he has satisfied himself that the provision is safe. The Contractor shall submit a Safety
Management Programme to the SO Rep within 14 days from the date of the Letter of Acceptance
for approval prior to the commencement of the Works. The submission of the Safety Management
Programme shall comply with and kept in the site office and made available for reference at all
times.

The Contractor shall display safety posters at the site office, site canteen, exit/entry points of
buildings, passenger cum material hoist area and storage area.

The Contractor shall submit drawings, detailing and calculation for all temporary structures as
required, certified by the Contractor's professional engineer for approval at least one week before
the commencement of the Works unless otherwise specified. The approval of the SO Rep shall
not relieve the Contractor and his professional engineer of the need to ensure the adequacy and
sufficiency of the safety provisions.

The Contractor is deemed to have allowed in the Contract Sum for all costs and expenses of the
safety provisions and for all additional costs that may arise from amendments to the Act and its
Subsidiary Legislation or changes in the requirements of MOM and the HDB.

CE21/S1.DOC(43)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-44

1.5.1 Site Safety Measures (Cont'd)

(b) Personal Protective Equipment

The Contractor shall provide and maintain suitable personal protective equipment to all workmen
employed on the Site. The Contractor shall ensure that such personal protective equipment
comply with the requirements of the Regulations. The Contractor shall also ensure that all
equipments are properly used by his workmen during the course of their work. The Contractor
shall record the issuance of all equipment to the workmen in the prescribed forms and such forms
shall be kept in the site office and made available for inspection at all times. The colour code of
the safety helmets provided by the Contractor shall comply with the requirements of the
Regulations. Three mirrors of sizes 600mm x 1500mm are to be installed for workers to check
their personal protective equipment during Tool Box Meeting. The location of these mirrors shall
be approved by the SO Rep.

(c) Protective Hoardings And Covered Footways

The Contractor shall erect and maintain all protective hoardings, covered pedestrian footways,
cross bridges with proper handrails and fencing where the SO Rep considers it necessary. It
shall be constructed in accordance with the design and drawings of his professional engineer
and to the requirements of the BCA. During the hours of darkness, the hoardings, covered
footways and fencing erected along roads shall be provided with suitable warning lights. The
hoardings, footways and fencing shall be cleared away on Substantial Completion of the Works
or upon the approval of the SO Rep.

(d) Authorised Operators For Machinery and Vehicles

The Contractor shall employ only qualified operators for his site machinery. The operator for the
machinery shall possess a Skill Evaluation Certificate (SEC) from an accredited training provider
or other approved training centre. For those machinery where accredited training providers do
not conduct courses or practical tests for machinery operator, the Contractor shall only authorise
an experienced and trained operator who has at least a minimum of 2 years experience in
operating the machinery.

In the case of vehicles, which are operated within the contract boundary, the authorised operator
shall possess a minimum valid Class 3 driving licence from the Registrar of Vehicles (Singapore)
or its equivalent from their originating countries. The equivalent of a minimum Class 3 driving
licence shall first be verified by the respective embassy in Singapore and thereafter submitted to
the SO Rep for approval.

The Contractor shall record the particulars of the operators for the machinery and vehicles in the
prescribed form and submit to the SO Rep for approval one week before the commencement of
the Works. The prescribed form shall be updated and keep on the Site and made available for
inspection at all times.

(e) Safety Guards

Provide safety guards to all moving machine parts that are likely to injure a workman.

(f) Workplace Safety & Health Co-ordinator/Workplace Safety & Health Officer

The Contractor shall employ Workplace Safety & Health Co-ordinator/Workplace Safety
& Health Officer with recognised and approved certification in construction safety to take
charge of all matters related to safety on a full-time basis throughout the Time for
Completion and any time where liquidated damages are imposed under the contract. The
said Workplace Safety & Health Co-ordinator/Workplace Safety & Health Officer shall
spend their time fully on the Site and perform the following :

(i) To supervise safety and promote safety conduct;

(ii) To inspect and rectify any unsafe place of work;

(iii) To correct any unsafe practice; and

(iv) To ensure that the provisions of the Workplace Safety & Health Act and its
Subsidiary Legislation made thereunder are complied with.

CE21/S1.DOC(44)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-45

1.5.1 Site Safety Measures (Cont'd)

(f) Workplace Safety & Health Co-ordinator/Workplace Safety & Health Officer (Cont'd)

The number of Workplace Safety & Health Co-ordinator/Workplace Safety & Health Officer to be
employed for the purpose of this Clause shall be in accordance with the following table :

Number of Each Type of Personnel to be Employed Fully Agreed &


Based On Contract Sum Accepted Rate by
the Contractor &
Exceeding the Employer for
Type of Exceeding Exceeding Exceeding the Cost & Expense
$75 Million
Personnel Not $10 Million $25 Million $50 Million Exceeding Deemed to be
But Not
Exceeding But Not But Not But Not $100 Allowed for by the
Exceeding
$10 Million Exceeding Exceeding Exceeding Million Contractor for the
$100
$25 Million $50 Million $75 Million Employment of
Million
Each Personnel
Workplace
Safety & $4,500 per Site
Health One One Two Two Three Three Safety Supervisor
Co- per month
ordinator
Workplace
$5,000 per
Safety &
One One One One One One Registered Safety
Health
Officer per Month
Officer

The Contractor is required to employ a full time Workplace Safety & Health Officer to comply with
the requirements under the Workplace Safety & Health (WSH Officers) Regulations. The
Workplace Safety & Health Officer shall implement appropriate safety measures and ensure a
safe work environment and a safe work procedure in accordance with the Workplace Safety &
Health Act and Subsidiary Legislation including the provisions of the Workplace Safety & Health
(Construction) Regulations 2007 and the requirements under the contract.

(g) Metal Scaffolding

All metal scaffolding used shall comply with the requirements of the Regulations. The
cantilevered platform for the metal scaffolding shall be erected according to the Drawings of the
Contractor's PE. The drawings shall be submitted to the SO Rep for approval at least one month
before the erection of the metal scaffolding. Working platforms, overlay or screening debris nets
and barricades to the open sides of the buildings shall be incorporated into the scaffolding. The
installation of the net shall follow the erection of the scaffold closely. There shall be no opening
between separate sets of the net and any torn net shall be replaced or repaired immediately.

The net shall comply with the following requirements :

(i) Maximum mesh size(square):15mm

(ii) Twine No: minimum 350D

(iii) Knot type : single or English knot

(iv) Minimum: 12 ply

All tiebacks for the scaffold shall be painted with a bright colour for easy identification. The
scaffold and any components therein shall be erected, or substantially extended to or dismantled
by scaffold erectors, under the immediate supervision of a qualified and competent scaffold
supervisor according to the Regulations. The scaffold and its component shall only be dismantled
and removed after the SO Rep has given his permission.

All metal access scaffolds shall be prezinc galvanised or other approved by the SO Rep. The SO
Rep may at his discretion select samples of the scaffold frames at the Site for testing to ensure
compliance with relevant standards. The testing schedule of the scaffold components are shown
in the Schedule Of Material Tests (CE Works) in the Supplementary Specifications.

CE21/S1.DOC(45)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-46

1.5.1 Site Safety Measures (Cont'd)

(h) Safety Training

(i) Safety Orientation Course

The Contractor shall employ workmen who possess valid Safety Orientation Course
Certificates. The Contractor shall be required to ensure that his workmen attend a
prescribed safety refresher course at an interval of time to be decided by the SO Rep.

(ii) Safety Training Course

When directed by the SO Rep, the Contractor shall at its own cost and expense also send
all his employees/staff as stipulated hereunder to accredited training providers for
appropriate safety training as shown hereunder :

• Safety Training Courses Conducted By MOM Accredited Training Providers

Course Applicable to
Specialist Diploma in Workplace
Safety and Health / Workplace Safety Personnel for registration as
Safety & Health Officer Workplace Safety & Health Officer(WSHO)
(WSHO)Training Course
Construction Safety Course for Chairman of Safety Committees,
Project Managers Project Managers, Engineers
Chairman of Safety Committees, Managers,
Safety Management Course
Engineers and Supervisory Staff
Advanced Certificate in Workplace
Workplace Safety and Health Coordinator
Safety and Health
Training Course for Safety
Safety Committee Members
Committee Members
Building Construction Safety Building Construction Foremen and
Supervisor Course Supervisors
SIC (Manhole) for Supervisors Supervisors
Lifting Supervisors Safety Course Supervisors and Foremen
Industrial First Aid Course Workers, Safety Personnel and Supervisors
Industrial First Aid Refresher
Trained First Aiders
Course
Crawler Crane Operator Course :
- New Entrant Programme
Crane Operators
- Refresher Programme
- Familiarisation Programme
Erection of Metal Scaffold Erectors
Slingers/Riggers Course Workers, Foremen and Supervisors
Tower Crane Operator Course :
- New Entrant Programme Crane Operators
- Familiarisation Programme
Supervision of Metal Scaffold
Supervisors
Erection
Climbing Work Platform Operation Supervisors, Workers and Operators
Explosive Powered Tools
Workers and Operations
Operation

Particular attention shall be given to the needs of young employees/staff. Further training
shall be required where :

- Employees/staff are transferred or where employees/staff take on new responsibilities


or where a change in the work activity or work environment could arise; and

- There is a change in the work equipment or systems of work in use.

Training shall be repeated periodically to ensure continued competence.

CE21/S1.DOC(46)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-47

1.5.1 Site Safety Measures (Cont'd)

(i) Warning Signboards, Cones And Lights

The Contractor shall display warning signs of sizes 900mm x 600mm at strategic points around
the periphery of the Site where trespassing is likely to occur. Such signs shall have the words
"DANGER - KEEP OUT" in the four official languages painted in red on a white background in
gloss finishing paint. Warning lights shall be placed at similar positions at night to serve as a
warning. In addition, the Contractor shall display "SAFETY FIRST" signs at the Site.

If work is carried out near public roads, all signage shall comply with the recommendations of
Code of Practice for Temporary Traffic Control issued by the LTA.

(j) Temporary Roads Signing

Works carried out at or near gazetted roads shall comply with LTA Temporary Traffic Control
recommendations.

(k) Electronic Distance Meter

Unless otherwise directed, use Electronic Distance Meter in the measurement of distances over
public roads and in built-up areas accessible to the public where the use of measuring tapes may
pose a danger to motorists and members of the public.

(l) Safety Reflective Apparel (High Visibility Warning Clothing)

All workmen engaged in any type of work on public roads shall wear approved type of reflective
apparel during all hours of the day and night when so engaged.

The Contractor shall also issue safety reflective apparels (with HDB logo) to the Resident
Technical Officer and supervising engineers on site.

The approved types of apparel shall be :

(i) sleeveless vests covering the top half of the body with or without perforations for wear
comfort; and

(ii) Design

The design shall be lightweight and cool, and of 100% polyester knit fabric or woven mesh.
The vest shall be fluorescent lime yellow embossed with organization identification/logo.
The retro-reflectivity of the double vertical and horizontal bands shall comply with
European Standard EN 471 Class 2 for high-visibility warning clothing.

(iii) Application

All personnel working on or near the road shall put on the vest to make them more
conspicuous and to warn road users of their presence. Only fluorescent lime yellow shall
be used on a work zone for ease of identification.
Summary

Visibility Enhancing Devices

Safety Reflective Apparel


No. Type
(High Visibility Warning Clothing)

1 Size Per requirement

2 Colour HDB's staff and contractor's supervisors : Fluorescent lime


yellow.
Contractors' workers : Fluorescent lime yellow
3 Reflectivity EN 471 Class 2

4 Material 100% polyester mesh

5 Standard EN 471 Class 2

CE21/S1.DOC(47)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-48

1.5.1 Site Safety Measures (Cont'd)

(m) Ventilation

Provide adequate ventilation and efficient safety and protective equipments to keep all
excavations, trenches, tunnels and heading structures, sewers and manholes free from all gases
whether generated in the strata, arising from the use of explosives for blasting, sewage gases or
otherwise and take precautions to ascertain that conditions are safe before allowing workmen to
proceed.

No person shall enter any confined space (whether above or below ground) unless a responsible
person has tested the space using an oxygen testing instrument and has certified to the
satisfaction of the SO Rep and Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB that the space
is suitable to enter.

For work in sewers, pumping mains, manholes, chambers, sumps and other confined spaces,
ensure that the following safety procedures are adhered to :

(i) Safety And Protective Equipment

Provide the following equipment for the safety and protection of the workmen at the work
Site before the commencement of any work. Ensure that all workmen are familiar with
the use of all safety and protective equipment required :

Safety Apparatus - Multi-gas monitor, lifting harness, torch light, first aid kit, life
lines, aluminium ladder, air blower, breathing apparatus,
oxygen meter;

Protective Equipment - Safety belt, safety helmet and gloves, knee length rubber
boots, overall, illuminous vest;

Other Equipment - Portable air blower, traffic warning lights and signs
and Tools barricades, pedestrian warning signs, manhole gratings,
non-sparking tools, flame proof lights;

(ii) Preparatory Work

Identify the position of the nearest telephone so that in the event of an emergency, help
can be summoned immediately.

Do not allow smoking or naked light or fire in the vicinity of any manhole or chamber.

Place proper barricades and traffic warning signs around the working manhole. For safety
of the public, place proper gratings over manholes that are opened.

Where a sewer is at a downstream of a pump main discharge chamber, obtain prior


clearance with the Pumping Station Unit. During the course of the work in this sewer,
maintain close co-ordination with the Pumping Station Unit to ensure non-operation of the
pumping station.

CE21/S1.DOC(48)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-49

1.5.1 Site Safety Measures (Cont'd)

(m) Ventilation (Cont'd)

(iii) Before Entering Manholes And Chambers

Remove the cover of the working manhole and those immediately upstream and
downstream to provide ventilation and to serve as emergency exits. Provide manhole
gratings for public safety.

Use air blowers of adequate capacity (min flow rate of 1200 m3 per hour) for ventilation.
Place the blower as far as possible from the working manhole and vehicles exhausts and
operate for a sufficient time to ensure that all gases are driven out.

Test for the presence of gases by lowering the multi-gas monitor into the manhole. Do
not enter the manhole if the multi-gas monitor indicates dangerous conditions. Inspecting
team shall carry Multi-gas monitor in the sewer.

Test oxygen deficiency. (The oxygen level must be maintained above 19% but not
exceeding 23%).

No workmen shall enter the manhole or sewer if they detect smell or if they feel giddy or
suspicious even if safe conditions are indicated in the tests above.

If a manhole is safe to enter, wear safety belt, helmet and protective footwear before
entering. Allow no person to enter a manhole or sewer alone. Detail at least two men as
top men. The top men shall carry breathing apparatus.

The supervisor shall keep count of his men before entering the sewer.

Use ladders for access into or out of any manhole which exceeds 1m deep. Allow only
one man on a ladder at one time.

If aluminium alloy ladder is used, provide the ladder with non-slip rungs to prevent slipping.
Wooden ladder shall not be used.

(iv) While Men Are In Manholes Or Sewers

Do not allow any workman to work in a sewer alone. Use lifelines when working in sewers.

The top man shall keep in touch with the men below by calling or signalling at frequent
intervals.

If dangerous conditions are encountered or if danger is suspected then the men below
shall return to the surface immediately through the nearest manhole.

During the whole of the time that the men are below ground, maintain proper and adequate
ventilation.

No smoking or naked light in manholes or sewers shall be allowed.

Wear safety belts and helmets at all times while working inside manholes and sewers.

Test the air inside a manhole or sewer continuously with the use of "personal gas monitor"
by those working below. The gas monitor shall be capable of measuring the concentration
of Carbon Monoxide, Oxygen, Hydrogen Sulphide and combustible gases.

Where the sewers are large enough to enter, keep guard bars or safety chains in position
across the sewer downstream of the place of work.

Where natural light is not adequate, use only artificial light of the explosive proof type.

(v) After Working In Sewers Or Manholes

The supervisory staff in charge shall check carefully that all men have left the sewer or
manhole. Replace properly all manholes or sumps cover.

CE21/S1.DOC(49)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-50

1.5.1 Site Safety Measures (Cont'd)

(m) Ventilation (Cont'd)

(vi) In An Emergency

Inform the Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB and the HDB's Safety Unit in
the event of an emergency.

(n) Housekeeping

Maintain and ensure a safe working environment by keeping the Site neat and tidy and free from
all hazards and debris. Materials shall be stacked up safely. All the material storage area are
to be barricaded. All workstations and accesses thereto shall be kept free from hazards and
debris. The Contractor shall submit such housekeeping technique to the SO Rep for approval at
least one month before commencement of Works.

Housekeeping shall be carried out in such a manner and at such times as not to cause any
inconvenience to either the adjoining owners, occupiers and the public. Debris shall be wet to
minimize the risk of dust. Containers for debris and rubbish are to be provided at the designated
places.

(o) Barricades To Lift Openings, Voids, The Open Sides Of Buildings And Excavations

The Contractor shall barricade all lift openings, internal voids and the open sides of buildings and
excavations where a person is liable to fall. The barricade shall be at least 1.1m high with 90mm
high toeboard and shall have sufficient strength and rigidity to withstand a lateral point load of 50
kg. All services opening shall be fully covered and secured to prevent unauthorised removal.

(p) Prefabricated Mesh Barricade

The Contractor shall provide, erect and maintain a vertical prefabricated mesh barricade
(hereafter referred to as “mesh barricade” for the purpose of this clause including all subclauses
under it) for all peripheral open sides of construction level of building (excluding multi-storey
carpark/garage) where a person is liable to fall from height. Metal access scaffold and working
platforms shall be maintained for multi-storey carpark/garage where a person is liable to fall from
height. Mesh barricade shall be of sound construction and produced in the factory and installed
at the construction level from the inside of the building. Mesh barricade and its support shall be
prezinc galvanised or other approved equivalent by the SO Rep, easily installed and dismantled,
and reusable throughout the construction (super-structure) stage. External works of the building,
such as painting, touching up works, repair and redecoration, and other minor works, shall be
carried out using mechanical suspended scaffold or other vertical access equipment.

Where the use of mesh barricade is not feasible, as interpreted by SO Rep, during the
construction (super-structure) stage, the contractor can counter-propose localised alternative
system other than the use of metal access scaffold.

Mesh barricade/ counter-proposals for localised alternative system, its vertical support and any
components therein shall be in modular sizes and designed according to the Workplace Safety
and Health (Construction) Regulations by a PE employed by the Contractor. The PE’s drawings
and calculation shall then be submitted to the SO Rep for approval within six weeks from the
Letter of Acceptance, before installation and use. Trial setting out of mesh barricade shall be
carried out on Site two weeks after approval of submission.

The mesh barricade shall be erected ahead of the structural work (including the construction of
water tank rooms) from the second storey and held by a supporting system designed by the said
PE. The height of the mesh barricade shall be at least 1.1m above the construction level. The
Contractor and his PE shall ensure that the substrate at which the mesh barricade is affixed to,
can resist the designed imposed loads. The PE shall satisfy himself that his proposal shall not
duly overload the RC structure.

CE21/S1.DOC(50)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-51

1.5.1 Site Safety Measures (Cont'd)

(p) Prefabricated Mesh Barricade (Cont'd)

Where necessary, the Contractor shall provide, erect and maintain an overlying screening net to
cover the entire internal face of the mesh barricade. The installation of the net shall follow the
erection of the fence closely. Where necessary, a 90mm high toeboards shall be provided at the
base of the net from the inside of mesh barricade. After installation, there shall be no opening
between separate sets of the net and any torn net shall be replaced or repaired immediately. The
net shall comply with the following requirements:

(i) Maximum mesh size (square) : 15mm square


(ii) Twine No. : Minimum 350D
(iii) Knot Type : Single or English knot
(iv) Minimum 12 ply

The vertical supports of mesh barricade shall be effectively anchored to the building structure.
All vertical supports shall be painted with a bright colour for easy identification.

The mesh barricade shall be erected according to a pre-determined safe work procedure
established by the Contractor, or substantially dismantled, by trained erectors, under the
immediate supervision of a competent supervisor. The mesh barricade and its components shall
only be erected and dismantled by workers using life-line and safety belts or other equivalent, if
not better, means of preventing a fall.

The Contractor shall under no circumstance, use the prefabricated mesh barricade and vertical
supports for other purposes.

(q) Access For The Use Of Mobile Crane and Piling Machines Next to Built-Up Area

When the Contractor uses mobile cranes and piling machines on the Site which is next to existing
buildings or public roads or MRT lines, the access for the mobile cranes and the piling machines
shall be of steel plates or reinforced concrete or bituminous pavement as approved by the SO
Rep. All such access shall be provided over adequate compacted hardcore base.

The Contractor shall provide full access for the movement of the cranes and piling machines and
for their lifting or pile jacking operations. The access shall be able to distribute the load so as not
to exceed the bearing capacity of the underlying materials.

The Contractor shall engage a PE to design the access. The drawings and calculations endorsed
by the PE shall be submitted for the approval by the SO Rep before the construction of the
access. The access shall be constructed according to the approved Drawings and maintained
in a good condition at all times throughout the Time for Completion and any time period when
liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract. The access shall be inspected by the
Contractor’s PE prior to its use.

(r) Mobile Crane

The Contractor shall submit layout and details of the crane access to the SO Rep for approval
prior to the use of the crane on the access. The Contractor shall ensure and check that the crane
access is properly constructed. The Contractor shall keep all records of inspections of the crane
access at the Site and produce them for examination when requested by the SO Rep. The boom
of the mobile crane with hoisted load shall not be allowed to swing outside the contract boundary
without the written approval of the SO Rep. All the hoisting area must be effectively barricaded.

The Contractor shall ensure the installation of the barriers to warn the crane operator of
depressions, excavated areas and other obstructions.

CE21/S1.DOC(51)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-52

1.5.1 Site Safety Measures (Cont'd)

(r) Mobile Crane (Cont'd)

Moment limiters shall be installed for all cranes. The Safety Factor for the mobile crane shall
have a minimum of 1.3, which includes the built-in factor of safety for the mobile crane. The
lifting load shall include the weight of the components, the spreader beam and the lifting device.
The tip-load shall have the capacity to hoist the heaviest component including all necessary lifting
appliances. A Permit-To-Hoist must be obtained before any hoisting operation is carried out.
The Contractor shall station a lifting supervisor on the Site to oversee and guide the crane
operator during positioning, hoisting and slewing. The cranes shall be tested by an “Authorised
Examiner” before its use on the Site irrespective of any valid test certificate. The Contractor shall
ensure daily checks are carried out by the crane operator and maintenance checks conducted
once every three months. The crane must have overhaul checks before it is used on the Site.
Test certificate, overhaul certificates, maintenance certificates, inspection records by the crane
operator, data on the Authorised Examiners and the Contractor’s site engineer shall be properly
documented, kept on the Site and produced for inspection by the SO Rep.

(s) Crane Operator, Lifting Supervisor, Rigger And Signalman

The Contractor shall comply with the Workplace Safety and Health (Operation of Cranes)
Regulations 2011. He shall appoint at least one full time lifting supervisor to supervise all lifting
operations of any crane for the site. However, where more than one crane is used on the Site,
the number of lifting supervisor employed by the Contractor shall be increased as required by the
SO Rep. No lifting activity shall be allowed without the supervision of the lifting supervisor.

The lifting supervisor shall have a minimum of 3 years of experience in construction work and
lifting operations. He must be a site foremen or site engineer and possess a certificate on Safety
Instruction Course for Lifting Supervisor. He shall spend his time fully on all lifting activities and
ensure that unsafe conditions are rectified.

For lifting operation within the site not next to existing buildings, public roads or MRT lines, the
crane operators shall have a minimum of 2 years of experience in the operation of cranes.

For lifting operation within the site which is next to existing buildings, public roads or MRT lines,
the crane operators shall have a minimum of 5-years experiences in crane operation.
Nevertheless upon the approval of the SO Rep, the Contractor is allowed to employ crane
operators with a minimum of 3 years experiences in crane operation instead but shall subject to
the following conditions and approval by the SO Rep;

(i) The crane operators shall pass an assessment by the BCA on their competency;

(ii) The Contractor shall carry out risk analysis based on the positions of the cranes to decide
which crane would be suitable for deploying such crane operators. Generally, this means
that such operators should operate cranes that are at least 50m away from any existing
buildings and facilities, and the collapse zone of the crane does not overlap with existing
buildings;

(iii) Other measures as and when instructed by SO Rep.

Rigger/s and signalman/s shall also be appointed for all lifting operations and they must have
completed an approved training course.

The crane operator, lifting supervisor, rigger/s and signalman/s shall carry out their duties strictly
according to the above mentioned Regulations and other duties as the SO Rep deems necessary
from time to time.

The Contractor shall submit a list of crane operators, lifting supervisor, rigger/s and signalman/s
with their names, identification card or passport numbers, qualifications and years of experience
to the SO Rep for approval one week before the use of the crane. The list shall be updated and
kept on the Site at all times. The SO Rep reserves the right to examine the list as and when
required.

CE21/S1.DOC(52)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-53

1.5.2 Safety Infringement

The above provisions shall be made to the satisfaction of the SO Rep. The Contractor shall include in
his Contract Sum all the costs and expenses for complying with the safety requirements.

In the event of any accident or mishap occurring on Site, whether or not caused by the inadequacy of
safety provision or non-compliance with safety regulations, the Contractor shall immediately notify the
SO Rep and the HDB and any other relevant Authority.

Depending on the nature and extent of the accident or mishap, the SO Rep, HDB or any other Authority
may order a total or partial stoppage of work to allow investigations and/or remedial measures to be
effected. In the event of such stoppage, or any stoppages of work due to safety violations, the Contractor
shall not be entitled to any claims for compensation or extension of time for completion.

The SO Rep will conduct periodic inspections on the provision of safety measures together with the
Contractor's Workplace Safety & Health Co-ordinator or foreman. The Contractor shall rectify
immediately all contraventions against the Workplace Safety & Health Act and its Subsidiary Legislation,
Workplace Safety and Health (Construction) Regulations or safety measures specified. All Works or
partial works may be stopped until further notice from the SO Rep if the total number of contraventions
or non-compliance is four or more or when the SO Rep considers the working environment unsafe for
Works to continue. If the contravention or non-compliance is not rectified at a subsequent inspection,
the SO Rep shall exercise its rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose charges
against the Contractor.

The SO Rep shall at its absolute discretion exercise its rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and
Irregularities" to impose charges against the Contractor for the following types of accidents occurring in
the course of or arising out of or in the consequence of the Works:

(i) For each instance of fatal accident, if the accident is established in part or in whole by the
SO Rep or any local Authority, to be the result of the defaults, acts, omissions or negligence of the
Contractor. This charge shall not be refunded to the Contractor;

(ii) For each instance of accident, if the SO Rep, HDB or the Competent Authority is of the
opinion that the accident is the result of the failure of the Contractor to provide necessary and sufficient
safety measures stipulated in the Contract or Workplace Safety & Health Act and its Subsidiary
Legislation, the Workplace Safety and Health (Incident Reporting) Regulations.

(iii) Dangerous occurrence as classified in the Subsidiary Legislation, Workplace Safety and
Health (Incident Reporting) Regulations, Part II if the SO Rep, HDB or the Competent Authority is of the
opinion that the dangerous occurrence is the result of failure of the Contractor to provide necessary and
sufficient safety measures stipulated in the Contract or the Workplace Safety and Health Act and its
Subsidiary Legislation, the Workplace Safety and Health (Incident Reporting) Regulations.

1.5.3 Reporting Of Accidents

In the case of an accident or dangerous occurrence as classified under the Workplace Safety & Health
(Incident Reporting) Regulations, the Contractor shall notify the Commissioner and HDB within one
hour of an incident. After being informed of it, the SO Rep or HDB may at his discretion make a
preliminary investigation of the circumstances and record its findings.

Notwithstanding the aforementioned requirements, the Contractor shall also, make an incident
investigation and record it in the form set out in the INCIDENT INVESTIGATION REPORT - HDB and
submit it to HDB within 10 days of the incident. Upon submitting this REPORT to HDB, the Contractor
shall arrange for the injured workman, witnesses and an interpreter, if necessary, to report to HDB to
furnish evidence relating to the incident.

If the Contractor fails to give any required notice or fails to furnish evidence of the incident as required
in this Clause, the SO Rep or HDB may at his absolute discretion exercise his rights under Clause
“Nuisance And Irregularities” to impose charges against the Contractor.

CE21/S1.DOC(53)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-54

1.5.4 Approved Construction Equipment

All Construction Equipment used at the Site as specified hereunder shall be obtained from Approved
Suppliers registered with the HDB. Such Construction Equipment are :

(a) mobile crane;


(b) tower crane;
(c) gondola;
(d) mast climbing platform; and
(e) metal scaffold.

The Approved Suppliers can be found on kmo.eptc.com.sg and/or HDB Materials List.

For Construction Equipment from other sources, such Construction Equipment shall firstly be registered
with the HDB before the Contractor can use such Construction Equipment at the Site.

Where, such Construction Equipment is used at the Site for a duration of less than a week, the SO Rep
may at his sole discretion, waive the aforementioned requirement. Under such a case, there shall be
no adjustment to the Contract Sum.

1.5.5 Gas Cylinders And Related Equipment

The Contractor shall use gas cylinders fitted with both a low pressure gauge and a high pressure gauge,
a reducing valve with pressure regulator, and safety relief device. The gas cylinders shall not be kept
in the same room where welding, cutting or heating is being carried out or placed within five metres of
any source of heat. The gas cylinders shall always be kept upright in a wheeled-trolley.

The hose connecting the gas cylinder to an apparatus for cutting, welding, heating or other related
works shall be of good construction and sound material, free from defects, properly maintained, and not
entangled or kinked.

A flashback arrester or any other similar device which stops flashback that is acceptable to the Chief
Inspector of the MOM shall be fitted at every outlet of a gas cylinder and every inlet of an apparatus.

The gas cylinders and hoses shall be colour-coded to conform to Singapore Standard 152 :
"Identification of Contents of Industrial Gas Containers" and any amendments thereof.

The Contractor shall engage a competent person to check the safety devices referred to herein once in
every 6 months. The competent person shall be any person who is competent by education, training
and experience on the safety and operational aspects of the use of gas cylinders and related equipment.

1.5.6 Erection of Temporary Structures

In addition to the submissions of the site layout plan, the contractor shall further submit detailed
structural plans and design calculations, certified by his PE, for temporary structures of two storey or
higher. His PE may make use of the Drawings in the Standard Construction Detail Manual as a guide
to the design and submission of the temporary structures. The Contractor shall erect all such temporary
structures in strict compliance with Professional Engineer’s plans and calculation.

1.5.7 Submission Of Proposal and Certificate Of Supervision

All Works requiring the Contractor to submit his proposal for the approval of the SO Rep shall be
stipulated in the Drawings and/or Specifications. The Contractor shall submit detailed structural plans
and design calculations, certified by his PE to the SO Rep not later than three months from the
commencement of the Works for such proposals whichever is earlier.

The Contractor shall bear all consequences for late submission. The Works shall be supervised by the
Contractor’s PE. Not later than two(2) weeks after completion of the Works, the Contractor’s PE shall
submit a Certificate of Supervision, stating that he has carried out such supervision work and is fully
satisfied that the Works have been constructed in accordance with his structural plans and design
calculations as approved by the SO Rep.

CE21/S1.DOC(54)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-55

1.5.8 Excavation

Piling, shoring and bracing used in trench excavation to protect persons against falling or sliding
materials shall be of adequate strength.

For any shaft, manhole, trench, tunnel or excavation exceeding 1.5m in depth, all detailed ERSS works,
methods of excavation, construction sequence and contingency plans are to be designed and endorsed
by Contractor’s engaged PE (CIVIL/ST) or as directed by SO Rep. For any shaft, manhole, trench,
tunnel or excavation exceeding 6.0m in depth, all detailed ERSS works, methods of excavation,
construction sequence and contingency plans are to be designed and endorsed by Contractor’s
engaged PE (Geo) or as directed by SO Rep. Contractor shall also comply with the relevant authorities’
requirements.

Contractor’s PE (CIVIL/ST) or PE (Geo) shall undertake the supervision (to deploy his own RE or RTO
for supervision and to visit the site regularly) and certification of all ERSS works to ensure compliance
with his design requirements.

Contractor’s PE (CIVIL/ST) or PE (Geo) shall endorse and submit the method statement and detailed
design to SO Rep within the time frame directed by SO Rep and shall obtain the approval from the
relevant authorities before commencing any excavation works.

All relevant plans/documents shall be submitted to the relevant authorities for clearance within the time
frame directed by SO Rep. For cases where AC checking is required, all relevant plans/documents shall
be submitted to the relevant authorities after AC’s approval or as directed by SO Rep. Contractor should
note that plan clearance by the relevant authorities may take 2 weeks or longer.

No cost recovery and claim for extension of time (EOT) is allowed.

1.5.9 Storage Of Diesel, Oil And Chemical

Diesel, oil and chemical shall be stored in a designated area within a covered shed with concrete floors
and collection sump to contain any leak or spillage. Such an area shall not have any outlet/opening
leading to a storm water drain or sewer. A full containment bundwall should be provided around the
storage area and a collection sump should be provided to collect any spillage. The contractor shall
comply fully with the requirement specified in Environmental Pollution Control Act and by the other
relevant authorities.

The contractor shall submit the layout of the proposed diesel, oil and chemical storage areas, the
design of the containment and collection sump endorsed by a PE to SO Rep for approval. The
contractor shall engage licensed toxic waste contractor to collect the spillage for safe disposal and
submit the receipt of disposal to SO Rep.

The contractor shall be responsible for paying any fines imposed by the relevant authorities eg. Public
Health Department, Drainage Department (PUB) etc. In addition, the SO Rep shall exercise his right
under Clause 1.6 ”Nuisance and Irregularities” to impose charges against the contractor.

1.5.10 Provision Of Equipment, Apparatus, Devices, Etc

(1) Safety Helmets And Safety Boots

The Contractor shall provide safety helmets and safety boots for use by the SO Rep and Resident
Technical Officers at the Site as well as the Employer's officers visiting the Site throughout the
Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the
Contract. The ownership of the safety helmets and safety boots shall be reverted back to the
Contractor upon the satisfactory Substantial Completion of the Works.

The requirements are as follows :

(a) Safety Helmets

(i) white colour with HDB logo in front of helmet


(Colour code for HDB logo : Pantone 485)
(ii) complete with canvas chin straps and sweat resisting lining
(iii) comply with latest edition of SS98

CE21/S1.DOC(55)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-56

1.5.10 Provision Of Equipment, Apparatus, Devices, Etc (Cont'd)

(1) Safety Helmets And Safety Boots (Cont'd)

(b) Safety Boots

(i) at least 24 cm in height


(ii) black/brown colour with steel toe cap
(iii) long-wearing
(iv) of great flexibility and resilience
(v) slip proof, resistant to oil, acid and heat
(vi) nail proof
(vii) of excellent insulation
(viii) comfortable and light
(ix) comply with latest edition of SS 513

The Contractor shall immediately replace those safety helmets and safety boots which the SO
Rep considers to be not in good working condition.

(2) Torch Lights

The Contractor shall provide sufficient number of torch lights on the Site at all times for use by
the SO Rep, Resident Technical Officers and/or representatives from other Authorities.

These torch lights shall be in good working condition and sufficiently bright enough for use.

CE21/S1.DOC(56)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-57

1.6 NUISANCE AND IRREGULARITIES

1.6.1 Nuisance And Irregularities

If the Contractor is found to have committed any of the following irregularities :

(a) Omitting building materials or labour, reducing the sizes of the materials, using inferior materials;
or materials constructed not according to the Specifications or Drawings;

(b) Creating nuisance at the Site thereby causing inconvenience to the SO Rep or the public or
committing similar acts (such as not complying with site safety requirements, etc) which are likely
to bring the Employer into disrepute;

(c) Non-compliance with any part of the Specifications or Drawings, or non-fulfilment of any
contractual obligation,

the SO Rep reserves the right to impose on the Contractor, and the Contractor hereby fully accepts and
agrees to pay without dispute or question, a charge based on prevailing guidelines set by the Employer
but not exceeding $100,000.00, and for contract with a Contract Sum of less than $300,000.00, a charge
not exceeding 30% of the Contract Sum per occasion as agreed compensation to the Employer for the
inconvenience caused, investigation and administration expenses incurred by the Employer and for
damage to the Employer's reputation and standing generally. Furthermore, the Contractor may be
barred from tendering for a specified period.

In addition to the above charges, the SO Rep or HDB is empowered either :

(a) to order any irregular work to be removed and made good to the satisfaction of the SO Rep or
HDB at the Contractor's costs and expenses;

or

(b) in lieu of correcting work not done in accordance with the Contract, the SO Rep or HDB may
allow such work to remain and shall recover any cost differences between the specified
requirements and the non-compliance.

For nuisance committed on Site, the Contractor must take immediate action to cease the nuisance
committed upon instruction given by the SO Rep or HDB .

CE21/S1.DOC(57)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 1-58

1.7 IMPLEMENTATION OF EUROCODES (SS EN / BS EN)

This Clause shall apply to the Technical Specifications of Section 2, Section 3, Section 4 and Section
5 of the Standard Specifications for Civil Engineering Works.

With the implementation of Eurocodes with effect from 01 April 2015 and for avoidance of doubts, all
design and construction works, including all descriptions, classification and testing of concrete/ steel/
soils materials and other works carried out from 1 April 2015 onwards shall satisfy and comply with the
relevant Eurocodes (SS EN / BS EN). No additional claim and time will be entertained in compliance
with this Clause during the transition period.

All materials used in the design and construction of roads, bridges, road related facilities, drains, sewers
and associated works shall be obtained from approved manufacturers. Materials and articles used shall
comply with appropriate Eurocodes (SS EN / BS EN) or ISO or other latest requirements by the BCA
and all relevant authorities where these exist, otherwise Singapore Standards or other specified
Standards shall apply. Where a Standard specified in the Specifications has been amended or
superseded, the latest edition of the standard shall apply. Where British Standards are specified in the
Specifications, the corresponding Eurocodes (SS EN / BS EN) where available shall prevail. The
recommendations in the appropriate Eurocodes (SS EN / BS EN) shall be referred to during the
construction where these are available, otherwise Singapore Standards, British Codes of Practice or
other codes shall apply unless otherwise directed by the SO Rep.

Where two or more alternative materials manufactured locally are proposed, the SO Rep may at his
sole discretion give preference to the use of a material that is approved under ISO 9000 or any of the
quality certification schemes of the PSB, such as PSB Singapore Quality Mark/Product Listing Scheme/
Certification Scheme.

For the purpose of this Clause, obtain all precast concrete products such as kerbs, aeration slabs, drain
units etc from ISO 9000 or PSB Singapore Quality Mark/Product Listing Scheme/Certification Scheme
Suppliers.

SECTION 2/.....

CE21/S1.DOC(58)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
CE Spec
Page 2-1

SECTION 2

MATERIALS, WORKMANSHIP AND CONSTRUCTION IN GENERAL

2.1 MATERIALS (GENERAL)

Unless otherwise stated, all materials and articles shall be of approve manufacture. They shall be
obtained from manufacturers and/or suppliers approved by the SO Rep.

2.2 QUALITY OF MATERIALS AND PROVISION OF STANDARD

All materials used in the construction of roads, drains, sewers, manholes etc shall be obtained from
approved manufacturers. Materials and articles used shall comply with appropriate Singapore
Standards (SS) published by PSB or ISO 9000 where these exist, otherwise British Standards (BS) or
other specified Standards shall apply. Where a Standard specified in the Specifications has been
amended or superseded, the current standard shall apply. Where British Standards are specified in the
Specifications, the corresponding Singapore Standards (SS) where available shall prevail. The
recommendations in the appropriate Singapore Codes of Practice (CP) shall be referred to during the
construction where these are available, otherwise British Codes of Practice or other codes shall apply
unless otherwise directed by the SO Rep.

Where two or more alternative materials manufactured locally are proposed, the SO Rep may at his
sole discretion give preference to the use of a material that is approved under ISO 9000 or any of the
quality certification schemes of the PSB, such as PSB Singapore Quality Mark/Product Listing Scheme/
Certification Scheme.

For the purpose of this Clause, obtain all precast concrete products such as kerbs, aeration slabs, drain
units etc from ISO 9000 or PSB Singapore Quality Mark/Product Listing Scheme/Certification Scheme
Suppliers.

2.3 CERTIFICATE OF COMPLIANCE WITH RESPECTIVE STANDARDS

If required, obtain from the manufacturers and supply to the SO Rep the appropriate certificate of
compliance with the Standard for which those materials or articles are specified to comply with.

2.4 TESTING OF MATERIALS

The SO Rep may cause a sample to be taken from each consignment of materials to be tested at an
SAC/SINGLAS laboratory and the results of such testing shall be accepted as final. If a sample does
not conform to the required standard, the whole consignment shall be rejected and shall be removed
from Site by the Contractor and charges against the Contractor under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and
Irregularities to be decided by the SO Rep shall be imposed. If for practical reasons the consignment
cannot be removed from the Site, eg. material already installed, then the cost difference between the
inferior/undersized/non-complied materials and the specified materials and/or omitted labour costs
based on the latest Rates shall be recouped plus the imposition of charges against the Contractor under
Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to be decided by the SO Rep.

Also bear the cost of the final testing to be carried out by LTA, the Employer or any authority responsible
for the final taking over of the completed Works; such as premix, precast concrete kerbs, dividers, etc.

2.5 EXCAVATION GENERALLY

Visit and examine the Site carefully and ascertained the nature thereof and the kind of materials to be
excavated, and make provision in the Contract Sum to cover for the type of materials to be excavated.

Prior to commencement of excavation, the Contractor shall carry out pre-construction survey of the
neighbouring properties and comply with the requirements of BCA. The Contractor shall set out the
lines and structures for the inspection and approval of the SO Rep. Original ground levels shall also be
taken and submitted to the SO Rep for record.

CE21/S2.DOC(1)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-2

2.5 EXCAVATION GENERALLY (CONT’D)

For excavation, the Contractor shall comply fully with the relevant provisions of the Telecommunications
Act, the Public Utilities Act, the Electricity Act, the Gas Act, the Workplace Safety & Health Act and the
Factories Building Operations and Works of Engineering Construction Regulations (prevailing) or any
amendment or re-enactment thereof. The Contractor shall not be allowed to make any extra claim for
work or cost and expenses incurred in complying with the requirements of this clause.

Excavation shall be carried out neatly in accordance with the Drawings in whatsoever material may be
found, including hard rock or other hard material which requires breaking up by pneumatic drills and the
excavated materials shall be used as filling if required. Any surplus excavated materials may be spread
or dumped within the Site of the Works if required by the SO Rep. Alternatively, dispose off any surplus
material and if so required, provide lorries for transport and make all necessary arrangements for use
of an approved dumping ground and bear all costs and expenses in connection with the use thereof.
Do not deposit excavated materials on private land unless written permission of both the owner and
occupier of the land are submitted to the SO Rep.

Unless decided by the SO Rep, surplus excavated materials shall not become the property of the
Contractor and it shall not be construed that he has the right of ownership of them.

Carry out excavations by any suitable methods but subject to the approval of the SO Rep.

The excavated materials may temporarily during the course of the Works be tipped on either side of the
excavations only where sufficient space is available without causing obstructions and shall not be tipped
nearer to the excavation than a distance equal to the depth of the excavation where the soil condition
is poor.

The SO Rep may prescribe and limit the lengths and/or widths and/or depths of excavation to be
proceeded with at one time.

Excavation shall not be carried down in the first instance to a depth nearer than 150mm to formation
level. The bottoming-up to formation shall be done by hand immediately in advance of placing hardcore,
concrete or pipe laying unless directed otherwise by the SO Rep. Also take such steps as are
necessary, in the opinion of the SO Rep, to prevent damage to the formation owing to exposure to the
atmosphere and the trampling of the formation by workmen. Where, in the opinion of the SO Rep the
formation is softened or spoilt, the soft or spoilt areas shall be excavated and filled with Grade 15
concrete.

Cut pipe trenches to a sufficient width to receive and allow the pipes to be easily and properly jointed,
but subject to the foregoing requirements, keep to the minimum practicable width. The trench width may
also be reduced at or about the pipe soffit level in order to reduce the formation width.

Do not construct Permanent Works in any excavation until the excavation has been approved.

Form the entire excavation and leave complete and as accurate to the widths, levels, contours and
slopes as possible or as otherwise directed.

2.6 EXCAVATION IN ROCK

Remove any rock or boulders met with in excavation to the required depths by wedging, blasting or
other means as directed.

When blasting is required, obtain prior permission in writing from the SO Rep. Comply with the Local
Laws and Regulations and any requirements imposed by the relevant Authorities with regard to blasting
operations.

The Contractor shall be required to submit the blasting proposal to the SO Rep for approval. The
following information shall be required on all the blasting Works :

(a) blasting method, method statement and special techniques;


(b) vibration control and measurement;
(c) average depth, diameter and spacing of the boreholes;
(d) drilling and blasting programme;
(e) safety control measures; and
(f) over excavation and remedial measures.

CE21/S2.DOC(2)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-3

2.6 EXCAVATION IN ROCK (CONT’D)

Over excavation by blasting method shall not exceed 1.0 metre unless otherwise specified or directed
by SO Rep. The Contractor shall make good all the over excavation to the required formation level and
shape as directed by SO Rep. The cost and expense of such Works shall be borne by the Contractor.

The SO Rep must be fully informed as to the steps and precautionary measures taken to safeguard the
surrounding properties. Be liable for any accident, damage or injury to any person, property or thing,
resulting from the use of explosives. Prior to the start of blasting operations and in the presence of the
SO Rep, conduct a survey of all structures within 120m of the site where blasting is proposed, and any
other structures which the SO Rep considers may be affected, in order to determine the existing or pre-
blast condition of these structures. Prior to commencing blasting operations, a written report, supported
by photographs where necessary, listing any existing defects in the structures, shall be submitted to the
SO Rep.

When blasting operation are being carried out, any road affected shall be closed to traffic and the
appropriate signs erected.

2.7 ERRORS IN EXCAVATION

Excavate to such depths only as shown on the Drawings or as directed. Any excavation done to a
greater depth than is necessary for execution of the Works shall be filled with concrete of such
proportions or with such compacted material to the required formation levels as directed. The cost and
expense of such Works shall be borne by the Contractor.

2.8 RATE OF EXCAVATION AND CONSTRUCTION

Arrange the work so that the rate of construction keeps pace with the rate of excavation. However, the
distance over which excavation may advance ahead of the concreting and drain construction will be
specified from time to time by the SO Rep.

2.9 SAFEGUARDING PROPERTIES ADJACENT TO SITE

Where the Works is undertaken near or adjacent to buildings and properties and in the opinion of the
SO Rep, the stability of such buildings and properties is liable to be affected as a result of the Works,
arrange to have such buildings and properties inspected and record any cracks or any other defects
which may be affected by the work. Every precaution shall be taken to safeguard such building or
property and it shall be to the complete satisfaction of the SO Rep. When directed, excavate in such
lengths of excavation as will permit the least amount to be opened at one time in order to minimize the
danger of such open excavation affecting the stability of buildings or their supports.

Be responsible for damage to public, private or other buildings and properties adjacent to the Site of
the Works which is caused as a direct or indirect result of the Contractor's work. Should the Contractor
fail to take the necessary precautions, the SO Rep may, after giving the Contractor twenty-four hours
notice in writing, carry out such work as may be necessary using labour, material, Construction
Equipment, implements and transport from other sources. The cost and expense of such work will be
charged to the Contractor.

2.10 DEALING WITH WATER

Maintain temporary diversion or damming of any existing drains, wherever necessary. Prior approval
from the Drainage Department, PUB, shall be obtained before such works can commence. Any drains
or water-courses so diverted shall be re-constructed to their original positions on Substantial Completion
of the Works.

Remove all water which may arise or be brought into the trenches or excavations and keep the level of
such sub-soil or accumulated water below the bottom of any Permanent Works by the use of pumps or
suitable well-point apparatus. After raising the water, at once convey it away in such a manner as not
to cause any damage, nuisance or injury. All sumps or wells which may be required for the purpose of
keeping the Works dry shall be sunk clear of any Permanent Works and shall be refilled after completion
of the Permanent Works. Conduct the pumping operations so as to avoid undermining any part of the
Works.

CE21/S2.DOC(3)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-4

2.11 APPROVAL OF EXCAVATION

Report to the SO Rep when the excavations are ready to receive hardcore or lean concrete sub-base
and await the inspection and approval of the SO Rep. Any hardcore or lean concrete sub-base or other
work put in before the excavation has been inspected and approved shall, if so directed, be removed
and new work substituted in accordance with the Specifications.

2.12 PREVENTION OF FLOATATION

The structures may not be heavy enough to resist the possible uplift due to water pressure until the
structure, soil cover and backfilling have been completed. Make adequate arrangement to keep the
excavation dry until the structures and filling are completed or adopt other approved means of ensuring
the stability of the Temporary Works or Permanent Works. Submit proposed method to the SO Rep for
approval before Works commences and provide for adequate standby Construction Equipment and
attendance throughout 24 hours each day.

For pipelines laid in wet, waterlogged ground subject to flooding, take all necessary precautions to
prevent floating or movement of pipelines whether laying, laid or under test.

2.13 REFILLING

The Contractor's attention is drawn to the absolute necessity to compact the refilling by adequate
consolidation and ramming. Pay particular attention to filling and ramming around and above pipes in
trench to thoroughly compact the filling around structures and to the complete filling of the voids created
by the withdrawal of timbering.

When a trench is excavated under or near any existing work liable to be affected by subsidence of the
material in the trench, or where any Permanent Works will later be constructed under, across, along, or
over the line of the trench, fill the trench with Grade 15 concrete, or take such other means to prevent
damage by subsidence as the SO Rep may direct. If such work is not shown on the Drawings or
specified in the Specifications, any extra work so necessitated shall be paid for according to the Rates,
unless, in the opinion of the SO Rep, it is necessitated by the Contractor's negligence, bad
workmanship, faulty materials or lack of reasonable foresight.

Maintain all refilled surfaces and be responsible for claims arising from accidents due to subsidence or
inadequate maintenance.

(a) Refilling within the Service Roads, Bus Bays and Carpark/Sewer Works

All concrete shall be thoroughly set before refilling is commenced. In refilling the excavation, use
only unwashed sand or granite fines as fill material for the portion of excavation of drain works
within the service roads, bus bays and carparks and the full excavation of sewer work trenches.
Other suitable fill materials can be used for the portion of the excavation of drain works outside
the service roads and carparks. In the initial refilling, carefully place the fill material on top and/or
next to the Permanent Works and well pack and ram in a layer of 300mm as directed. Fill the
remainder of the excavation with unwashed sand or granite fines, in layers of not more than
600mm deep or such depth as directed, each layer shall be thoroughly rammed before the next
layer is placed. In all cases efficient mechanical rammers shall be employed in refilling. Refilling
shall include the filling in of all voids caused by the withdrawal of timbering. During the removal
of timbering from the trench withdraw the runners only to the level of the backfilling as it proceeds
regularly and in layers. As timbers are lifted without exposing the face of the trench, immediately
ram the filling hard into the space left by the timber.

For sewer works, fill the trenches to a depth of 600mm over the pipes before the pipes are
emptied of water after testing, so that any damage that may be caused by ramming can be
detected. Where the sewer works are constructed within the roads, driveways or carparks,
refilling of the trenches with unwashed sand or granite fines shall be taken up to the Subgrade
level of the road/driveway/carpark or 500mm below the road/driveway/carpark finishing level or
the proposed manhole top levels whichever is the greater.

(b) Refilling for Roadbase

Keep separate those excavated materials which are suitable for subsequent backfilling.
Carefully repack selected excavated materials in place after refilling to form a compact neat
surface.

CE21/S2.DOC(4)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-5

2.14 IMPORTED FILLING MATERIAL

Where filling is required and suitable material from the excavations on the Site is not available, imported
filling shall be used. This imported filling which must be to the approval of the SO Rep shall be good
lateritic gravel or hogging, broken stone, hardcore, quarry waste or other approved material.

Inform the SO Rep the source of supply of the imported filling materials.

2.15 WORKING SHAFT FOR HEADING

Obtain access to tunnel or heading work from the working shafts proposed on ends of the open
excavation in trench. The Contractor may seek approval from the SO Rep to open additional working
shafts within the length of tunnel to facilitate the Works. Make good and refill upon completion of the
Work.

Provide adequate timber and protect the ends of the open trench used as tunnel or heading access.

2.16 TUNNEL EXCAVATION

Engage a registered Professional Engineer to submit all proposals for excavating, timbering and
constructing sewers and pipelines in tunnel and obtain the approval of the SO Rep before commencing
any work.

Be responsible for the safety of the timbering. Submit the design, calculation and full details of the
supports and timbering to be used for approval by the SO Rep.

The excavation for the tunnel shall be of sufficient size for proper execution of the construction work
and all timbering shall be driven and fixed in close contact with the ground to be supported. No payment
for overbreak or additional excavation shall be made and all such excavation shall be packed with
concrete.

Unless otherwise approved, the tunnels shall be close timbered and the timber shall be left in place on
Substantial Completion of the Works. During excavation, securely fixed running boards shall be
provided to the floor of the tunnel and on completion of excavation, such running boards shall be
removed, the formation cleaned and dried out and a concrete sealing coat provided. The tunnel shall
be driven complete between access points before commencing Permanent Works and the work shall
at all times be carried out as quickly as possible so that the excavation shall remain open for the shortest
possible time.

The working face of the tunnel excavation shall be supported as necessary and shall be boxed up at
the end of each shift when continuous working is not in progress or whenever required by the SO Rep.

When work is in progress, proper access ladders shall be fixed and maintained at the tunnel access
points and the tunnel lighted by electricity at not more than 110 volts. Lamps shall be provided at not
more than 9 metres intervals and no flame or other naked light shall be used. Proper and adequate
ventilation fans and ducts shall be provided, maintained and operated at all times.

Pipes laid in heading shall be carefully bedded on Grade 30 concrete adjusted to line and level and
jointed, inspected, tested and approved. After approval, the whole of the tunnel section shall be
carefully and solidly packed with Grade 30 concrete.

2.17 DEWATERING OF EXCAVATION

Where dewatering is approved, provide, operate and maintain to the satisfaction of the SO Rep a
system of temporary drains intercepting ditches, cut off drains, sub-drains, sumps, pumps, well-points,
dewatering equipment and all other things necessary for keeping the sub-soil or accumulated water out
of the excavation or at a level below the bottom of any Permanent Works for such a period as the SO
Rep may direct.

Where ground water, irrespective of the sources, is encountered or anticipated, provide sufficient pumps
to handle the ingress of water and provide and maintain in working order standby pumping units. Also
arrange for night and day manning and operation of the pumps wherever necessary to ensure that at
all times and weathers, the work can be proceeded with.

CE21/S2.DOC(5)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-6

2.17 DEWATERING OF EXCAVATION (CONT’D)

After raising the water herein referred to, at once convey it away in such a manner as not to cause any
nuisance or injury. No new or existing pipe may be used for the purpose of carrying water away from
the excavations without permission in writing from the SO Rep. Make good any damage whatsoever
resulting from such use of new or existing pipes or culverts. When sand, silt or mud particles are
suspended and maintained in the pumped water, tanks to settle the solids shall be provided to remove
the solids before discharge of the water.

Site temporary works for the control of water clear of the Permanent Works, except where temporary
sub-drains under the Permanent Works are approved.

Should the SO Rep give permission for temporary sub-drains under the Permanent Works, the pipes
shall be laid with a 75mm surround of 19mm single size aggregate and the top surface of the surround
shall be covered with tarred felt cloth or other approved material.

Unless as directed otherwise, all temporary drains and sub-drains shall be finally sealed with concrete
at intervals to the satisfaction of the SO Rep and all temporary ditches, sumps, wells etc, shall be filled
and reinstated.

Include in the Contract Sum for all costs and expenses for complying with this clause, irrespective of
the methods adopted.

2.18 SUPPORT FOR EXISTING WORK

When any excavation is carried out near, or under any existing work including buildings, services,
mains, cables, and surfaces such as roads, etc., which is liable to be affected by subsidence, take
necessary measures to prevent damage by subsidence, whether such existing work is shown in the
Drawings or not. If it becomes essential, in the opinion of the SO Rep, to permanently divert any sewer
drain, pipe, cable or other services or to reconstruct any existing building in an alternative position, such
diversions and/or reconstructions shall be paid for by the Employer. Provided always that such
diversions and/or reconstructions do not form part of the Works.

2.19 HARDCORE

Hardcore shall be composed of approved broken stone, brick, concrete or other similar approved
material, free from excessive dust, foreign matter and other impurities. It shall not contain pieces
exceeding 150mm or less than 60mm gauge. Oversized hardcore shall not be considered for use
unless it can be broken down to the allowable range effectively.

2.20 TIMBER

All timber delivered to the Site shall be properly seasoned to moisture content not exceeding 20%,
straight, sound, square cut, free from injuries, waney, edges, decay, shakes, large and dead knots,
insect attack and other serious defects, and of the appropriate grade according to the Malayan Grading
Rules for Sawn Hardwood Timber (current edition) as specified below :

(a) All scantlings up to 400 cm2 in cross-section shall comply with the requirements of the grade
"Merchantable".

(b) All large structural timber above 400 cm2 in cross-section shall comply with the requirements of
the grade 'Baulks & Large Squares'.

(c) All timber for joinery and dressing used in natural state shall comply with the requirements of the
grade 'Standard and Better'.

(d) All timber for joinery and dressing which is to be painted shall comply with the requirements of
the grade 'Merchantable'.

Any portion of the timber works showing signs of warps, shakes or other Defect within the Defects
Liability Period shall be replaced with new works together with all other works which may be affected
thereby.

CE21/S2.DOC(6)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-7

2.20 TIMBER (CONT’D)

Submit sample pieces of the timber proposed to be used in the works to the SO Rep for approval.

Remove from the Site immediately any timber member or component which the SO Rep does not
approve.

The recommendations of the Singapore CP 1 and CP 7 for use of timber shall be referred to except
where they conflict with this Specifications. Where plywood is used, it shall comply with SS 1 and
SS 72.

2.21 CARPENTRY AND JOINERY

All timber for structural works shall be Balau, Chengal or Kapur. All timber joinery works shall be Kapur.
All carpentry works shall be sawn except where specified as wrote. All exposed surfaces of joinery
works shall be wrote by planing and sand-papering to an approved finish. Wrote timber shall be worked
to the correct sizes and shapes as shown in the Drawings. Sizes of timber indicated in the Drawings
are nominal and a maximum allowance of 2.5mm shall be permitted for each wrot face.

Upon delivery all timber shall be properly stacked under cover to ensure free air circulation round all
faces and to minimise warping.

Take measurements for joinery works on the Site and verify it with the dimensions shown in the
Drawings. When discrepancy occurs between the measurement shown in the Drawings and that taken
on the Site, obtain the confirmation of the SO Rep before proceeding with the Works.

Joints shall be formed in a proper workmanlike manner, well proportioned and tight fitting. Dress all
exposed surfaces of joinery work. Where glued joinery work is likely to come into contact with moisture,
the glue shall be waterproofed. All joinery requiring painting shall be knotted, stopped and primed
before fixing.

Coat the backs of all carpentry and joinery works in contact with masonry work with one coat of
"Solignum" or "Presotim" or other approved preservative. Allow the preservative to be thoroughly dried
before fixing of the Works. Treat all saw cuts similarly.

All structural members, assemblies or framework shall be capable of sustaining with due stability and
stiffness the whole dead and imposed loads without exceeding the Limits of Stresses stated in CP 1
and CP 7. The timber shall be seasoned as far as practicable to a moisture content appropriate for its
particular use as spelt out in CP 1 and CP 7.

Treat all timber exposed to damp conditions or in contact with ground with "Solignum" or "Creosote" or
other approved wood preservative applied with brush in two coats, or be treated with approved
pressurised process.

2.22 PLYWOOD

Plywood shall be of the grades specified in SS 1 which in the opinion of the SO Rep is appropriate to
the work and shall be as follows :

Grade I For use in the natural state. The veneer shall be free from knots, worm and beetle holes,
splits, glue, stains or other defects.

Grade II For use where subsequent painting or similar treatment is required. The veneer on the
face side may have a few sound knots, occasional minor discoloration or stains and small
inlay repairs.

Grade III For use where the plywood is not normally visible. The veneer on the face may have
other defects than those specified above provided that its serviceability is not affected.

Adhesives for plywood are to be one of the following types :

Type 1 Phenol Formaldehyde resin adhesive classified as weather and boil proof in BS 1203
(WBP).

Type 2 Urea formaldehyde resin adhesive classified as moisture and weather resistant (WR).

CE21/S2.DOC(7)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-8

2.22 PLYWOOD (CONT’D)

Unless otherwise specified, plywood for internal use shall be Grade II with Type 2 adhesive and plywood
for external use shall be Grade II with Type 1 adhesive.

Adequately protect all plywood used in permanent structure under damp or wet service conditions
against decay and insect attack by treatment conforming to SS 72.

2.23 TIMBERING OF EXCAVATION

The term "timbering" shall cover all necessary methods of support including the use of timber, concrete,
steel sheet piling, steel sheeting or such materials as may be approved. If timber is used, it shall be of
the species Keruing or Kempas.

Provide and fix strong and sufficient timbering to support the sides and/or bottom of the excavation to
the satisfaction of the SO Rep and maintain the same until the constructional work is sufficiently
advanced, in the opinion of the SO Rep to permit the timbering to be withdrawn, which shall be
conducted only under the personal supervision of a competent person employed by the Contractor.

Carry out such timbering and shoring with due consideration to full flow or flooding conditions all to the
satisfaction of the SO Rep.

Submit to the SO Rep drawings and calculations showing details of the proposed timbering for approval.
Where excavation exceeds a depth of 4m, engage a registered Professional Engineer to submit the
design and supervise the erection of the timbering. No excavation work may start until the timbering
details are approved. Where excavations for culvert, drains, sewers and manhole are required, submit
the full details of the proposed timbering methods within one month from the date of the Letter of
Acceptance. Failure to submit and obtain approval of details expeditiously may result in delays and the
Contractor shall not be entitled to any extension of Time for Completion on this ground. Notwithstanding
the approval given, the SO Rep reserves the right to instruct the Contractor to improve, alter, revise,
strengthen the timbering from time to time.

Be responsible for any injury to the Work and any consequential damages caused arising out of the
remedy of the timbering and any advice, permission or approval given by the SO Rep relating to the
relieve of timbering shall not relieve the Contractor from the responsibility specified in the Contract.

The SO Rep shall have the right to order excavation and construction work to be carried out in such
lengths and in such sections of the Works, as will, in his opinion, minimise the danger of such open
excavation affecting the stability of any nearby structures or ground, and the Contractor shall have no
claim for extra payment on this account. Shoring timbers shall be removed as the work proceeds only
if their removal does not endanger existing adjacent structure. Where the SO Rep deems it dangerous
to remove the shoring timbers, such timbers shall not be removed.

2.24 TIMBERING LEFT-IN

The Contractor shall be paid for all timbering left in the excavation on the instruction of the SO Rep
provided the timber is required to give permanent support to trench sides, services or buildings. No
payment shall be made where timber has to be left in, on the instruction of the SO Rep to counter any
Defect or negligence in the Contractor's execution of the Works. Only the actual quantity of timber left
in shall be paid for. Payment shall not be made for labour in cutting nor for timber in ends thus cut off,
nor for the disposal of additional surplus excavated materials due to the leaving in of timber.

2.25 STEEL TRENCH SHEETING

Where the subsoil conditions are expected to be of a soft and unstable character in trench excavation,
the normal methods of timbering will probably prove inadequate to avoid subsidence of the adjoining
road surfaces and other services. The Contractor shall be responsible for all such damages as specified
in the Contract.

In such circumstances the Contractor shall use Steel Trench Sheeting or Sheet Steel Piling adequately
supported by timber struts, walings, etc. Provide, pitch, drive and subsequently remove trench sheeting
or piling in accordance with other timbering items specified in the Specifications and the terms Timber
or Timbering shall also apply to Steel Trench Sheeting.

CE21/S2.DOC(8)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-9

2.26 STEEL SHEET PILING

The Contractor may use steel sheet piling during the construction of the Works subject to the approval
of the SO Rep.

Steel sheet piles shall conform to the provisions of BS 4360 and shall be driven where required and
approved or directed.

Engage a registered Professional Engineer to design the layout of the piling and the overall dimensions
of the excavation to suit the sheets and corners available and to give sufficient working space for the
proper construction of the Works. For purposes of this Contract, it shall be clearly and definitely
understood that the terms 'timber' or 'timbering' as used in any portion of the Specifications or Drawings
shall be deemed to include 'Steel Sheet Piling'.

2.27 LIABILITY OF TIMBERING

Approval by the SO Rep of the timbering shall not absolve the Contractor from his responsibility and
the Contractor shall be responsible for making good any damage caused as a result of the timbering
failing to give proper support to the sides of the excavation.

Carry out the timbering to the sides of excavation for structures in such a way that there is no obstruction
caused to the fixing of formwork for the walls. Remove the supporting struts and walings in stages to
suit progress of concreting.

If the SO Rep is not satisfied that the standard of timbering is equal to that shown on the approved
Drawings or that the sides of the excavations have not been secured in a manner to render such
excavations safe for working, he may, one hour after notifying the Contractor or Contractor's
Representative in writing, employ other persons to alter the timbering and the cost and expense incurred
for such workmen and materials employed shall be recovered from monies due or becoming due to the
Contractor.

2.28 WITHDRAWAL OF TIMBERING

Withdraw runners and sheets and steel sheet piles in lifts as backfilling and compaction is taking place.
Any damage caused by subsidence of the excavation resulting from the careless withdrawal of support
shall be the responsibility of the Contractor.

2.29 TIMBER PILING

(a) Scope of Piling Work and Valuation

The value of Works completed at any stage shall be the product of the net penetration of driven
piles as specified in subclause 2.29(i) "Penetration of Piles" and the rate per metre run, as
described in the Rates. Unless described otherwise, such Rate shall include preliminaries, all
labour, materials, Construction Equipment and its mobilisation, supply and driving of piles,
excavation for piling and cutting, piles cutting, wastage and everything necessary for the
execution and completion of piling work.

The difference between the value of piling works completed and that as specified in the Contract
as computed in the manner described in the preceding paragraph shall be adjusted as a variation
to the Contract.

(b) Construction Equipment & Experience for Driving Piles

Submit together with the Tender, a schedule including full details of the Construction Equipment
to be committed on the Site. A resume showing the experience of the Contractor and operators
in piling work shall also be submitted.

(c) Warranty

Be responsible for the proper execution of the piling work according to the Specifications and the
pile layout Drawings. Make good any damage or Defect to the super-structure resulting from
Defective execution of Works at the Contractor's costs and expenses to the satisfaction of the
SO Rep. The warranty period shall be one year after the completion of the superstructure.

CE21/S2.DOC(9)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-10

2.29 TIMBER PILING (CONT’D)

(d) Timber Piles

Timber piles specified shall be from the HDB Materials List.

Timber piles shall be 100mm x 100mm, 125mm x 125mm, 150mm x 150mm or 175mm x 175mm
square sawn timber foundation piles with an allowable tolerance of ±5mm, produced from the
species Kempas or Keruing. The safe working load shall be 8.5 N per mm2 in direct compressive
stress and with an ultimate resistance of all piles of not less than 3 times the nominal working
load.

The centre line of pile shall not deviate from the straight line joining the mid points of the butt and
toe by more than 25mm for any pile up to 6m in length, or 38mm for pile over 6m in length.

Use only timber piles produced under the ISO 9000 or PSB Singapore Quality Mark/Product
Listing Scheme/Certification Scheme Suppliers.

Each batch of piles delivered to the Site shall be subjected to random sampling, for testing by an
SAC accredited laboratory, in accordance with the following frequency :

(i) for every contract supply, a minimum of two tests;

(ii) For supply up to 3,000 metre run, the first test will be carried out from any batch of piles,
subsequent test will be made at each interval of 3,000 metre run, the number of test will
depend on the quantity of supply but subject to a minimum of two tests for each contract
as stated in (i) above.

All piles shall be pressure-treated with copper-chrome-arsenic wood preservative under a


pressure of not less than 12.5 kg per cm2, with minimum depth of penetration of preservative of
25mm and with a net dry salt retention in the outermost 25mm of pile of not less than 16kg per
m3. All methods of chemical treatment and testing shall be in accordance with SS 72 : 1988 or
BS 4072. The SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to
impose charges against the Contractor for each test that fails to comply with the above
requirement.

In the event that any test by SAC accredited laboratory resulted in failure, remove the batch of
piles from which the random sampling is obtained completely from the Site. Should the
Contractor negligently or wilfully transport the same batch that had failed previously to the Site
again, this act shall be deemed to be an infringement and Clause 1.6 "Nuisance & Irregularities"
shall apply.

(e) Steel Box Joint

Join two piles by using a mild steel welded box joint 450mm long made from 4.5mm thick plate
and coat with bituminous paint and approved by the SO Rep before use.

(f) Hammer and Set for Pile Driving

Use free drop hammer to drive the timber pile. The hammer weight for driving 175mm x 175mm
pile shall be 1.5 tonnes, and for driving 150mm x 150mm, 125mm x 125mm or 100mm x 100mm
pile shall be 1 tonne.

The hammer shall drop a minimum of 1300mm. The acceptable set for the last 10 blows for
175mm x 175mm pile shall be not more than 15mm. The acceptable set for the last 10 blows
for 150mm x 150mm, 125mm x 125mm or 100mm x 100mm pile shall be not more than 20mm.

(g) Driving of Piles

Drive Piles accurately in the correct locations true to line both laterally and longitudinally as
indicated in the Drawings.

Guide piles at the top and bottom during driving and suitably constrain them to maintain their
correct position by means of guides. No piles which has been deflected from its course, or has
been wrongly aligned may be forcibly brought back to correct alignment except with the written
approval of the SO Rep.

CE21/S2.DOC(10)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-11

2.29 TIMBER PILING (CONT’D)

(g) Driving of Piles (Cont’d)

The centre of each pile shall not deviate from its true position as shown in the Drawings by more
than 25mm. Bear all additional costs of the amendment in pilecaps, ground beams, etc as
designated by the SO Rep as a countermeasure to the pile eccentricities exceeding the
permissible tolerance. Alternatively, the SO Rep may require extra piles to be driven at the
Contractor's own cost and expense.

During driving, protect the heads of all piles with the helmet of mild steel fitting closely around
the pile. A 25mm thick plywood covering the head of the pile shall be contained within the helmet
to separate the helmet from the head of the pile.

Rigidly & securely join all piles with metal box joints. The joints shall be driven to a tight fit with
the pile hammer and spiked to the section of both piles.

(h) Piling Record

Drive piles only in the presence of the SO Rep. The penetrations and sets of every pile shall be
subject to the approval of the SO Rep. Record of driving for every pile shall be submitted to the
SO Rep and a copy shall be kept by the Contractor on the Site. The record shall include the
following items :

(i) Set
(ii) Temporary compression
(iii) Penetration from ground level
(iv) Length of pile and size of section
(v) Ground level
(vi) Cut-off level to the top of pile
(vii) No. of joints used
(viii) Time of starting and time of completion

The method of measuring set and temporary compression shall be approved by the SO Rep.
The above record shall show a series of sets and temporary compressions measured during the
whole process of driving. Once the driving of a pile is commenced it shall continue until the final
penetration or set is reached.

(i) Penetration of Piles

The penetration of driven piles is the actual length measured from the bottom tip to the cut-off
level of the driven piles. The penetration of every pile shall be recorded by the Contractor in the
presence of the SO Rep. Mark the timber piles with red paint at every 300mm or other suitable
interval to enable easy determination of pile penetration.

(j) Damaged or Rejected Piles

All piles which are broomed, split or damaged during handling or transportation shall be rejected.
All piles damaged during driving, or driven unduly out of position, or driven out of plumb resulting
in no set after driving for considerable length, where it should set based on soil data and site
condition, shall also be rejected.

(k) Compensating Piles

Replace all piles driven into ground and rejected with compensating pile or piles. The position
and number of compensating pile/s as decided by the SO Rep shall be such that the concentricity
of the pile group is not altered. The Employer shall only pay the cost for the original number of
pile/s in the pile group as shown in the Drawings.

(l) Removal of Obstructions of Piling

In the course of piling, only the removal of natural obstruction 2.5m below the ground surface
shall be paid for by the Employer as an extra item based on the Contract Rates and only if the
SO Rep is satisfied that the Contractor has made every effort to proceed with piling by avoiding
the obstruction. Any excavation for obstruction not exceeding 2.5m, including restoring of ground
surrounding the piles, and any other works necessary to complete the operation to the
satisfaction of the SO Rep shall be deemed to be included in the Contract.

CE21/S2.DOC(11)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-12

2.29 TIMBER PILING (CONT’D)

(m) Cutting off of Piles

Excavate and cut off the pile to the required level shown on the pile layout Drawings or otherwise
directed by the SO Rep. Checking and recording of cut-off level shall be followed up immediately.

In the cutting of piles, ensure that a surveyor is stationed at the Site for such work.

Do not reuse any pile which has been cut off as wastage unless the waste pile length exceeds
2.5m and the cut-off head has been treated.

2.30 PAINTING

(a) Material

All paints, primers and other materials shall comply with SS5, SS6, SS7, SS34, SS37, SS38,
SS150, SS206 and SS345 or other relevant specifications of PSB.

(i) Enamel Gloss Paint

Paint for timber and metal work shall have a synthetic enamel gloss finish with an alkyd-
resin base.

Where an undercoat is specified, obtain the paint from the same manufacturer whose
gloss paint is approved for the particular work. A different brand shall not be used unless
the SO Rep has given his consent.

If more than one under-coat is specified, the undercoats shall be of different colour from
each other to enable the number of coats applied to be checked. Before the following
coat is applied, allow each coat at least 24 hours to dry. Carry out painting with proper
paint brushes. Any other method of painting shall not be allowed unless approved by the
SO Rep.

(ii) Primers

Primer for aluminium, zinc or galvanised iron shall be an approved Etching Primer with a
Polyvinyl resin base and then cover with another coat of approved lead and chromate free
primer with a pure linseed oil base. Thoroughly mix etching primer with the Activator
before use in the ratio of 3 parts Base to 1 part Activator. Being a dual pack material, the
mixture shall have a pot life of 12 hours.

Carry out the painting of etching primer coat under shed or in the factory.

The dried etching primer coat shall not come in contact with water and apply a coat of
Red lead primer over it within two days from the date of applying the etching primer.

(iii) Emulsion Paint

All emulsion paints shall be of an approved brand with an acrylic base. Apply with a proper
paint brush and not a locally made colour wash brush. If more than one coat is specified
the previous coat shall be properly dried before the following coat is applied.

(iv) Driveway Marking Paints

All paints used for driveway marking shall be water based acrylic road marking paint and
shall comply in all respects with the requirements specified in the Singapore Standard
624:2016 for Road Marking painting.

The SO Rep may direct the Contractor to change the supplier or manufacturer of the
paints used in this Contract if he is satisfied that the paints used in this Contract do not
comply with the Specifications.

Deliver all paints for driveway marking to the Site ready for use. When the container for
the paint is opened, the paint shall show no signs of livering or instability and be free from
skin, dry sediment, and caking and shall mix readily with a paddle to a smooth
homogeneous state.

CE21/S2.DOC(12)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-13

2.30 PAINTING (CONT’D)

(b) Equipment

Mechanisation in all aspects of painting of road line and driveway markings is compulsory under
the Contract. It shall be a prerequisite for the Contractor to own and make available the following
equipment for use under the Contract :

(i) Driveway Marking Machines

The marking machine shall be self-propelled and constructed so as to apply or spray paint
under pressure in continuous uniformity to dimensions of the markings. It shall be
equipped with the devices for agitation of the paint while in operation. All parts of the
apparatus which come into contact with the paint shall be so constructed as to be easily
cleaned and maintained.

The marking machine shall be capable of adjustment to provide a uniform spray wet film
thickness of between 200 to 500 microns and in this respect shall be automatically self-
drive and be capable of travelling at uniform speed. It shall be mobile and manoeuvrable
to the extent that straight lines can be followed and regular curves can be prescribed in a
true arc. The apparatus shall have the capacity of selection of either automatic or manual
skip marking operations preferably to four pre-set programmes. The apparatus shall also
be capable of marking line widths varying from 100mm to 600mm with extended facilities
of applying paint to symbolic signs and messages using templates.

The marking machine shall also be equipped with devices capable of applying glass
beads balloting in such a manner that the balloting are dispersed almost instantly upon
the freshly painted surface at a rate of 0.72 kg per litre of paint or at the recommended
rate of the paint manufacturer. The balloting depositor shall be synchronised with the cut
off of the paint application control. The balloting shall be applied with sufficient velocity to
ensure retention in the surface of the paint.

(ii) Roadline Erasing Machine

The machine shall be mechanically propelled and be able to erase road lines uniformly in
the cold state.

(c) Mode of Operation

All road line paintings and driveway markings which, continuous broken lines, numerals, arrows,
letterings, etc shall be fully mechanised and drawn or spray painted by road line painting
machine. On no account shall the paint be applied by brushes to road lines and markings and
in the event that such lines and markings are so drawn, such work shall be rejected.

Painting of other traffic appurtenances and road related facilities may unless otherwise directed
by the SO Rep be carried out by brushes. Under such circumstances the workmanship shall be
of the highest standard and care shall be exercised to produce a smooth and uniform coat of
paint.

CE21/S2.DOC(13)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-14

2.30 PAINTING (CONT'D)

(d) Weather Conditions

(i) No painting shall be done on surfaces which are wet or damp from rain, dew or any other
causes until they have been properly dried.

(ii) Prepare all surfaces before the application of paints. Preparation shall have the following
meaning for the surfaces indicated :

Preparation

1) On new concrete or plastered surfaces to receive cement paint or emulsion paint :

Prepare by washing down with soap (if necessary) to remove dirt, grease and other
adhering materials. Rinse off with clean water and allow to dry thoroughly.

(2) On existing painted plastered or concrete surfaces to receive cement paint or


emulsion paint :

Prepare by removing all nails etc., scraping thoroughly and brushing briskly with a
stiff brush to remove efflorescence and flaking materials. Where necessary wash
down with soap to remove dirt, grease and rinse off with clean water and allow to
dry thoroughly. Make good areas of defective plaster or concrete and fill up cracks
and holes with approved filler.

(3) New metal surfaces to receive paint :

Prepare by scraping and removing all rust and mill scales by sand paper and rub
down with emery cloth.

(4) Existing painted metal surface to receive primer coat and paint :

Prepare by burning down all existing paint, thoroughly wash off the surface with
soap and rinse with clean water. Allow it to dry thoroughly and rub down with emery
cloth.

(5) Existing painted surface to receive paint only :

Prepare by rubbing down with sand paper to remove flaky old paints, and rinse
surface thoroughly with water and allow to dry thoroughly.

(6) Painting of road line and driveway markings :

Prepare by sweeping off all dust, grit and foreign matter on the driveway surface
with stiff brushes. Mark out to the required dimensions and alignment for
directional arrows, continuous or broken lines, lettering, etc. before the application
of the paint.

(e) Wet Film Thickness

Supply all paints for driveway marking ready mixed by the manufacturer and no thinning with any
materials to the already mixed paints shall be permitted.

Apply all paints for driveway marking by machine approved by the SO Rep to a wet film thickness
of 300 microns (plus or minus 25 microns).

(f) Colour Scheme

The colour schemes for any work and the various coats to be applied shall be determined by the
SO Rep.

CE21/S2.DOC(14)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-15

2.30 PAINTING (CONT'D)

(g) Adulteration

(i) Under no circumstances shall any oil or spirit be added to paint. All oil or spirit found in
the possession of any painter or the presence on Site of any tins, drums, kegs or other
containers marked with the name of a brand or material or manufacturer different from
those which the SO Rep has selected to be used, as a receptacle for brushes, as paint
kettles, etc. shall be deemed as evidence of adulteration.

(ii) Before any paint is applied, the prepared surfaces shall be inspected and approved by
the SO Rep.

(iii) After a coat has been applied the succeeding coat shall not be applied until the work has
similarly been inspected and approved and not before 24 hours have lapsed after the first
application.

(h) Durability of Paintwork

The visibility of road lines and driveway markings shall not be decreased by more than 50% at
any time after the initial painting or repainting.

Provide everything necessary to maintain all paintworks during the Defects Liability Period.

For road lines and driveway markings, repaint the entire work when the paintworks failed to meet
the above requirement and at the end of the Defects Liability Period. In this respect, the decision
of the Superintending Officer on the 50% visibility requirement shall be final.

For other painted items of structures, provide everything necessary and repaint every and all
such items with 1 coat of approved paints at the end of the Defects Liability Period. Satisfactorily
attend to all Defect such as rust, chipped or dented surfaces, etc. prior to repainting. In this
respect, arrange a joint site meeting with the SO Rep before any remedial work is carried out,
and comply with all requirements as directed.

2.31 REFLECTORISED THERMOPLASTIC ROAD MARKING

(a) General

Where reflectorised thermoplastic road marking is indicated on the Drawings or where directed
by the SO Rep, the road shall be prepared and the prime coat and reflectorised thermoplastic
road marking supplied and applied in the manner as specified.

On receipt of instructions from the SO Rep, proceed promptly with such work on receipt of such
instructions. Carry out the Works continuously and complete within such time as specified
allowing only for unavoidable lost time because of any inclement weather during the course of
the Works.

(b) Material Specifications

(i) Thermoplastic Material

The thermoplastic material to be used under this Specifications shall comply with the
British Standard BS 3262:1982 - "Hot Applied Thermoplastic Road Marking Materials".
The material shall be able to resist damage caused by the spillage of petroleum on the
road. The material shall be tough, durable, elastic and of heavy duty, formulated to adhere
excellently on pavements of all descriptions and to provide superior resistance to
abrasion. The material shall be able to withstand the ravages of traffic impacts, staining
and flaking.

CE21/S2.DOC(15)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-16

2.31 REFLECTORISED THERMOPLASTIC ROAD MARKING (CONT’D)

(b) Material Specifications (Cont’d)

(i) Thermoplastic Material (Cont’d)

The thermoplastic material shall be so manufactured to be applied by extrusion onto the


pavement in molten form with glass beads mixed in and also dropped into the material
immediately after it is applied. Reflectorization with solid glass beads of a suitable grading
shall be used to improve the visibility of road markings at night. The proportion and
grading of glass beads shall be in accordance with subclause 2.31(b)(vi) "Solid Glass
Beads" specified hereunder and shall be correctly sprayed to achieve the specified
retroreflection throughout its lifetime.

(ii) Aggregate

The aggregate shall consist of light coloured silica and, calcite, quartz and calcined flint.

(iii) Pigment

White material shall be of titanium dioxide complying with the requirements of type A
(anatese) or type R (rutile) of BS 1851.

Yellow material shall consist of sufficient yellow pigment of lead chromate of sufficient
heat stability when heated to temperature of 200 degrees Centigrade to substitute part or
all of the titanium dioxide.

(iv) Extender

Extender shall be in whiting (calcium carbonate prepared from natural chalk) complying
with BS 1795.

(v) Binder

Binder shall consist of synthetic hydrocarbon resin plasticized with mineral oil.

(vi) Solid Glass Beads

The reflectorization shall be done by solid glass bead, of which the following classes are
appropriate for use :

Class Application

A Incorporation in thermoplastic road marking compounds

Surface applied for thermoplastic road marking compounds and


B
pavement marking paints

The solid glass bead shall be made from soda glass and not less than 70% by mass shall
be of transparent glass, reasonably spherical and free from flaws.

Class A glass beads shall conform to the following requirements of BS 6088 with respect
to particle size distribution, roundness and defect :

Minimum % spherical Maximum % of


beads by mass tested defective beads as
%
Sieve in accordance with tested in accordance
Retained
Appendix C of with Appendix D of
BS 3262 BS 3262

1.18 mm 0 to 3 )
1.18 mm 0 to 3 ) 70 30
850 µm 0 to 10 )
425 µm 90 to 100 )

CE21/S2.DOC(16)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-17

2.31 REFLECTORISED THERMOPLASTIC ROAD MARKING (CONT’D)

(b) Material Specifications (Cont’d)

(vi) Solid Glass Beads (Cont’d)

Class B glass beads shall conform to the following requirements of BS 6088 with respect
to particle size distributions, roundness and defect :

Minimum % spherical Maximum % of


beads by mass tested defective beads as
%
Sieve in accordance with tested in accordance
Retained
Appendix C of with Appendix D of
BS 3262 BS 3262
(µm)

850 0 to 5 )
600 5 to 20 )
300 30 to 75 ) 80 20
180 10 to 30 )
Below 180 0 to 315 )

The solid glass beads may be applied by either gravity feed or air assisted feed and may
have a moisture proof coating or a flotation coating.

The solid glass bead used shall be of the chemical composition given in the tables below :

Chemical Composition Requirement

Silicon dioxide Si0 2 not less than 70%

Calcium oxide Ca0 ) )


Magnesium oxide Mg0 ) ) together not less than 8%
Sodium oxide Na 2 0 ) )

Potassium oxide K20 ) )


Aluminium oxide Al 2 0 3 ) ) together not more than 18%
Ferric oxide Fe 2 0 3 ) )

The proportion of the constituents of the mixed materials shall comply with the following
requirements :

Percentage by Mass of
Item Constituents Total Mixture
Minimum Maximum
1 Binder (resin and oil) 18 22

2 Solid glass beads 20+ -

3 Aggregate, pigment extender,


78 82
and solid glass beads*

* where specified.

+ 20% shall be maintained even in the case of material to which solid


glass beads are to be applied by pressure application.

CE21/S2.DOC(17)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-18

2.31 REFLECTORISED THERMOPLASTIC ROAD MARKING (CONT’D)

(b) Material Specifications (Cont’d)

(vi) Solid Glass Beads (Cont’d)

The grading or the combined aggregates, pigment, extender and solid glass beads as
found on analysis shall comply with the following requirements :

Sieve Size Percentage by mass passing

2.80mm 100
600 microns 75 - 95

(c) Equipment Specification

Mechanisation in all aspects of painting of road line and carriageway markings is compulsory
under this Contract. It shall be a pre-requisite for the Contractor to own and make available the
following equipment for use under the Contract :

(i) Carriageway Marking Machines

The equipment shall be self propelled and constructed so as to apply thermoplastic


roadmarking using screed method, or where the roadmarking thickness required are of
1.5mm only, spray thermoplastic can be applied.

It shall be equipped with devices to provide uniform heating, continuous mixing and
agitation of the material with balloting beads while in operation.

The equipment shall be capable of adjustment to ensure continuous uniformity in the


dimensions of the stripe. It shall be mobile and manoeuvrable to the extent that straight
lines can be prescribed in a true arc. It shall provide a means of clearly cutting off square
stripe ends upon the installed line. The finished lines shall have well-defined edges and
free of wariness.

Provide a special melting kettle for heating, melting and mixing of the thermoplastic
material. The kettle shall be equipped with a correct thermometer so as to provide positive
temperature control and prevent overheating of the thermoplastic material. Heated
thermal oil jacket may be utilised to keep the thermoplastic material at constant
temperature. When the spray method is employed, the traverse speed of the equipment
shall be between five to seven kph. In this case, a self contained preheater unit shall be
provided. The heating shall be by oil jacket and thermostatically controlled. A transport
trailer unit towable easily by a land rover or equivalent vehicle shall be provided for the
transportation of the spray machine from site to site. The trailer shall be twin-ram and of
tiltable deck raised and lowered by a screw lever device without any wheel housing to
interfere with a machine having side mounted equipment.

The equipment shall also be equipped with devices capable of applying solid glass beads
ballotini in such a manner that the ballotini are dispersed upon the freshly painted surface.
The ballotini depositor shall be synchronised with the cut off of the paint application
control. The ballotini shall be applied at a sufficient rate to ensure retention in the surface
of the paint. For the case of a glass bead spray gun, the rate of glass bead dispersion
shall be up to 7 kg per minute.

All parts of the equipment which come into contact with the paint shall be so constructed
as to be easily cleaned and maintained. Ensure that the equipment is properly cleaned
or maintained at all times.

(ii) Roadline Erasing Machine

The apparatus shall be mechanically propelled and be able to erase road lines uniformly
in the cold state.

CE21/S2.DOC(18)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-19

2.31 REFLECTORISED THERMOPLASTIC ROAD MARKING (CONT’D)

(c) Equipment Specification (Cont’d)

(iii) Retroreflectometer For Measuring Retroreflectives Of Roadmarking

It is essential that the Contractor provides at least two (2) units of retroreflectometer for
use in this Contract. The instrument shall be robust, simple and quick to operate, weighing
not more than 10kg and portable (preferably having dimensions not more than 500mm x
210mm x 210mm) and be operated by one-operator. It shall be easily connected to a 24
Volt car-battery or a suitable generator for power supply and shall have digital readout in
mcd/lx.m2. The measuring area of the instrument shall be of a maximum width of 100mm
for each reading taken. The measuring geometry shall be as follows :

Entrance Angle : 86.5%


Observer Angle : -85%

The lamp used shall be a single 12 volt 100W halogen/quartz Iodide lamp which shall be
easily replaceable without tools. The instrument shall be internally zeroed and calibrated;
ie. it shall have a built in zero and reference standard and when in normal use shall be
capable of setting to zero and calibrating to 600 (six hundred) mcd/lx.m2.

(iv) Deep Frame Micrometer For Measuring Thickness Of Roadmarking

It is essential that the Contractor provide two units of approved deep frame micrometer
with an anvil area of at least 10mm2 and an accuracy of 0.01mm for use in measuring the
Works.

(d) Method Specifications For Application Of Thermoplastic Roadmarking

(i) Preparation of Site

An approved adhesive primer coat at the rate of 220 g per m2 shall be provided on old
polished surfaces of bituminous pavements, existing road markings and on concrete
before the markings are applied to ensure optimum adhesion. The thermoplastic material
shall not be laid over loose detritus, mud or extraneous matter or over old flaking markings
of road line paint or thermoplastic material.

The road surface shall be clean and absolutely dry before markings are placed over. The
surface shall be swept by a handsweeper, and any damp spot or grease stain shall be
burned off with a gas burner.

In events whereby existing road lines and markings are out of alignment with the new
thermoplastic lines and markings, erase off such existing road lines and markings using
Roadline Erasing Machine.

(ii) To avoid discoloration and embrittlement of the material due to heating at a temperature
in excess of that laid by the manufacturer, the thermoplastic material shall be heated in
sufficient quantities in a heater fitted with a mechanical stirrer. Once molten, the material
shall be laid on expeditiously. It shall not remain in a molten state for more than 6 hours
for hydrocarbon resins and shall not at any time be heated above the manufacturer's
declared safe heating temperature.

(iii) Laying Of Thermoplastic Materials

The application of the material to the road shall be by machines using the screed and/or
spray method. Equip the machine with various sizes of shoes or to employ a range of
machines that would enable him to mark the required lines in one pass. The materials
shall be laid within the temperature range specified by the manufacturer and not
exceeding 180 degrees Centigrade. The thermoplastic markings shall be uniform in
texture and thickness and free from blisters, bubbles and streaks. The finished lines shall
be sharp and free of ragged edges.

Proper templates shall be used for marking of arrows and letterings.

The thermoplastic material shall be applied at the specified thickness excluding surface
applied solid glass beads or otherwise specified.

CE21/S2.DOC(19)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-20

2.31 REFLECTORISED THERMOPLASTIC ROAD MARKING (CONT’D)

(d) Method Specifications For Application Of Thermoplastic Roadmarking


(Cont’d)

(iii) Laying Of Thermoplastic Materials (Cont’d)

Prepare the road surface thoroughly to ensure satisfactory adhesion of the thermoplastic
material.

The road surface shall be free from moisture and loose particles. The application of the
material shall take place when the road temperature is lower than 40 degrees Centigrade
and the relative humidity of the air not greater than 85%.

(iv) Reflectorization By Surface Application

The material shall have minimum 20% (by weight) of ballotini beads incorporated in the
thermoplastic as specified in sub clause 2.31(b)(vi) "Solid Glass Beads". To achieve
immediate reflection, a further quantity of glass beads shall be sprayed onto the hot
material at the time of application. The beads shall be applied by pneumatically "fired"
drop-on or by gravity at the rate of approximately 300 ±50 g per m2, immediately after the
thermoplastic material has been deposited on the road but before it has hardened.

The retroreflectorization of the thermoplastic roadmarking shall be measured in the field


by the retroreflectometer as in subclause 2.31(c)(iii) "Retroreflectometer For Measuring
Retroreflectives of Roadmarking".

Measurements shall be done at suitable time when traffic density is lowest and with proper
signing as specified in subclause 1.5.1 "Site Safety Measures".

(v) Thickness

The material shall be laid to the specified thickness of 1.5mm/3.0mm. When the film
thickness is specified as 1.5mm/3.0mm, the minimum thickness of thermoplastic lines, as
viewed from a lateral cross section, shall be not less than 1.5mm/3.0mm at the edge and
centre. These measurement shall be taken as an average through any one metre section
of the line.

The minimum thickness specified are exclusive of surface applied solid glass beads. The
method of thickness measurement shall be in accordance with Appendix B of
BS 3262:1981.

(e) Performance Specification and Related Test Methods

All material properties and their related test methods shall as far as possible conform to
BS 3262:1981 unless otherwise stated or approved by the SO Rep.

Generally the material shall be easy to apply, has high brightness, very short overdriving time
and very low dirt attack. In order for the material to be considered it shall have the following
properties :

(i) Colour Luminance

When tested in accordance with BS 3262:1981 Appendix D, the luminance factor of white
shall not be less than 70 (as delivered) while that for yellow shall not be less than 80 (as
delivered).

(ii) Density

The density of the thermoplastic material shall not be less than 1.65 kg per litre.

(iii) Softening Point

When tested by the Ring and Ball method in connection with Appendix C of BS 4692, the
softening point shall be greater than 80 degrees Centigrade.

CE21/S2.DOC(20)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-21

2.31 REFLECTORISED THERMOPLASTIC ROAD MARKING (CONT’D)

(e) Performance Specification and Related Test Methods


(Cont’d)

(iv) Heat Stability

When tested in accordance with Appendix E of BS 3262:1981, the decrease in luminance


factor of the white and yellow material as measured in accordance with Appendix D shall
not be more than 5.

(v) Flow Resistance

A cone made and tested in accordance with Appendix F BS 3262:1981 shall not slump
by more than 25%.

(vi) Resistance to Calcium Chloride

The material when immersed in a strong solution of calcium chloride for a period of 4
weeks will remain completely unaffected.

(vii) Viscosity

The material shall possess the following characteristics - solid at 20 degrees Centigrade,
thick fluid at 170 degrees Centigrade.

(viii) Abrasive Resistance

The material shall possess excellent wear-resistance properties. The wear resistance
shall be measured on a Taber Abraser Type 503 standard abrasion tester using H-22
calibrate wheels in accordance with Appendix K of BS 3262:1981. The loss in weight of
the test panel after 200 revolutions shall not exceed 0.5g.

(ix) Skid Resistance

When tested in accordance with Appendix G, BS3262:1981 skid resistance of the newly
placed road marking or any roadmarking that is still within the Defects Liability Period shall
not be less than 45.

(x) Degree Of Erosion

When the material applied in accordance with the Specifications, is tested in accordance
with Appendix M of BS 3262:1981, the total wear index for the test area on each stripe
shall not exceed 30 at each of the regular inspection intervals.

(xi) Reflectivity

Measure the reflectivity by the retroreflectometer as specified in subclauses 2.31(c)(iii)


"Retroreflectometer For Measuring Retroreflectives Of Roadmarking" and 2.31(d)(iv)
"Reflectorization By Surface Application" immediately after the thermoplastic roadmarking
has hardened.

Four measurements are to be taken at representative locations.

The average of the ten readings in any one measurement shall achieve :

(a) For white roadmarking : retroreflection reading not less than


300 mcd/lx.m2

(b) For yellow roadmarking and : retroreflection reading not less than
other colours 200 mcd/lx.m2

CE21/S2.DOC(21)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-22

2.31 REFLECTORISED THERMOPLASTIC ROAD MARKING (CONT’D)

(e) Performance Specification and Related Test Methods


(Cont’d)

(xii) Thickness Of Material Laid

Measure the thickness of the thermoplastic laid by a deep frame micrometer.

Carry out measurements immediately after the thermoplastic roadmarking has hardened.

10 measurements are to be taken at representative locations. For each measurement at


a selected location, 3 samples' mean of 4 readings are taken by the deep frame
micrometer to make up one measurement. The 3 samples are to be taken from positions
at least 3 metres apart. The average of the 3 samples' mean forming one measurement
shall not be less than the thickness specified in subclause 2.31(d)(v) "Thickness" and as
shown in the Drawings.

(xiii) Non-Compliance Of Thickness And Reflectivity

If the thickness or reflectivity is found to be below the values specified, grind away the
surface of the portions represented by the sample readings and then apply thermoplastic
material and glass beads to bring the thickness to 1.5/3mm and the reflectivity to at least
the minimum required values.

(f) Shape and Spacing Of Roadmarking

For new road surfaces, ensure that the surface be sufficiently clean and dry before the application
of the thermoplastic material. The Contractor shall be responsible for erasing the old road-
markings and the resetting of the whole intersection and marking of the lines to the required
widths and dimensions as shown in the Drawings or as directed where existing markings have
faded or have run out of alignment.

All markings shall be laid in accordance with the Drawings.

(g) Guarantee Of Material Quality

Guarantee the thermoplastic road marking material furnished and installed under the
Specifications against failure due to poor adhesion resulting from defective materials or method
of application for a period of twelve (12) months in conjunction with the Defects Liability Period.

(h) Test Samples And Testing For Content Of Material

Present the proposed grading of the glass beads, and aggregates; and samples of the following
materials intended for use under the Specifications to an approved Highway Authority Material
and Research Laboratory for test. The Authority testing the material may be the same country
where the product is manufactured. Details of testing requirements and the test methods shall
conform to BS 3262:1981 Appendices A to M or of a method and standard acceptable to the SO
Rep.

Submit latest test reports of the samples to the SO Rep for consideration.

If materials presented under this subclause are accepted, they shall be the standard by which
materials actually applied under the Contract are compared with.

(i) Samples To Be Supplied At The Start Of Time For Completion

Supply 2 no. of white roadmarking and 2 no. of yellow roadmarking properly laid on
30mm x 150mm aluminium sheets before the commencement date for the Time for Completion.

The thermoplastic roadmarking materials shall be of 3mm thickness.

The tone of colour agreed upon by the SO Rep for the samples shall be used as the standard
tone for all the Works.

The SO Rep reserves the right to request for another supply of these same number of samples
if he feels that the tone of colour has inevitably changed.

CE21/S2.DOC(22)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-23

2.31 REFLECTORISED THERMOPLASTIC ROAD MARKING (CONT’D)

(j) Information Of Product To Be Supplied By Manufacturer

Obtain from the manufacturer the following information of the thermoplastic material proposed
for use for the Works :

(i) Maximum safe heating temperature of the material.


(ii) Temperature range of application for screed laying.
(iii) Flash point of the material.
(iv) Composition of the mixture.

The foregoing information shall be provided to the SO Rep one week before the start of the laying
operation.

(k) Protection Of New Road Marking

Make arrangements for the protection of new marking until such time as the material has `set-
up' sufficiently to resist being damaged by traffic. Replace all materials laid and subsequently
rendered unfit by the action of traffic or other road users.

2.32 WATER FOR THE WORKS

Obtain all water to be used for making mortar or concrete or for other purposes from the PUB mains.
Make provisions for such storage tanks, temporary connections, etc as may be required and for moving
such tanks to keep them sufficiently adjacent to the part or parts of the Works in progress. Arrange for
the supply of water to the Works and for paying all charges.

2.33 CEMENT

All cement used in the Works shall be of approved local manufacture except otherwise permitted by the
SO Rep. Where cement is specified it shall comply with SS 26 and BS 12. With each delivery the
Contractor may be required to send to the SO Rep a memorandum of the quantity delivered and the
manufacturer's test certificate. Unless otherwise specified, the compressive strength test shall be used
to determine the strength of cement.

2.34 CEMENT STORE

Provide on the Site a building or shed to be used exclusively for the purpose of storing the cement. This
building or shed shall be dry inside and closed to entry of water, have thoroughly dry floors and walls,
be well lighted and ventilated and be capable of holding at least one month's supply of cement and at
least sufficient cement for two week's supply shall always be kept in the shed. So far as is practicable
keep different consignments of cement separately. Use cement in the order in which it has been
delivered to the Site on a first in first out basis and the method of storage shall be arranged to facilitate
this requirement.

Keep cement in the store until it is actually required for use on the Works and any cement temporarily
placed near the mixer or elsewhere, after removal from the store, shall be adequately protected by
approved means. Cement shall not be kept in a temporary store except in so far as is necessary to
allow for efficient organisation of the mixing plant.

If the Contractor proposes to use cement delivered in bulk obtain the prior approval of the SO Rep as
to the method of delivery and storage.

If the Contractor refuses to accept the cement delivered to the Site by the supplier on the instruction of
the SO Rep but instead accepts the cement from another supplier, the SO Rep shall impose charges
against the Contractor in accordance with the provisions as spelt out in Clause 1.6 "Nuisance &
Irregularities".

CE21/S2.DOC(23)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-24

2.35 CEMENT TESTING

The SO Rep and his representative shall have access to the cement store at all reasonable hours and
shall be furnished with the means of identifying the several consignments of cement.

Cement shall comply with SS 26 and BS 4550. The manufacturer's approved test certificate shall
normally be accepted as proof of compliance with the Specifications.

2.36 AGGREGATES

2.36.1 General Requirements

Fine aggregates shall be uncrushed sand or crushed granite fines complying with SS EN 12620. Where
crushed granite fines are used, its percentage of the total amount of fine aggregates shall not exceed
30%. The upper sieve size (D) for fine aggregates shall be 4 mm.

Coarse aggregates shall be crushed or uncrushed gravel, crushed or uncrushed stone complying with
SS EN 12620.

Coarse aggregates shall not exceed 40mm in size for lean and mass concrete and 20mm for reinforced
concrete, unless otherwise specified.

All-in aggregates as specified in SS EN 12620 and aggregates derived from limestone or other materials
inferior to granite shall not be used. The upper sieve size (D) for coarse aggregates shall be 20 mm and
the lower sieve size (d) shall be 4 mm.

Aggregates shall be stored on clean surfaces in separate stockpiles or bunkers to prevent intermingling
of different materials and contamination. Aggregates used for concrete batching plant on site shall be
covered with a light roof cover. Fine aggregates shall be tested for moisture content constantly to
facilitate moisture compensation during concrete production. The testing shall be carried out based on
the Speedy method or other approved equivalent method approved by the SO Rep.

The SO Rep reserves the right to draw samples of aggregates from any stockpile at any time and have
them tested for compliance with Approved Standards of SS EN 12620, BS EN 933, BS EN 1097, ASTM
C295 and ASTM C289. The samples shall be sent for testing at the HDB’s Engineering Materials
Laboratory. Aggregates failing to comply with the Approved Standards shall be rejected.

2.36.2 Supply From The Contractor’s Source

(a) Certificate Of Compliance

The Contractor shall ensure that the quality of his own supply comply fully with the Specifications
and Approved Standards. The Contractor shall within one (1) month from the date of the Letter
of Acceptance inform and seek the SO Rep’s prior approval in writing of his source of supply
together with test reports from SAC-SINGLAS accredited laboratories for each source of his
supply on the following properties:

(i) 20mm Aggregate

(a) particle size distribution - sieving method;


(b) flakiness index;
(c) shape index;
(d) volume stability – dry shrinkage;
(e) aggregate resistance to fragmentation;
(f) bulk density;
(i) particle density and water absorption;
(j) fines content;
(k) shell content;
(l) acid soluble sulphates content;
(m) sulphate content;
(n) humus content (lighter than Organic Plate No. 3);
(o) chloride content (not more than 0.01%);
(p) potential alkali-silica reactivity (Mortar Bar Method);
(q) petrographic examination;
(r) other properties as specified by the SO Rep.

CE21/S2.DOC(24)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-25

2.36.2 Supply From The Contractor’s Source (Cont’d)

(a) Certificate Of Compliance (Cont’d)

(ii) Concreting Sand

(a) particle size distribution - sieving method;


(b) fines Content (not more than 3.00%);
(c) humus content (lighter than Organic Plate No 3);
(d) chloride content (not more than 0.01%);
(e) bulk density;
(f) particle density and water absorption;
(g) assessment of fines (Methylene Blue Test);
(h) potential alkali-silica reactivity (Mortar Bar Method);
(i) magnesium sulphate soundness;
(j) elemental analysis (in percentage):
- Silica as SiO 2
- Aluminium Oxide as AI 2 O 3
- Iron Oxide as Fe 2 O 3
- Titanium Oxide as TiO 2
- Calcium Oxide as CaO
- Magnesium Oxide as MgO
- Chromium Oxide as Cr 2 O 3
- Sodium Oxide as Na 2 O
- Potassium Oxide as K 2 O
- Sulphate as SO 4
- loss on Ignition at 900 0C
(k) acid soluble sulphates content;
(l) volume stability – dry shrinkage;
(m) petrographic examination;
(n) any other element(s) which may exist in the concreting sand; and
(l) other properties as specified by the SO Rep.

All test reports shall be the original or certified true copies from a SAC-SINGLAS accredited
laboratory. The test reports shall not be dated more than three (3) month from the submission
date of the test reports to the SO Rep.

Other than due to circumstances beyond the Contractor's control, the Contractor shall not be
allowed to change the source of supply at his discretion. The Contractor shall be required seek
the SO Rep’s prior approval in writing for any change in his supply sources, together with the
documents laid down hereinabove.

(b) Test Requirements

The Contractor shall, in the presence of SO Rep, be required to take and send samples taken
from his own supply during the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated
damages are imposed under the Contract for testing at the SAC-SINGLAS accredited laboratory.

The quality of the aggregates to be supplied shall comply in every respect with the Specifications
and Approved Standards, and the conditions, analysis and test requirements laid down in the SS
EN, BS EN, ASTM (especially SS EN 12620, BS EN 933, BS EN 1097) classification for
concreting purposes. The number of tests to be conducted during the Time for Completion and
any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract shall be as follows:

CE21/S2.DOC(25)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-26

2.36.2 Supply From The Contractor’s Source (Cont’d)

(b) Test Requirements (Cont’d)

(i) 20mm Aggregate

Properties Frequency of Test


Particle size distribution - sieving method Minimum one test quarterly
Flakiness index
Shape index
Volume stability – dry shrinkage
Aggregate resistance to fragmentation
Bulk density
Particle density and water absorption
Fine content Minimum one test six-
monthly
Shell content
Acid soluble sulphate content
Sulphate content
Humus content
Chloride Content
Potential alkali-silica reactivity
(Mortar Bar Method)
Petrographic examination Minimum one test

The Contractor shall be required to send their 20 mm aggregate supply for the Mortar-Bar
test under ASTM Standard C1260 if the need arises.

CE21/S2.DOC(26)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-27

2.36.2 Supply From The Contractor’s Source (Cont’d)

(b) Test Requirements (Cont’d)

(ii) Concreting Sand

Properties Number of Test


Particle size distribution - sieving method

Fines content (not more than 3%)

Humus content
(lighter than Organic Plate No 3)

Chloride content (not more than 0.01%)


Bulk Density Minimum one test monthly
Particle density and water absorption

Assessment of fines (Methylene Blue Test)


Elemental analysis (in percentage):
(i) Silica as SiO 2
(ii) Aluminium Oxide as Al 2 O 3
Volume stability – dry shrinkage

Full list of properties as specified in the subclause Minimum one test six-
“Certificate of Compliance”. monthly

The Contractor offering from two different supply sources will have both sources subjected to the
test requirements.

All costs and expenses in carrying out all the tests and arranging and sending the test samples
to the Approved Laboratory as required in the Contract including the cost of samples shall be
borne by the Contractor.

2.37 RESERVED

2.38 CEMENT MORTAR

Cement mortar for general purposes shall consist of one volume of Portland Cement to three volumes
of fine aggregates unless otherwise specified or as directed by the SO Rep. Testing of cement mortar
shall comply with BS 4551.

Thoroughly mix the materials in a dry state either by hand on a close jointed wooden platform or in a
mechanical mixer of an approved type and sufficient water shall then be added and the whole mixed to
a mortar of even and proper consistency. The proper consistency is that when moisture is excluded
under a slight pressure, the mortar binds together into a solid lump. Use mortar immediately after it has
been prepared and on no account shall it be used after it has commenced to set.

CE21/S2.DOC(27)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-28

2.39 CONCRETE

Unless otherwise stated, concrete mix refers to "designed mix". In designed mixes, the strength shall
be the main criterion specified, with compliance to minimum and maximum cement content, and
maximum water/cement ratio. The workability of the mix shall be such that the measured slump shall
not deviate from the agreed value by more than + 25mm or one third of the value, whichever is greater,
or Clause 16.6 of BS 5328. Mix design shall be based on a target mean strength not less than the
specified characteristic strength plus 7 N per mm2. The Contractor shall design the mix and shall be
responsible to ensure that the mix supplied will give the required properties including strength. Unless
otherwise specified for protection against aggressive soil conditions, designed concrete mixes shall
comply with the specifications in the Table below :

Specifications For Designed Concrete Mix

Grade 55 50 45 40 35 30 25 20 15
Minimum crushing strength
37 34 30 27 24 20 17 14 9
N per mm2 at 7 days
Characteristic strength N
55 50 45 40 35 30 25 20 15
per mm2 at 28 days
Minimum cement content in kg
per m3 of fully compacted 475 425 375 350 350 325 300 270 205
concrete
Maximum cement content in kg
per m3 of fully compacted 550 550 550 550 550 550 550 550 550
concrete
Maximum water/cement ratio 0.4 0.45 0.45 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.55 0.6 0.7

Design of the mix shall ensure no segregation, no excessive bleeding and ability to achieve specified
surface finish. Segregation and bleeding shall be determined by visual inspection.

"Nominal mix" may be used in place of "designed mix" provided :

° the works are of minor nature or involving a small quantity of concrete.


° the approval of the SO Rep is given.
° the strength of the concrete is still the responsibility of the Contractor.

The Contractor may adopt the prescribed nominal mix and preparation of ingredients as shown in the
table below :
Nominal Mix For Use In Minor Works Or
Involving Small Quantity Of Concrete
Nominal Volume of Volume of Coarse
Class of Weight of Minimum Crushing
Volumetric Fine Aggregates
Concrete Cement Strength
Proportions Aggregates (19mm to 5mm)
kg m3 m3 N per mm2
(a) (b) (c) 7 Days 28 Days
Grade 30 1:1:2 50 0.035 0.07 20 30
Grade 25 1:1.5:3 50 0.050 0.100 17 25
Grade 20 1:2:4 50 0.070 0.140 14 20
Grade 15 1:3:6 50 0.105 0.210 9 15

Basing on :

(a) Cement of bulk density 1450 kg per m3.


(b) Semi-dry sand (30% voids) of bulk density 1600 kg per m3.
(c) Coarse aggregate (45% voids) of bulk density 1400 kg per m3.

The whole of the concrete shall be dense, compact and thoroughly homogeneous. It shall be placed in
foundations, walls, floors, slabs, moulds or shuttering after mixing as soon as practicable and no
concrete shall be placed without being thoroughly tamped and compacted. Complete all tamping well
before the initial setting of the cement commences.

The SO Rep reserves the right to instruct the Contractor to modify, alter and improve the concrete mix
from time to time during the progress of the Works.

CE21/S2.DOC(28)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-29

2.39 CONCRETE (CONT’D)

Keep the fine and coarse aggregates separately until actually mixed in the hopper of the concrete mixer,
which shall be of the batch or other approved type. Mix each batch for a sufficient period to produce a
mixture of even and proper consistency.

Immediately after mixing, convey the concrete to the place of final deposit as rapidly as possible by
methods which will prevent the segregation, loss or contamination of any of the ingredients. In all cases
place the concrete and compact within 20 minutes of the addition of water to the mix. Any concrete left
unplaced after this time or showing any indication of drying out or taking its initial set shall be
immediately rejected and removed from the Works.

Transport the concrete in clean metal buckets, barrows, dumpers or trucks and obtain the written
approval of the SO Rep before any method involving the use of concrete pumps, placers, pipelines,
chutes or spouts may be used.

For transporting concrete by means of chutes, segregation should be minimised by providing a


downpipe at the end of the chute. Chutes shall be of metal or metal-lined, preferably round-bottomed,
and large enough to guard against overflow. Slopes shall not be flatter than 1 to 3 or steeper than 1 to
2 for ordinary mixes. The SO Rep may allow the use of steeper slopes for stiff mixes.

Hand mixing shall be allowed only for small quantities of concrete and subject to the mixing being
satisfactorily performed and approved by the SO Rep and to the addition of 10% extra cement.

Adjust the proportions of water and aggregates according to the moisture content of the aggregate.

Add only sufficient water to the cement and aggregates during mixing to produce a concrete having
sufficient workability to enable it to be well consolidated, to be worked into the corners of the shuttering
and around the reinforcement and to have the specified strength. When a suitable amount of water has
been determined, maintain the resulting consistency throughout the Works and conduct tests from time
to time to ensure consistency. The method of determining the consistency of concrete shall either be
by slump test or by the compactor tests as defined in SS 78 and BS 1881. Supply all labour and
materials necessary to carry out the tests as directed. All concrete which has too high a water content
shall be rejected straightaway.

No concrete shall be re-mixed after it has once become partially set or hardened but shall be rejected
and removed from the Works.

2.40 DEPOSITING AND COMPACTING CONCRETE

Do not tip the concrete from a height of more than 2 m but lowered in chutes or skips. It shall be placed
in regular courses, in layers of not more than 250mm thick, punned down, beaten and neatly levelled
to a smooth surface. It shall not be covered up until passed. When the Works is interrupted, the surface
of the unfinished concrete shall be thoroughly cleaned, watered, coated with cement grout and covered
with a layer of cement mortar, at least 10mm thick, immediately before further concrete is added and
whenever practicable, wooden battens shall be inserted in the unfinished concrete and withdrawn to
form a continuous key for further concrete, both in horizontal and vertical joints.

At all junctions between new and existing concrete work, clean, roughen, coat and spread with at least
10mm thick of cement mortar to the surface of the existing concrete; immediately before the new
concrete is deposited. No concrete shall be placed unless the SO Rep has inspected the receiving
surfaces and is satisfied with the conditions for concreting.

Concrete shall be normally compacted by means of approved immersion vibrators of minimum 5000
cycles per minute or otherwise well rammed between and around the steel reinforcement by hand
rammers to ensure compactness and to avoid air-holes, or voids and to produce smooth surfaces, free
from honey combs. Remove any water accumulating on the surface of newly placed concrete by
approved means and place no further concrete thereon until such water is removed. Take great care
to prevent the displacement, bending or deformation of the steel before, during or after concreting.
Insert all reinforcement members in position before concreting and they shall be temporarily held, fixed,
tied or wired securely in position.

CE21/S2.DOC(29)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-30

2.41 PROTECTION AND CURING OF CONCRETE

Allow no load of any kind, however light, on concrete which has not properly matured. Do not allow
walking on or laying of planks on concrete until it has been properly matured and ready to carry load.

Allow a period of 24 hours between the laying of the concrete foundation and the laying of pipes or
kerbstones before backfilling.

After being placed in position, all fresh concrete shall be protected from rain, sun and drying wind, and
shall not be subjected to any vibrational disturbance other than that arising from compacting. The
exposed surfaces of concrete, other than concrete foundation and haunching for kerbstones and pipes,
shall be cured with an appropriate curing compound as approved by the SO Rep. The curing compound
shall be applied by mechanical sprayer and comply strictly with the manufacturers' instruction. If the
curing compound is exposed to rain or water within 4 hours from the time the application is completed,
the Contractor shall re-apply the area affected with appropriate curing compound again.

The curing compound shall not be used in concrete containing Portland Blast Furnace Cement or
Sulphate - Resisting Cement. In such instance, other appropriate curing method shall be adopted.

2.42 CONCRETING AGAINST SURFACE OF EXCAVATION

Place concrete only against surfaces of excavation when the receiving surfaces are clean, firm and free
from any accumulation of water. Should the receiving surfaces deteriorate as a result of the Contractor's
delay in placing concrete, the Contractor shall, as directed, cut the loose material and top-up with
compacted firm material or lean concrete.

Unless otherwise specified, concrete sealing to foundations shall be 75mm Grade 15 concrete.

Wherever in the opinion of the SO Rep that ground conditions permit, the timbering shall be removed
before concreting and the concrete placed in the walls for the full width from the shuttering to the face
of the excavation in one operation. The Contractor's attention is drawn to the desirability of keeping the
working space or overbreak to a minimum in all cases.

Where concreting in one width is called for by the SO Rep, payment for any extra concrete involved will
be priced at the Rates and the appropriate item for rough shuttering will be omitted.

2.43 CONCRETING THROUGH WATER

Concreting shall not be deposited under water without the prior consent of the SO Rep. Submit details
of the proposed method of placing concrete through water for the approval of the SO Rep. Design a
concrete mix for this purpose with a high workability of approximately 150mm slump and an increased
cement content of 25%.

2.44 FINISH OF CONCRETE

Upon removal of the shuttering and with approval of the SO Rep, make good honeycombed surfaces
immediately by a method approved by the SO Rep and superficial water and air holes shall be filled in.
Unless instructed to the contrary, rub down the face of exposed concrete placed against shuttering with
a carborundum stone immediately upon removal of the shuttering to remove fins or other irregularities.
Float the face of concrete for which shuttering is not provided (other than slabs) to give a finish equal
to that of the rubbed down face where shuttering is provided. No cement wash, mortar or paint may be
applied to any concrete surface without the permission of the SO Rep. Generally concrete finishes as
struck from the shuttering are required.

Lay all floors, slabs and inverts to the required depths, thickness, inclinations and curvatures shown on
the detail Drawings. The falls shall be even so that no pockets occur and the concrete well rammed,
consolidated and formed to a true and even slope by means of wooden screeds and straight edges,
and immediately thereafter be floated over with a wooden float, any hollows or rough places unavoidably
left after screeding being filled up with fine concrete. Subsequently and just before setting, finish off the
concrete to a smooth and even surface with metal floats, unless otherwise directed by the SO Rep.

Do not lay concrete floors and inverts in two courses, except where specified or by special permission
of the SO Rep in writing. Where screeds are required or approved, key and roughen the structural
concrete to ensure proper bond.

First class plane surfaces free from ripples, hollows, air holes or exposed aggregate is required.

CE21/S2.DOC(30)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-31

2.45 CONCRETE ADDITIVE

Suitable additives may be used in concrete only with the approval of the SO Rep. Apply the concrete
additives as approved in accordance to the manufacturer's recommendation and instructions.

When directed by the SO Rep, carry out verification on the suitability of concrete additives by trial mixes
and laboratory tests.

2.46 PREMIX AND READY-MIX CONCRETE

All concrete used in the site casting for the Works shall be obtained from pre-approved Ready-Mixed
Concrete suppliers under the Singapore Accreditation Council’s Certification Scheme for RMC. Ready-
mix concrete shall comply with SS EN 206.

2.47 TESTING OF CONCRETE CUBES

The methods of sampling and testing concrete shall comply with BS 78, BS 1881 and BS 5328. Provide
a minimum of 4 numbers of standard metal moulds. No concreting Works shall be allowed to commence
unless the required number of moulds is present at the Site. No extension of the Time for Completion
shall be allowed for stoppage of work due to the Contractor's failure to comply with this requirement.

On each concreting day, for every 40 cubic metres or part thereof of each grade of concrete, at least
one test shall be taken. At least 4 cubes shall be cast for each test. Two cubes shall be tested at 7
days and the remaining two cubes shall be tested at 28 days for compliance of the specified concrete
strength. Testing for Grade 15 Concrete is not required unless directed by SO Rep.

Compliance of the specified concrete strength shall be judged by tests made on cubes at an age of 7
days and 28 days respectively. Two test cubes shall be made for each test at the age required. The
cube strength shall be calculated from the maximum load sustained by the cube at failure.

The appropriate strength requirements at the age of 28 days shall be considered to be satisfied if:

(a) The average strength of the sample and the preceding three samples or the average of the first
four samples of the production is greater than or equal to the specified characteristic strength plus half
a fixed current margin of 6 N per mm². Thus, the minimum average strength shall be :

Grade 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55

Minimum Average
Strength at 28 days 18.0 23.0 28.0 33.0 38.0 43.0 48.0 53.0 58.0
(N per mm²)

(b) The sample strength is at least the level specified below:

Grade 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55
Minimum Individual
Sample 12.0 52.0
17.0 22.0 27.0 32.0 37.0 42.0 47.0
Strength at 28 days (N
per mm²)

CE21/S2.DOC(31)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-32

2.47 TESTING OF CONCRETE CUBES (CONT'D)

(c) The characteristics strength shall meet the requirement of the specified concrete grade.

If a current margin lower than the fixed current margin can be consistently achieved, approval may be
sought to lower the strength level as specified in subclause (a) above.

The test cubes shall be cured in accordance with SS 78, BS 1881 and BS 5328. Concrete shall be
placed in standard steel mould in layers approximately 50mm deep and each layer compacted by using
a steel bar 300mm long weighing 1.8 kg and having a ramming face of 25mm square. The number of
strokes per layer shall not be less than 35 for 100mm cubes or as per SS requirements. The cubes
shall be tested at the HDB’s Engineering Materials Laboratory or other approved accredited testing
laboratory with equivalent or better testing facilities, auto-capturing and computerized monitoring
system with analysis capabilities. The Contractor shall submit the information pertaining to the proposed
laboratory to SO Rep for approval. All contract information and test results shall be uploaded to EPTC
e-cube website.

The Contractor shall provide lockable humid boxes of adequate size to store all the test cubes for the
specified period. The humid boxes shall be placed in a covered area and maintained at a relative
humidity of above 95%. The keys to such curing facility shall be exclusively held in custody by a person
designated by the SO Rep. The Contractor shall provide lockable humid boxes of adequate size to store
all test cubes for the specified period. The humid boxes shall be placed in a covered area and
maintained at a relative humidity of above 95%. The keys to such curing facility shall be exclusively
held in custody by a person designated by the SO Rep. The test cubes to be tested at HDB’s
Engineering Materials Laboratory shall be collected by the SO Rep from the designated site at regular
interval. The SO Rep shall inform Contractor of the designated collection site and the Contractor shall
deliver cubes to the designated collection site on the day of collection.

The Contractor shall provide all necessary assistance to hand over the cubes to the HDB’s appointed
contractor for the collection of cubes.

The Contractor shall provide facilities to enable the identification of test cubes by radio frequency or
similar means. The Contractor shall provide at least one web-based radio frequency identification
(RFID) reader capable of reading the RFID tags on the concrete cube from a minimum distance of at
least 40 mm. The reader must be able to read all 125kHz RFID tags, including tags starting with hex
codes of '2800' and ‘2868’. The Contractor shall include the appropriate interfacing software to a web-
based controller.

The Contractor shall logon to a website of the Employer to register the concrete cube data and tag IDs
using the RFID reader. The registration of cube data and tag IDs shall be done within the same casting
day. The appropriate RFID tags shall be placed on the cubes while the concrete is still fresh. The top
surface of the RFID tag shall be level with the concrete cube surface. The Contractor shall protect the
RFID tags on the concrete cube while demoulding. For damage or loss of RFID tag, the Contractor shall
be charged the replacement cost based on the Employer's purchase price

The Employer shall deduct the charges payable by the Contractor from any monies due or becoming
due to the Contractor or recover the same from the Contractor as a debt due by the Contractor to the
Employer.

2.48 FAILURE OF TEST ON CONCRETE TEST CUBES

For each batch of concrete, make two test cubes for each test at 7 days and 28 days respectively. The
crushing strength to be achieved shall be as specified in Clause 2.39 "Concrete". Notwithstanding that
the test on the 7 days cubes pass the strength as specified in Clause 2.39 "Concrete", the test on the
28 days cubes shall still be required to be carried out.

The SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose charges
against the Contractor for each test that fails to attain the required crushing strength at 28 days as
specified in Clause 2.47 "Testing Of Concrete Cubes". The SO Rep may also require that part of the
Works represented by the cubes that has failed, be taken down or cut and replaced to comply with the
Specifications or that additional measures shall be provided to make the Works secure.

2.49 CONCRETE WALLS

Concrete walls generally shall be constructed in alternate bays not exceeding 7m in length. The height
of any lift of concrete shall not exceed 2.5m unless otherwise permitted by the SO Rep. Walls shall be
truly vertical and all surfaces which are exposed to view or to liquids finished to a smooth surface.

CE21/S2.DOC(32)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-33

2.50 SHUTTERING

All shuttering or formwork shall comply with Singapore Standard CP 23 and shall be, in every respect,
rigidly constructed of approved material and shall be true to the shape and dimensions as shown in the
Drawings. Timber used for formwork shall be medium hardwood, machined dressed to a uniform
thickness. The timber shall be well seasoned, free from loose knots and, unless otherwise approved,
wrought on all faces. Where plywood is to be used, it shall be Phenolic film faced plywood complying
with SS1 and cut to size from sheets at least 12mm thick.

The Contractor shall provide an appropriate formwork system that produces concrete surfaces with
good off-form finish requiring no plastering or skimming. However, if the off-form finish is unsatisfactory,
the SO Rep reserves the right to instruct the Contractor to carry out plastering and skimming work to
achieve the required finish as specified. The form face in contact with concrete shall be free from dirt,
adhering grout, projecting nails, splits and other Defect.

Formwork shall be coated with an approved form oil which is compatible with the required finish. Such
oil shall be insoluble in water, non-staining, not injurious to concrete and shall not become flaky or be
removed by rain or wash water. Diesel oil and liquids which retard the setting of concrete shall not be
used. The same approved type of form oil shall be used for all work. The application of the form oil
shall be such that no reinforcement is coated by the oil and there shall be no accumulation of the oil on
the formwork.

Close all joints tightly and prevent all leakage of liquid cement from the concrete.

2.50 SHUTTERING (CONT'D)

All formwork shall be inspected and approved by the SO Rep before any concreting operation is
commenced but this shall in no way affect, vary or relieve the Contractor of his responsibilities under
the Contract.

2.51 STRIKING OF SHUTTERING

Striking or removing shuttering shall not begin until the concrete is matured to sufficient strength to carry
its own weight plus any constructional or designed loads likely to come upon it, and this work shall be
conducted only under the personal supervision of a competent foreman. After striking of formwork, any
honeycombed surface and defective or damaged concrete work arising from improper work procedures
shall be immediately made good, as, directed by the SO Rep. Any remedial measures carried out
without the knowledge and approval of the SO Rep shall be liable for rejection and re-execution. All
holes formed by tie bolts shall be filled with cement mortar.

The minimum period before striking of the formwork for ordinary Portland Cement concrete shall be in
accordance with the following :

Minimum Period
Type of Formwork Remarks
Before Striking

All vertical or side formwork 12 hours


The period shall commence from the
time of last pour of concrete.
Soffit formwork to slabs and beams 3 days

Props to slabs and beams


14 days After striking of formwork, props
shall be immediately put up to
Props to cantilever slabs and cantilever
21days support the structure.
beams

2.52 RE-CONSTRUCTION OF FAULTY WORK

Remove and reconstruct any structural member of work which gives evidence before or after removal
of the shuttering that the concrete was of faulty quality at the time of deposition or was not properly
deposited and rammed in the shuttering or gives evidence that any member of the reinforcement was
omitted, incorrectly placed, or displaced by any agency or cause or which gives evidence of any Defect,
fault or injury from any cause whatsoever which might prejudicially alter the strength and durability of
the construction.

CE21/S2.DOC(33)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-34

2.53 STEEL REINFORCEMENT

Obtain steel reinforcement from local manufacturer or other manufacturers as may be approved in
writing by the SO Rep and comply with SS 2, SS 18, SS 32, BS 4449, BS 4461, BS 4482 and BS 4483
wherever applicable.

All reinforcement shall be free from scale and all loose rust. It shall not be coated with any grease, oil,
paint or adhering earth that may impair the bond between the concrete and reinforcement.

2.54 TESTING OF STEEL

Whenever required by the SO Rep, arrange for the manufacturer to supply direct to the SO Rep a test
certificate stating the process of manufacture and the results of each of the mechanical tests applicable
to the description of the material purchased, the chemical analysis and all as specified in the relevant
Standards. Alternatively, the SO Rep may require that the steel elements be tested according to
BS 4360. If the representative samples fail to achieve the minimum value specified, the batch
represented shall be rejected and the SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and
Irregularities" to impose charges against the Contractor for each such failure.

2.55 BENDING, PLACING AND FIXING REINFORCEMENT BARS

The number, size, form and position of each steel bar, tie, link, stirrup or other member of the
reinforcement shall be in exact accordance with the approved Drawings. Nothing shall be allowed to
interfere with the disposition of any member of the reinforcement and special precaution shall be taken
that it is not only correctly placed but made to keep its correct place during the placing and setting of
the concrete.

The ties of links connecting longitudinal bars in columns shall be taut so that the main bars shall be
properly braced in all directions.

Bend reinforcement bars by machine or other approved means producing a gradual and even motion.
Bend bars cold unless the SO Rep shall approve bars of over 25mm in size being bent hot. Bars bent
hot shall not be heated beyond cherry-red colour and after bending allowed to cool slowly without
quenching. Bars depending on cold-working for their strength shall always be bent cold.

Where it is necessary to reshape steel previously bent, this shall only be done with the approval of the
SO Rep and each bar shall be inspected for sign of fracture.

Bends shall comply with the dimensions given in the bending schedule. Dimensions of bent bars and
internal dimensions of binders and the like shall not exceed the dimensions given on the bar schedule
or elsewhere, and shall not be more than half per cent shorter than the specified dimensions.

The internal radii of bends shall not be less than twice the size of the bar unless described to the
contrary. The internal radii of the bends at corners or binders or the like shall be half the size of the bar
embraced by the binder. For the purpose of this requirement the size of a bar shall mean the diameter
of plain round bar or wire, or twice the diameter of one of the composing bars of a twin twisted bar, or
one-and-a-half times the nominal dimensions of the side of a twisted square bar.

Where steel fabric is required as reinforcement, carefully and accurately bend to the required shape
when cold, either with a bending machine or edge block. All bending shall be done before the fabric is
laid in position and no heating or welding shall be allowed. Carefully straighten steel fabric if they come
in rolls.

No piece of steel, wood or any foreign material whatsoever shall be employed on the bottom board, or
against the side board of the shuttering to keep the reinforcement bars in position.

The length of lap joints shall be not less than forty times the diameter of the steel member unless
otherwise permitted by the SO Rep. Hooks shall have a diameter of curvature of at least four times the
diameter of the member and shall be bent to a semi-circular form with a straight and measuring in length
at least four times the diameter of the member. Wherever shown on the Drawings all free ends of bars
shall be hooked as above and all joints in the length of bars shall be lapped and laps shall be at points
of minimum stress.

Maintain the vertical distances required between successive layers of bars in beams of similar members
by the provision of mild steel spacer bars inserted at such intervals that the main bars do not perceptibly
sag between adjacent spacer bars.

CE21/S2.DOC(34)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-35

2.55 BENDING, PLACING AND FIXING REINFORCEMENT BARS (CONT'D)

Immediately before concreting, examine the reinforcement for accuracy of placing and cleanliness and
corrected if necessary.

No concreting shall commence until the SO Rep has inspected the reinforcement in position and until
his approval has been obtained.

Reinforcement projecting from work being concreted or already concreted shall not be bent out of its
correct position for any reason unless approved and shall be protected from deformation or other
damage.

Provide and maintain the cover of concrete to the reinforcement as described in the Drawings and within
a tolerance of 3mm by means of distance pieces of plastic spacers or cement mortar.

2.56 FIXING FABRIC REINFORCEMENT

Securely and accurately tie fabric reinforcement which shall comply with SS 32 and fix in position in
accordance with the general requirements for fixing bar requirement.

All fabric shall be "lapped" and the minimum lap allowed in the case of rectangular mesh fabric shall
be :

450mm overlap of the longitudinal wires,


75mm overlap of the transverse wires.

With square mesh fabric the minimum lap allowed shall be :

300mm overlap of the longitudinal wires,


300mm overlap of the transverse wires.

In all types of fabric the lap provided shall be sufficient to develop the full strength of the material.

Allow for all cutting to waste.

2.57 CONSTRUCTION JOINT

Construction joints shall be of an approved shape and shall be vertical or horizontal, as required and
except that in an inclined member, the joint shall be at right angle to the axis of the member. Provide
in the positions shown on the Drawings or as directed. Key by the use of battens placed in the concrete
and subsequently remove.

Before placing new concrete against concrete that has already set, clean and roughen the face of old
concrete and remove loose aggregate therefrom. Immediately before placing the new concrete, wet
the face thoroughly and apply a coating of neat cement grout thereto. Ram the new concrete well
against the prepared face before the grout sets.

2.58 BRICKS

Bricks shall be at the best of their respective kinds, sound, hard, squarely made, well burnt throughout,
regular in size and shape, with good faces and clean arrises and free from lime, chalk, pebbles, shells
or other Defect.

They shall be of the standard size and conform to SS 103 and BS 3921. Obtain all common bricks from
the HDB Brick Factory unless otherwise permitted by the SO Rep. They shall not be removed away
from the Site without written permission by the SO Rep.

The crushing strength of bricks shall not be less than 27.5 KN per m2.

CE21/S2.DOC(35)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-36

2.59 BRICKWORK GENERALLY

Lay each brick after being immersed in water as far as practicable or wetted in full and close joints of
cement mortar in its bed, ends and sides in one operation, each course being subsequently flushed and
finished solid without damage to the external faces of the work.

In no case shall a brick be laid dry or with insufficiently filled joints and afterwards flushed in. At least
every fourth course shall be laid fair and smooth to line and joints shall not exceed 6mm in thickness
and shall be neatly finished on the face with flat or flushing joints.

Transport bricks carefully in carts or lorries and stack and remove all broken bricks from the Site without
delay. Press every brick firmly into position, the surplus mortar being lightly struck off flush with a trowel
or pointed.

Wet the top of any work left unfinished immediately before re-starting. Keep all faces of brickwork clean.

Fill bed and vertical joints of brickwork solid with mortar and no vertical joint allowed to be flushed up
from the top, but each joint filled up as the bricks are laid. All Works found not complying strictly with
this requirement shall be taken down and rebuilt.

2.59 BRICKWORK GENERALLY (CONT'D)

Maintain vertical joints in alternate courses in vertical lines. No work shall be carried up to a height
greater than 1 m above the level of adjacent work.

The style of brickwork in vertical walls shall be English Bond unless otherwise specified. The height of
four courses of bricks laid in mortar shall not exceed by more than 25mm the height of the same brick
laid dry.

Where the work is curved on plan, crop the bricks when necessary to ensure that they break joint
correctly.

2.60 CONCRETE PIPES

Concrete pipes, bends and channels for sewers, manholes and culverts shall be obtained from an
approved manufacturer and shall be made from Portland Cement and the pipes shall preferably be
spun reinforced concrete pipes. If permitted by the SO Rep, pipe may have collar joints when socketed
pipes are unobtainable. Socketed pipes shall have the sockets cast with the barrel of the pipe.

The sewer pipes shall comply with the requirements of the Water Reclamation (Network) Department,
PUB, and also comply with SS 183 wherever applicable.

Unless otherwise permitted, use only concrete pipes and fittings with spigot and socket rubber ring
joints or similar approved for sewers. They shall be of the required class and be tested and certified
satisfactory by PSB or Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB.

Unless otherwise specified, such as limestone aggregate or using PVC lining, all concrete pipes shall
be thickwall reinforced concrete pipe using Ordinary Portland Cement all in accordance with the
Standard Specifications and tests of Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB.

The Contractor's attention is drawn to the requirement that all Clauses laid down in the current Standard
specifications for Sewerage Works published by the Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB,
shall also be complied with.

CE21/S2.DOC(36)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-37

2.61 REINFORCED CONCRETE PIPES OF DIAMETER 300MM TO 825MM FOR SEWERAGE WORK

All sewers using reinforced concrete pipes and are of nominal internal diameter between 300mm and
825mm shall comply with the following requirements :

(a) thickwall reinforced concrete pipe using Ordinary Portland Cement and with an extra internal wall
thickness of 38mm over the normal cover to reinforcement, as provided for in the approved
standard of manufacture;

(b) the extra wall thickness of 38mm shall be added monolithically to the internal surface of the pipe
barrel; and

(c) comply with the specifications of Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB.

2.62 VITRIFIED CLAY PIPES

2.62.1 Vitrified Clay Pipes And Joints

(a) Vitrified clay pipes and fittings shall comply with either European Standard EN 295: 1991,
Australian Standard AS 1741: 1991 or other Equivalent Standard.

(b) All pipes shall be sampled and tested to the requirements of the relevant Standards. PSB Test
Report or Certificate of conformity. Type-tested pipes by other local/overseas test laboratories
accredited with PSB are also acceptable.

(c) All pipes and its joints must be watertight. Rubber sealing ring and other jointing materials used
in the joint assemblies shall comply with the requirements as specified in the relevant Standards.

(d) The chemical resistance, hydraulic roughness, abrasion resistance and shear resistance of all
pipes and fittings shall be tested and comply with the requirements as specified in the relevant
Standards.

(e) Dimension Requirements

Vitrified clay pipes shall have minimum bores as follows :

Nominal
200 225 250 300 400 500 600 700 800
Size (mm)
Minimum
Bore(mm) 195 219 244 293 390 487 585 682 780
*

* Note: Other nominal sizes greater than nominal size 200mm may be manufactured to comply
with this standard, providing that the minimum permissible bore is not more than 2.5%
less than the nominal size, rounded to the nearest mm.

(f) Marking Requirements

(i) All pipes manufactured and supplied shall have the following marks indented on the
exterior of the barrel :

 The manufacturer's name


 Date of manufacture
 Nominal bore size of pipe
 Standard Reference
 Crushing Strength in kN/m

(ii) All pipes and fittings shall be from only one manufacturer. The Contractor shall forward
the manufacturer's signed certificate stating that the pipes and fittings comply with the
relevant standard and the results of all tests to the SO Rep.

CE21/S2.DOC(37)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-38

2.62 VITRIFIED CLAY PIPES (CONT'D)

2.62.2 Vitrified Clay Pipes And Joints For Trenchless Construction

The following sets out the requirements for flexibly jointed vitrified clay pipes for construction by
trenchless installation technique including pipe jacking.

(a) Strength Requirements

(i) Vitrified clay pipes shall have minimum crushing strength as follows :

Nominal
200 225 250 300 400 500 600 700 800
Size (mm)

Strength
48 54 60 72 80 80 96 112 129
(kN/m)

(ii) The manufacturer shall declare the design jacking load.

(iii) All pipes or pipe sections shall be sampled after any grinding or cutting of ends and tested
to the requirements of the relevant Standards.

(iv) When tested in accordance with EN 293-3:1991, the deviation from squareness measured
at the pipe ends shall be not greater than 1mm.

(b) Jointing Sleeves

The joints of the vitrified clay pipes shall be of the double spigot type that are suitable for direct
jacking or microtunnelling. The jointing sleeves shall be made of Type 316 stainless steel.

(c) Rubber Rings

The rubber sealing rings and other jointing materials used in the joint assemblies shall comply
with the requirements as specified in the relevant Standards.

(d) Buffer Rings

The buffer ring shall be made of standard flooring grade chipboard sheets.

2.62.3 Vitrified Clay Pipes And Joints In Open-Cut Method Of Construction

The following sets out the requirements for flexibly jointed vitrified clay pipes for installation by open-cut
method of construction.

(a) Strength Requirements

(i) Vitrified clay pipes shall have minimum crushing strength as follows :

Nominal
200 225 250 300 400 500 600 700 800
Size (mm)

Strength
32 36 40 48 64 80 80 84 96
(kN/m)

(ii) All pipes or pipe sections shall be sampled after any grinding or cutting of ends and tested
to the requirements of the relevant Standards.

(iii) Pipes shall meet the tolerance for squareness at ends of pipes as specified in EN
295:1991. This is fixed at 6mm for pipes up to and including nominal diameter 300mm
and then at 2% of nominal diameter for larger sizes.

CE21/S2.DOC(38)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-39

2.62 VITRIFIED CLAY PIPES (CONT'D)

2.62.4 Flexible Joint To Vitrified Clay Pipe

(a) Flexible joints to stoneware pipes shall be of the rubber ring or polyester type of a design and
form approved by the SO Rep.

(b) The joints shall be of a type to remain completely watertight while accommodating a deflection
of 5E in any direction.

(c) Where polyester joints or polyester/rubber ring joints are supplied the formed polyester must be
securely bonded to the stoneware and pipes having damaged or loose polyester rings or socket
packings shall be rejected.

2.63 PITCH FIBRE PIPE

Pitch-Fibre pipes shall be of an approved type and manufacture conforming in all respects with BS
2760. The joints shall be of a design to permit flexibility and movement without leakage.

2.64 CAST IRON PIPE

(a) Unless otherwise specified cast-iron pipes and specials and cast (spun) iron pipes shall comply
with BS 4622 and shall be Class "B". Flanged pipe fittings and flanges shall also comply with
BS 4622 Class "B". The expression "cast-iron" also embraces spun iron where applicable.

(b) Joints to cast iron pipes unless otherwise indicated shall be "screwed gland", "bolted gland" or a
proprietary rubber ring joint "Tyton" or other approved.

2.65 STEEL PIPES

2.65.1 Sizes And Lengths Of Steel Pipe

(a) The diameters described are the finished internal diameter of the linings, and the steel pipes,
joints, flexible joints, etc, shall all be made to such dimensions as to suit the required finished
internal diameter. A tolerance of plus or minus 3 mm will be allowed in the finished lining
thickness. The tolerance for the finished internal diameter shall not exceed plus or minus 1% of
the nominal diameter of the pipe.

(b) The pipe lengths stated are effective lengths when laid and the Contractor shall allow in his
Contract Sum for the additional length of pipe required to form the joints.

2.65.2 Thickness Of Steel

(a) The thickness of steel plate to be used in manufacturing the pipes is stated in the Drawings.

(b) In the even of the plate thickness stated not being available, the Contractor shall allow in his
Contract Sum for supplying the nearest available thicker plate section.

2.65.3 Steel For Pipe And Special

The steel for the pipes and specials shall be manufactured by the open-hearth or electric process, acid
or basic and shall conform to and be tested in accordance with BS 534.

2.65.4 Testing Of Steel Pipes

(a) All pipes and specials shall be hydraulically tested after manufacture (ie. without the lining or
coating) as described in BS 534 in the presence of the SO Rep to a test pressure of 200 metres
load of water.

(b) Where specials and fittings are of a shape or size on which it is not practicable to apply the
hydraulic test the SO Rep may give approval to an alternative method of test such as the paraffin
test.

(c) The Contractor shall bear the cost and expense for all the tests specified.

CE21/S2.DOC(39)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-40

2.65 STEEL PIPES (CONT'D)

2.65.5 Lining Of Steel Pipes

(a) All the pipes and specials shall after the removal from the inner surfaces of all rust, loose seals,
oil, grease or other foreign matter and thorough cleansing, be lined with concrete or other
materials as specified and shall be in accordance with the current BS 534. It shall be terminated
as near to the ends of the pipes and specials as will allow for effective jointing without damage
to the lining.

(b) Great care must be taken to avoid overstressing the lining at any stage of manufacture, handling
or during delivery and storage and linings showing hollow, drumming sections or with cracks,
other than surface cracks which can be shown not to penetrate more than 6mm below the surface
will not be accepted. All pipes above 900mm diameter shall be clearly marked "Top" and
"Bottom" as soon as the pipe is lined.

2.65.6 External Coating Of Steel Pipes

The external coating shall be as described hereunder:-

(i) All pipes and specials shall be cleaned over the whole of their external surface by sand or grit
blasting, acid pickling or mechanical wire brushing in order to remove all millscales, rust, paint,
grease and loose dirt.

(ii) Within two hours of cleaning, the dry clean surface shall receive one cold application of approved
bitumen primer by brush or spray application over the whole external surface.

(iii) When the primer is dry and within 5 days of its application, the pipes shall be coated to within
75mm of each and with a continuous coating of not less than 2.4mm thickness of hot applied
coal-tar enamel by pouring onto the primed pipes as they are mechanically rotated. The
temperature of the enamel as it flows onto the pipes shall be between 225°C and 250°C but the
temperature of the enamel in the melter is not to exceed 260°C. Any melt which has been
overheated shall be immediately removed from the rolling rig and discarded.

(iv) Simultaneously with the pouring of the hot enamel 150mm wide coal-tar saturated felt reinforced
with glass fibres at 6mm spacing outer wrap shall be spirally wrapped with 6-12mm overlap on
to the exterior of the exterior of the hot coating, on the rotating pipes, so as to firmly adhere to it.

(v) The primer and enamel shall meet American Water Works Association Specification C:203:1962
which is for plasticised coal-tar base materials.

2.65.7 Joints To Steel Pipes

(a) Expansion and welded joints are to be made in accordance with the Drawings although changes
may be proposed by the Contractor and such changes must be approved in writing by the SO
Rep before manufacture commences.

(b) The flexible joints are to be of an approved form similar to Viking Johnson Couplings. Details of
the type of joints are subject to the approval of the SO Rep.

2.65.8 Protection During Transit And Storage Of Steel Pipe

(a) The coated pipes shall be lime washed and provided with sufficient protection such as straw
roping to prevent any damage during transit or storage. The ends of all pipes and specials shall
be covered with caps or discs of an approved pattern to prevent damage to the pipe ends, joints
and lining.

(b) The unprotected surfaces of all pipes and specials after lining (eg pipe ends, joints, etc.) shall be
protected from corrosion during storage by the application of Shell "Ensis" or other approved
temporary coating.

CE21/S2.DOC(40)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-41

2.66 GASKETS FOR FLANGED PIPE

(a) Gaskets for flanged pipes shall comply with the requirements of BS 2494 and BS 3063.

(b) They shall be "full face" Class "D" 3mm thick.

2.67 BOLTS, NUTS AND WASGERS FOR FLANGED PIPE JOINT

(a) Bolts, nuts and washers for flanged pipe joints shall be in accordance with BS 4190 and BS
4320.

(b) Where flange bolts are to be installed and buried under ground the bolts, nuts and washers shall
be non-ferrous or metal coated to prevent any corrosion.

2.68 UPVC PIPES

Unplasticized polyvinyl chloride (UPVC) pipes and fittings shall be of an approved type and manufacture
complying with the requirements of the Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB. They shall
conform to SS 272, BS 4660, BS 5481 and the relevant Australian Standards where applicable.

2.69 ORDER OF SEWER PIPES, FITTINGS AND MANHOLE PARTS

For the construction of sewers, place order for the supply of all the required pipes and manhole parts
within 7 days from the date of the Letter of Acceptance and shall notify the SO Rep of this in writing.
The order shall stipulate the specified times of delivery to the Site after all the necessary tests required
by PSB or Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB.

If no such order is made, the SO Rep may place on behalf of the Contractor the necessary order to a
supplier decided and approved by the SO Rep. Bear all costs and expenses involved in such an order
and these shall be paid to the supplier by deducting from monies due or becoming due to the Contractor.

2.70 PIPE LAYING

Carefully brush all pipes inside and visually test for soundness before being laid. Lay the pipes to true
inverts, straight lines and falls, each pipe being separately bonded between sight rails and bearing
evenly upon the solid ground or concrete for its full length.

Where pipes are to be laid in rock cutting, take the excavation down to 100mm below bed level and
take great care to ensure that there are no projecting pieces of rock on which the pipe will ride. Make
up the bed to its true line and level by refilling with either 100mm of consolidated, selected material from
the excavation, well rammed and watered if necessary or with 100mm of compacted sand or with
100mm of Grade 15 concrete as directed.

Where pipes are to be supported on a bed of concrete or surrounded with concrete, provide rectangular
blocks composed of concrete made in approved moulds at least 14 days before use and approved
hardwood folding wedges. Provide two blocks for each pipe set and bond into the correct level on the
formation bottom and lay the pipe on them properly centred and socketed. Two hardwood folding
wedges of a width equal to the width of the concrete block shall then be inserted between the body of
the pipe and the block and shall be driven together until the pipe is brought to the exact level required.
Blocks and wedges shall then be left undisturbed while the pipes are being jointed and the concrete
surround is being placed in position.

Ensure that all blocks and wedges are of sufficient size and strength to prevent settlement of the pipes
and make good any settlement.

CE21/S2.DOC(41)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-42

2.71 JOINTING CAST IRON PIPE

In general for all types of joint, thoroughly clean the pipe joint and jointing ring or material of dirt and
grease before any jointing commences. The pipes shall be properly supported, bedded and lined up
before the joint is set up and made.

Make bolted gland, screwed gland and similar types of flexible patent joint in accordance with the
manufacture's instructions. Clean the joint rings, lubricate with the manufacturer recommended
material and accurately position it. Firmly push or jack home the joint and where screwed or bolted
glands are involved steadily and evenly tighten the glands all round.

No lead caulked joints shall be permitted.

Carefully clean the flanged joints, centre and line up with only 3mm allowed for the gasket between the
faces of the flange. The flanged gasket shall be carefully positioned and held by the flanged bolts.

2.72 JOINTING STEEL PIPES

(a) Welded pipe joints shall be made by means of the metal welding process in compliance with the
general requirements for this process laid down in BS 1856.

(b) The jointing of pipes and specials shall be done with the pipes and specials laid in their final
positions. Their positions shall be so adjusted in preparation for welding that the clearance
between pipe barrel and jointing sleeve does not exceed 3mm.

(c) If tack welds are used they shall be limited in number and positioned evenly throughout the
circumference of the joint. The length of each tack weld shall not be less than 40mm.

(d) The section size of the tack welds shall be similar to that of the root run to be deposited in the
joint. The extremities of tack welds shall be chipped or ground to facilitate the proper fusion with
subsequent disposition if they are to be incorporated in the initial root run. A whipping technique
shall be employed at the end of the run on each tack weld and all other electrode changes to
prevent craters.

(e) The main welds shall be fillet welds and the leg of each weld shall not be less than the thickness
of the steel plate being welded.

(f) Steel pipes above 825mm diameter shall be welded both internally and externally.

(g) Welding shall not be performed where, in the opinion of the SO Rep, the weld would be subject
to excessive cooling rates and welded joints shall not be disturbed until thoroughly cooled.

(h) Welds shall be free from undercut, porosity, cracking, zones of incomplete fusion, inadequate
root penetration, or any other defect listed in BS 499, Section 6 and the Appendix. Porosity, slag
inclusion of any other foreign body shall not exceed 1.6mm in any dimension nor shall there be
more than six such inclusions of this maximum size per square inch of weld metal, nor shall the
combined areas or any numbers of defects exceed 0.02mm2 of weld metal.

(i) Cut lengths shall be jointed by the use of welded butt straps or flexible joints. Wherever
necessary the external and internal lining shall be made good as specified after completion and
acceptance of the joint. When butt straps are used they shall be welded both internally and
externally.

(j) Short tubes may be provided on the side of the pipes to form an access for welding leads during
pipe laying. These access tubes shall be sealed off by welding sockets into the tubes.

2.73 JOINTING CONCRETE PIPES

Push well home each concrete pipe with the rubber ring accurately positioned on the spigot into the
socket of the previously laid pipe by means of uniformly applied pressure with the aid of a jack or similar
appliance. Use roll on rubber rings and they shall be lubricated before making the joint using soft soap,
water or other approved lubricant supplied by the manufacturer. The manufacturer's instruction shall
be deemed to form part of this Specifications.

CE21/S2.DOC(42)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-43

2.73 JOINTING CONCRETE PIPES (CONT'D)

Lay the PVC lined concrete pipes and join as specified above except that all necessary precautions
shall be taken to protect and safeguard the PVC lining from any damage during pipe laying. After the
pipes have been laid, jointed and approved by the SO Rep, "Thermo Weld" the cover flaps of the PVC
lining across the pipe joints, according to the manufacturer's instruction and this shall be carried out in
conjunction with the pipe laying progress.

Where the lined pipes enter the manholes and other structures, seal the PVC lining by the welding of
approved preformed cover fillets or angles forming returns to the arrises built into the in-situ concrete
work.

The manufacturer's instructions for jointing and thermo-welding the joints shall be deemed to form part
of this Specifications. The manufacturer shall submit to the SO Rep for approval, the methods for field
testing the PVC lining and thermo-welded joints for flaws, burnt surfaces, pin holes etc. Employ
approved methods for the complete testing of the lining, jointing and welding throughout the line.

2.74 FRACTURE OF PIPES

In the event of pipes being fractured after being, to all appearances, properly laid, whether due to
imperfect beds having been formed or the material for refilling having been improperly selected or due
to any other cause, the Contractor shall be responsible and shall be called upon to replace such
defective pipes, if such Defect appears before the expiry of the Defects Liability Period.

Immediately remove and replace any pipe or length of pipes found to be defective and remake all
leaking joints.

2.75 PRECAST CONCRETE DRAIN CHANNELS, KERBS, DIVIDERS, ETC

Precast concrete drain channels, kerbs, road channels (gutters) and dividers shall be constructed in
accordance with the Drawings and shall comply with the requirements as regards to strength of
concrete, water absorption, rate of wear, finish and size, where applicable with BS EN 1339 and/or SS
214. Obtain precast concrete units from ISO 9000 or PSB Singapore Quality Mark/Product Listing
Scheme/ Certification Scheme Suppliers only. Lay precast concrete drain channels, kerbs, road
channels (gutters) and dividers, true to line and level in accordance with the Drawings.

0.5% of the total number of precast units to be used for the Works subject to a minimum of three
numbers of precast units shall be selected at random by the SO Rep for water absorption tests by a
competent Authority whilst the Works is in progress. The SO Rep shall exercise his rights under clause
1.6  Nuisance and Irregularities to impose charges against the Contractor for every test that exceeds
the average absorption rate as stated below. For each water absorption test, three test pieces shall be
used for determining the average increase in weight by water absorption.

When tested for water absorption, the average increase in weight by absorption of water in the first 30
minutes shall not exceed 6% of the dry weight of the three test pieces for all precast concrete channels,
kerbs, etc.

These tests shall be in addition to those to be carried out by either LTA or the SO Rep prior to taking
over of the completed Works before the expiry of the Defects Liability Period. Comply with the final
decision made by LTA or the SO Rep in respect of any test carried out by them.

2.76 PRECAST CONCRETE SLABS

Precast concrete slabs for footpaths, etc shall comply with the requirements of BS EN 1339, whenever
applicable. Submit the details of the supply of this item to the SO Rep for approval.

CE21/S2.DOC(43)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-44

2.77 TRAFFIC SIGNS, CONES, BARRIERS AND LAMPS

The following shall comply with the requirements of LTA, subject to the approval of the SO Rep :

(a) Traffic Sign

All warning, regulatory and information signs shall be made of aluminium sheeting. The sheeting
shall be 2.03 mm thick of SWG No. 14 and the materials for the sheeting shall comply with the
relevant specification of BS 873 and BS 1470.

The reflective sheeting adhered to the aluminium plate shall be diamond grade. It shall consist
of spherial lens elements embedded in transparent plastic having a smooth, flat outer surface.
The material of the reflective sheeting shall comply with the relevant specification and be tested
according to ATM D4956. The thickness of the reflective sheeting inclusive of adhesive shall be
in the range of 5.5 mils to 6.5 mils.

All warning, regulatory and information signs shall be supported/fixed on to galvanised square
hollow section, tripod stand or plate support as shown in the Drawings.

All mild steel pipe frames shall consist of 25 mm internal diameter medium grade mild steel pipe
vertically and horizontally.

All tripod stands shall consist of 19 mm internal diameter medium grade galvanised iron pipes
all round.

The information plate supports shall consist of 50 mm internal diameter medium grade
galvanised iron pipes all round.

The weight of the warning and regulatory signs together with the support shall not be less than
15 kg.

(b) Cones

The traffic cones shall conform to all the relevant clauses and parts of the latest BS 873.

All cones shall be conical in shape and hollow. The opening at the top shall be manufactured to
accommodate the blinker's adaptor. The sleeve of the cone shall be made of replaceable retro
reflective sheet of BS 873 : Part 6 Class/material or better with the HDB logo printed on three
sides or two sides if space does not allow.

The cones shall be made of medium density polyethylene with additional stabiliser or pigmented
poly-vinyl chloride. Each cone shall have a minimum weight of 4.40 kg and the minimum
thickness shall be 3 mm. The cones shall be sufficiently stable that they remain upright and not
creep or topple under normal traffic condition. Ballast shall not be used. The cones shall not
overturn when it is tilted up to an angle of 49 degrees away from its vertical axis.

The cones shall also have excellent impact performance and shall be sufficiently flexible for the
cone to recover its shape after distoration at normal temperature or after being knocked over by
any vehicle. The cones shall be stackable.

(c) Barriers

(i) Plastic Barriers

The plastic barrier board shall be rectangular in shape. The board shall be stiffened by
fixing flat metal bars to the top and bottom edges of the board. The barrier shall be
moulded with flexible toggle fixing to fit the barrier stands.

The board shall be made of high density polyethylene. The minimum wall thickness of
the board shall be 3.5 mm and the minimum weight per metre run of the board shall be
1.8 kg per metre run.

CE21/S2.DOC(44)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-45

2.77 TRAFFIC SIGNS, CONES, BARRIERS AND LAMPS (CONT'D)

(c) Barriers (Cont'd)

(i) Plastic Barriers (Cont'd)

The stand shall not overturn when it is tilted up to an angle of 46 degrees from its vertical
axis. The stand shall have drainage holes at its base to prevent water collecting there.
Provision shall be made to accommodate the toggles of barrier and blinker. There shall
be a locking device to prevent the easy removal of the barrier board from the stand.

The materials for the stand shall be medium density polyethylene with additional stabiliser.
The minimum wall thickness of the stand shall be 3mm and the minimum weight of the
stand shall be 18.8 kg. The materials for the stand shall have a minimum tensile strength
of 15 N per m2.

(ii) Barrier Fencing

Barrier fencing is a continuous plastic mesh which may serve as an alternative for close
barricading. The plastic mesh shall only be used by fixing securely to stable supports and
the gaps between these support should be not more than 6.0 m. Barrier fencing is used
to exclude pedestrians from a worksite and for the containment of workers. If it is erected
parallel and adjacent to traffic, a separate delineation with a line of traffic cone shall be
provided between the plastic mesh and the traffic. The colour of the mesh shall be high
visibility orange or red. The material shall be re-usable, high durability, non-fading and
UV resistance plastic.

(iii) Longitudinal Safety Barrier

The type of barriers may be required for the protection of traffic, the works as well as the
workers in long term stationary works. They may also be used to separate opposing
traffic. Suitable treatment of the ends of such barriers shall be taken to minimise risks
associated with end-on collisions.

The longitudinal safety barriers are a continuous close barricading formed by


interconnection of individual portable units that are made of concrete, steel or
polyethylene reinforced with steel. The performance of the safety barrier system shall be
fully tested to meet the recommended structural adequacy, occupant risk and vehicle
trajectory criteria set forth in the National Cooperative Highway Research Programme
(NCHRP) Report 350 for Test Level 2. Test reports shall be provided by the manufacturer
for verification by SO Rep. Only safety barrier system satisfying the required performance
criteria shall be used for the protection purpose.

(d) Lamps

(i) Flashing Lamps

All low and high intensity flashing lamps shall comply with BS 3143:1985 and the
Australian Standard AS 1165-1982 on traffic hazard warning lamps.

The flashing lamp shall have a luminous intensity integrated over flash duration of not less
than 2 cd.sec (minimum photometric performance) for low intensity type and not less than
50 cd.sec for higher intensity type as in AS 1165 (cd stands for candela).

The rate of flashing shall not be less than 60 pulsations per minute.

The requirements of the light output of flashing lamps shall apply within an elliptical cone
bounded by :

(a) Directions 5 degrees above and below an axis normal to the surface of the
geometric centre of the light emitting face in the vertical plane containing the axis.

(b) Directions 7.5 degrees on either side of the axis normal to the surface of the
geometric centre of the light emitting face in the horizontal plane containing the
axis.

The flashing lamp shall be provided with photoelectric control so that the flashing lamps
shall operate when the horizontal illuminance is less than 100 lux and shall cut off when
the horizontal illuminance is exceeding 1800 lux.

CE21/S2.DOC(45)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-46

2.77 TRAFFIC SIGNS, CONES, BARRIERS AND LAMPS (CONT'D)

(d) Lamps (Cont'd)

(i) Flashing Lamps (Cont'd)

The flashing lamp shall be resistant to corrosion or be suitably treated to prevent corrosion
and shall be weatherproofed.

The flashing lamp shall be provided for swivelling the lens 360 degrees and shall be
designed so that the rotation will not damage any wiring or components.

The flashing lamp shall be designed so as to facilitate easy replacement of the batteries
and lamp.

The flashing lamp shall be clearly and indelibly marked as tested to BS or AS Standards.

The battery shall be designed to operate the lamp for at least 200 hours and of which the
output during this period shall not drop below 50% of its initial lamp output.

The flashing lamp shall also pass the impact test as detailed in BS 3143 Appendix A.

Also submit test reports by independent testing authority on the flashing tested to BS 3143
or AS 1165 and the Specifications, as and when required.

Use low intensity flashing lamps for all barricading and cone tapering area.

In residential areas use low intensity flashing lamps at warning signs and regulatory signs
instead of high intensity flashing lamps. They may be switched on to static mode if the
flashing light is posing a problem to residents.

Use high intensity flashing lamps for all warning signs and first regulatory signs only. They
shall be used along all other roads but not for private residential minor roads.

Ensure that :

(a) the flashing lamps are mounted between 1.0m and 1.2m above the road surface.

(b) the flashing lamps of directional type are aimed at centre of on-coming traffic at
about 100 to 200m away.

(c) The orientation of the lamp are checked to ensure correct aiming and alignment is
maintained.

Check all flashing lamps daily to ensure that they are functioning properly. Replace any
blown lamps or weak batteries and also ensure that the flashing lamps are cleaned daily
and after rain so that dust and dirt do not accumulate on the surface of the lens.

(ii) Rotating Lamps

All portable amber rotating lamps shall comply to BS 3143:Part 4 and the Australian
Standard AS 1165 on traffic hazards warning lamps.

The rate of flashing shall be between 120 and 150 flashes per minute. The power
requirement for the rotating lamp shall be of 12V and have a minimum wattage of 50 watts.
The bulb shall be of halogen type. The material for the lens shall be of polycarbonate
material.

Use portable amber rotating lamps for all cases in lane diversion, road diversion, bends,
crests and all other roads except for private residential minor roads. Unless otherwise
indicated, they shall generally be placed at the first warning sign and the last regulatory
sign. The rotating lamp shall be operational at all times (24 hours). To replace with static
mode high intensity warning lamps if the rotating mode is posing a problem to residents.

CE21/S2.DOC(46)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-47

2.77 TRAFFIC SIGNS, CONES, BARRIERS AND LAMPS (CONT'D)

(d) Lamps (Cont'd)

(ii) Rotating Lamps (Cont'd)

For longer duration work, the AC current type of portable amber rotating lamps may be
used. However, the lamps shall meet all the requirements of the DC current type. On the
safety aspect, the requirement of PowerGrid shall be met and approval from PowerGrid
shall be obtained before they are allowed to be used on the Site.

2.78 HOT DIPPED GALVANISED GRATINGS

All galvanised gratings shall be zinc coated by the hot-dip galvanising process in accordance with
SS 117 or BS 729 Part 1. Batches of galvanised gratings delivered to the Site shall be accompanied
by a certification letter or copy of invoice from the firm at which they are galvanised. The word 'gratings'
used in this Clause shall also be deemed to include the frames and their miscellaneous components.
Submit the details of the galvanising to the SO Rep for approval.

All gratings shall be thoroughly removed of all welding slags prior to galvanising. Galvanised gratings
found having welding slags remaining on them shall be rejected and all such items shall be immediately
removed from the Site.

The galvanised gratings shall be tested for their zinc mass coating. The testing shall be performed at
an SAC accredited laboratory using magnetic or electronic thickness measuring devices.

2% of the total number of gratings delivered to the Site subject to a minimum of three numbers of
gratings shall be selected for testing.

The mass of zinc coating tested shall be carried out at regular points of not less than 32 no. total on the
surface of all the steel angles and flats of the grating.

The results of the tests at every point for one grating shall be averaged to determine the average zinc
coating weight of the grating.

The mass of zinc coating on each grating shall comply with the following average coating mass :

Average Coating Minimum Permissible


Thickness of Steel Mass g per m2 Value g per m2
5mm thick and over 610 580
Under 5mm, but not less than 2mm 410 390
Under 2mm 350 330

Gratings which fail to achieve the requirements specified above shall be dealt with as follows :

(a) The SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose
charges against the Contractor for any grating the zinc coating mass of which is less than the
average coating mass but greater than the minimum permissible value.

(b) The batch of galvanised gratings having any one of the representative samples failing to achieve
the minimum permissible value shall be rejected and the SO Rep shall exercise his rights under
Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose charges against the Contractor for each such
failure. Batches of rejected gratings may be sent for re-galvanising and may be accepted if tests
show that they comply with the requirements of the zinc mass coating.

CE21/S2.DOC(47)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-48

2.79 GEOTEXTILE

(a) General

Where indicated in the Drawings or as directed, the type of geotextile specified shall be laid
strictly in the manner required and also in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions.

Generally woven or non-woven type geotextile may be used for road construction and other civil
engineering construction. Use non-woven type geotextile for sub-soil drainage unless otherwise
specified. The geotextile shall be composed of one or a combination of the following polymers.

(i) polypropylene
(ii) polyethylene
(iii) polyamide

Other polymers may be used subject to approval by the SO Rep.

(b) Protection

The geotextile shall be properly sealed when delivered to the Site. Ensure that it is well protected
against direct sunlight and contamination by chemical solutions while in storage. Only minimum
exposure to weathering in the course of laying is permitted. Geotextile with stain markings shall
be rejected.

(c) Testings

Random samples of the geotextile shall be selected for testing for its mechanical and hydraulic
properties to be carried out by an SAC accredited laboratory when required. The batch of
geotextile fabric from which failed samples are taken shall be rejected and taken out of the Site
immediately. In addition to the rejection, the SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6
"Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose charges against the Contractor.

(d) Method of Testings

Geotextiles shall be tested for its properties in accordance with ASTM unless otherwise specified.

The following tests shall be carried out when required by the SO Rep :

(i) Load vs strain characteristic Curve (ASTM D1682)


(ii) Grab Tensile Test (ASTM D1682)
(iii) Trapezoidal Tear Test (ASTM D2263-68)
(iv) Mullen Burst Test (ASTM D751-73)
(v) Water Permeability Test
(vi) Pore-Size Distribution Curve

The Contractor shall be required to bear the cost and expense for sampling and testing when required
by the SO Rep.

2.80 MANHOLE COVER AND FRAME

The manhole covers and frames shall be of cast iron machined type and of approved size, weight and
pattern. The heavy duty type shall be used in roadways and paved areas.

Manhole covers and frames shall comply with SS 30 and BS 497 and be of the standard type and size
specified by the Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB, Drainage, or LTA and shall be in
accordance with the Drawings. The cover and frame shall be cast from a mixture of cast iron scrap and
a suitable grade of pig iron. The mixture of the resultant metal shall be such as to provide a strong grey
structure free from chill. The cover and frame shall be free from air, sand holes and cold shuts. They
shall be neatly dressed and carefully fettled. All casting shall be free from voids, whether due to
shrinkage, gas inclusion or other causes.

Supply manhole covers and frames coated with a black bituminous composition. They shall be well
fitting, flush at the top and shall not rock.

Where required, the cover and frame shall be tested in accordance with SS 30.

CE21/S2.DOC(48)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-49

2.81 STEP-IRONS

Step-irons shall be of malleable cast iron and complying with BS 1247 and shall be used only under the
direction of the SO Rep.

2.82 HAND-RAILING

All mild steel pipes used for handrailing shall be bare steel light tubes of 40mm nominal bore conforming
to BS 1387 and SS 17:1970. All mild steel tubes and flats shall conform to BS 15 or SS 104.

Provide on the Site a building or shed which shall be dry and close to entry of water. The floors and
walls shall be dry and the building or shed shall be well lit and ventilated.

Before painting, bring the handrailing into the building or shed and clean with a wire brush to remove
all rust and mill scale. Paint the handrailing with one coat of approved priming paint or as specified.
Allow the paint to dry completely before it is removed from the shed or building for erection.

After erection, paint the handrailing with two undercoat of approved oil base paint and one finishing coat
of approved oil base paint or as specified.

Provide all the necessary items to carry out painting of one additional finishing coat of approved oil base
paint before the expiry of the Defects Liability Period. Attend to all Defect such as rust, chipped or
dented surfaces prior to the repainting.

2.83 SAFETY CHAINS

Safety chains shall be made of aluminium alloy HE 30 FT.

2.84 LADDERS

Ladders shall be made of aluminium alloy HE 30 FT and of approved design complying with BS 1474
and BS 2037 unless otherwise specified. The ladder rungs shall be at 300mm centres and stringers
380/450mm apart. Strong support stays shall be provided on both sides of the ladder at not more than
2.5m centres.

2.85 BAKAU PILES

Bakau piles shall be of an approved species, good, sound, straight with fresh uninjured bark and of
reasonably uniform size throughout. They shall be supplied in minimum 4.0m length, measured after
the heads have been squared and the undersized ends cut off. They shall not be less than 80mm in
diameter at the larger end and not less than 55mm in diameter at the smaller end, including the
thickness of bark. Such measurements shall not be done over knobs and protuberances. The
permissible deviation of the axis of the pile from the straight joining the centres of the two ends shall
not be more than 25mm. All bakau piles shall be inspected and approved by the SO Rep before being
used. Bakau piles that have been rejected shall be removed from the Site immediately.

When the piles need to be joined, such joints shall be made of mild steel collars of 300mm long. The
steel collar joint shall be divided into 2 equal sections, each with different diameters. The internal
diameter of the mild steel collar for the top 150 mm section shall be 70mm and for the lower 150 mm
section shall be 90 mm, with a diaphragm plate welded at the connection. The minimum thickness of
the mild steel collar and the diaphragm shall be 1.8mm with joints fully welded and coated with tar or
bituminous paint approved by the SO Rep. Prior to the commencement of the bakau piling work, the
Contractor shall submit to the SO Rep a design sketch duly endorsed by the Contractor's PE to show
the full details of the mild steel collar joint including the type and size of the welding. A sample of the
collar joint made to the Professional Engineer's design shall also be submitted for the approval of the
SO Rep before it is used on the Site for the bakau piling work. Bakau piles shall be joined with such
mild steel collar firmly wedged with the axis of the top pile properly aligned to coincide with the driven
pile. Unless specified otherwise, the Contractor shall provide all the bakau piles driven to the numbers
and lengths according to the Specifications and Drawings. The Contract Sum shall be adjusted for the
net quantities actually provided in the Works.

CE21/S2.DOC(49)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-50

2.86 BAKAU PILING

Where indicated on the Drawings, bakau piles as specified and of approved lengths shall be driven
plumb and in approved positions to the full length of the piles or to refusal or otherwise directed by the
SO Rep.

Piling shall be carried out by experienced operators and shall be in accordance with the instructions of
the SO Rep. The piles shall be driven with a piling frame with a drop hammer of approved weight of not
less than 200 kg to a final set of 200mm for the last 10 blows from a drop of 1.0m to 1.5m height.
Wherever required by the SO Rep, drive piles at required set with number of blows and the weight of
hammer determined and the bearing capacity of the piles assessed.

The SO Rep may call for test piles to be driven in different sections of the excavations to determine the
stability of the ground below the formation level and hence the approved requirements of piles. Extract
and replace or else duplicate all incorrectly or badly driven piles and piles damaged during driving.

On completion of bakau piling saw off all pile heads to the required level and trim the excavation around
the pile heads.

When directed by the SO Rep, the Contractor shall carry out simple load tests to determine the bearing
capacity of the driven pile, as directed all at the Contractor's own cost and expense.

2.87 SOIL MIXTURE FOR WATER CATCHMENT AND NON-WATER CATCHMENT AREA

Soil mixture shall consists of 3 parts of top soil to one part of sludge for non-water catchment areas.

All topsoil shall be of good quality, free from rubbish, roots, stumps, subsoil or other extraneous matter,
be friable and porous in texture.

Sludge shall only be used in non water catchment areas. Sludge shall be dry, solid and well treated
type from approved sources. The use of sludge for turfing and other work shall comply with Water
Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB's instructions and recommendations on the prevention of
smell and flies problems :

(a) Immediately use sludge delivered to Site meant for the turfing works.

(b) Evenly cover sludge stockpiled on the Site with a layer of lime and cover over with a layer of
topsoil.

(c) After planting of turf no additional spreading of sludge or soil on the turfed area shall be allowed.

For water catchment areas, soil conditioner shall be used instead of sludge. Soil conditioner shall be
peat, cocopeat, organic compost; or other approved fibrous organic matters suitable for mixing with soil
to make a friable growing medium for planting.

The soil mixture shall be three parts of topsoil with one part of sludge for non water catchment areas or
3 parts of topsoil with 1 part of soil conditioner and 1 kg per m3 of compound fertilizer NPKMg (15:15:6:4)
for water catchment areas. Provide and spread the required amount of top soil for such turfing and tree
planting works.

CE21/S2.DOC(50)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-51

2.88 PLANT SOIL

In the event that the Contractor is unable to obtain the necessary top soil of the quality acceptable to
the SO Rep from any source, subject to the approval of the SO Rep, plant soil may be provided as a
substitute for top soil. Provide, mix and use the plant soil for the Works.

Manufacture the plant soil by mixing 4 parts of sub-soil, 2 parts of unwashed sand and 1 part of treated
sludge for non water catchment areas to achieve a thorough and homogenous mix relatively free of
lumpy material. In water catchment areas, the one part of sludge shall be substituted by one part of soil
conditioner and 1 kg per m3 of compound fertilizer NPK Mg (15:15:6:4). The mixing may be carried out
by spreading the various components on the ground in layers and ploughing and mixing them using
appropriate machinery or by using a mixer or by any other process. The resulting plant soil shall be
relatively free of lumpy material and shall have the following range of composition by weight :

Sand 40% to 70%


Clay 10% to 25%
Organic Matter 2% to 5%

(a) Sub-Soil

The clay content of the sub-soil which is the soil strata found just below the top soil layer, shall
not be greater than 45%. Only approved sub-soil shall be utilised for the production of the plant
soil.

(b) Unwashed Sand

Provide the unwashed sand required for the manufacture of plant soil. The unwashed sand to
be used shall be free of any debris, stones or other foreign material. The unwashed sand
delivered to the Site shall be rejected it if fails to meet this requirement and shall be immediately
removed from the Site. Neatly store all acceptable unwashed sand on the Site prior to their use.

(c) Treated Sludge

Provide the treated sludge required for the manufacture of plant-soil. Collect the treated sludge
as and when required from any of the following treatment works as directed.

The treatment works are :

(i) Bedok Wastewater Treatment Plant


(ii) Serangoon Sludge Treatment Works
(iii) Ulu Pandan Sewage Treatment Works
(iv) Kranji Sewage Treatment Works
(v) Seletar Sewage Treatment Works

Collect, transport and store the treated sludge properly. Bear all costs and expenses incurred in
this respect, including any charge levied by PUB for the collection of the treated sludge.

Neatly store the treated sludge within a demarcated area on the Site prior to their use. Treated
sludge shall only be used in non water catchment areas. In water catchment areas, use
approved soil conditioner and compound fertilizer in its place.

Before proceeding with the manufacture of plant soil the Contractor shall first carry out a trial mix using
the approved sub-soil, unwashed sand and sludge. Three samples of the trial mix shall be analysed
for its physical composition to ascertain if the composition of the final mix falls within the range of
composition specified above. Mixes that do not conform to the Specifications shall have their mix
proportion modified to achieve an acceptable composition.

CE21/S2.DOC(51)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-52

2.89 TURFING

Provide a layer of 150 - 200mm thickness of approved soil mixture evenly spread over the Site or as
directed by the SO Rep, followed by the planting of fresh turves. The soil mixture shall be laid below
the desired turf level. Sludge can be omitted for heavily built up and pedestrianised across areas such
as neighbourhood and town centres and eating houses and compound fertilizers substituted.

The turf shall be closed turfed with 50mm thick Axonopus Compressus (commonly called Cow Grass).

All turves supplied by the Contractor shall be of healthy and vigorous stock of approved type and quality.

Turf sods shall be laid abutting unless otherwise directed, with no appreciable spaces between adjoining
turf sods. Each sod shall be properly laid on a loosened soil surface and tamped down to prevent
movement or displacement of any kind. For slopes, the turf sod shall be pegged down to prevent
movement. The turfing shall thereafter be rolled with a suitable 1-tonne (maximum) roller. The
Contractor shall use a laser grader to ensure the gradient and level of the completed turf so as to allow
for effective surface drainage. On completion, the turfing shall present a uniform and regular
appearance without any localised depressions.

Turf sods shall be free of weeds, especially vigorous weeds like Lallang and Mimosa Pudica.

Submit for approval a sample of the grass whenever an area is to be turfed. Plant the approved turf
promptly on arrival to avoid desiccation.

The turf species shall be Axonopus compressus or commonly called Cow Grass.

When carrying out turfing work, the organic matter and approved Soil mix (ASM) shall be thoroughly
mixed before application. The ASM or soil mixture shall be laid 150-200mm below the desired turf level.
The turf sods shall then be planted on top of this layer. Thereafter, gaps between sods shall be filled
ONLY with approved soil mix or sand, and then a thin layer of 25mm thick approved soil mix or sand
shall be broadcast on the turf to fill all depressions to give an even, smooth finish, and bring the ground
to the final level. All soil mix used shall be free of clumps and should be loose. After planting and
watering, no additional spreading of organic matter on the newly laid turfed area shall be allowed. The
Contractor shall note that the relevant Authorities / SO’s Rep may impose changes to or additional
requirements on the composition of turfing substrate and top-dressing material and the Contractor shall
adhere to the instructions given.

The Contractor is to grade and camber the ground to ensure sufficient surface water runoff. All stones
and debris must be removed before levelling and cambering. There shall be no areas, spots or
depressions that may result in the stagnation of rainwater for a period of more than 1 (One) Day. If
necessary, the Contractor shall roll the ground with approved rollers to achieve the camber and flatness
of the ground so as to achieve a flat and true surface.

Establish the turves in 3 months from the date of planting by means of :

(a) Watering at regular intervals


(b) Weeding regularly
(c) Replacing badly growing or unsatisfactory turves immediately
(d) Applying fertilizer and cutting the grass once every two weeks.

Thereafter, apply compound fertilizer once every 3 months. The compound fertilizer shall be of approved
type and the application rate shall be 10 g to 15 g per m2. Nitrogen fertiliser is recommended.

All earth slopes shall be carried out as soon as possible in order to ensure rapid growth of protective
grass. Provide and fix the turves promptly after laying the top soil in order to prevent erosion thereof
due to wet weather or other causes. Make good any loss of unprotected or inadequately protected top
soil.

When the level of the completed turfing Works is undulating or uneven, the turfed areas, except for those
on steep slopes, shall be properly rolled out with a garden roller or other approved means. The turfing
shall give a uniform even surface on completion.

CE21/S2.DOC(52)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-53

2.90 MAINTENANCE OF TURVES

The Contractor shall allow in the Contract Sum for all costs and expenses for providing maintenance
services as specified hereunder, to the turfing Works, for a period of one year commencing from the
Date of Substantial Completion for the Works or phase or sub-phase of the Works as certified by the
Superintending Officer (hereinafter referred to as the "Defects Liability Period" for the purposes of this
clause).

Throughout the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under
the Contract and during the Defects Liability Period, maintain the turves by cutting and removing dead
turves and weeds once every two weeks and replacing with new stock.

All turfing shall be regularly watered, weeded and maintained until growing satisfactorily in the opinion
of the relevant Authorities / SO’s Rep, and the works for turfing shall include for such regular watering
and tending such as weeding, grass-cutting, rolling, etc. Fertilising should be done as required. Any
badly growing or otherwise unsatisfactory turf shall be removed and replaced with approved quality turf
by the Contractor at his own expense. This maintenance shall continue until the turf is properly
established in the opinion of the relevant Authorities / SO’s Rep.

The Contractor shall be required to maintain all vegetation that is to be retained within the land within
contract boundary as instructed by the relevant Authorities / SO’s Rep, up till the handover of the Land
within contract boundary to the relevant authorities. The Contractor shall reinstate any of the vegetation
within the Land and within contract boundary that has been damaged, diseased or have died throughout
the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract
and during the Defects Laibility Period at his own cost.
2.90 MAINTENANCE OF TURVES (CONT'D)

The Contractor shall carry out routine grass cutting and maintenance, up till the date the Land and work
area within contact boundary is being handed over to the relevant Authorities or any other agencies as
instructed by the SO’s Rep.

Before commencing necessary grass cutting, manually remove all weeds and undesirable vegetation
growing in the turfed areas. Close cut grass as short as possible following the general contours of the
ground. The stock or blade of the grass after each cutting shall not stand higher than 20mm above the
ground level. Approved mechanical cutters of various capacities to suit site conditions shall be utilised
to cut the grass. Remove all cut grass from the Site.

Cut back the edges of turfed areas adjoining roadways, footpaths, kerbs, dividers and concrete paved
areas to proper straight lines or curves as the case may be, and trim thereafter to produce a neat and
tidy appearance. Carry out this work immediately after the grass in the area has been cut or manually
weed out and clear. Cut and manually weed out and clear grass growing in the joints of footpaths,
scupper drains, etc.

If the Contractor fails to maintain the turves, the Employer shall have the right to engage its own
workmen or other contractors to carry out such work and the cost incurred shall be recovered from the
Contractor. In addition, the SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and
Irregularities" to impose charges against the Contractor.

2.91 SAFETY MEASURES FOR GRASS-CUTTING MACHINES

(a) Take every safety precaution to eliminate danger to the workmen, the general public and the
property of others.

(b) Install all grass-cutting machines used with suitable protective guards of steel or other approved
materials to eliminate splinters and flung-off objects from causing damage. Under no
circumstances shall the protective guards be removed from machines in operation.

(c) The Contractor shall not use open blade rotary machine. Hand held rotary grass cutters shall be
of the nylon cord type.

(d) The grass-cutter shall wear safety boots, goggles, helmets and safety vest. When these safety
requirements are not complied with, the Contractor's foreman or the SO Rep shall instruct the
grass-cutter to stop work.

(e) Keep the public away from the grass-cutter and erect a signboard on the Site with the wordings
"DANGER", KEEP OFF, Grass Cutting Works In Progress".
CE21/S2.DOC(53)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-54

2.92 GREENERY PROVISION WITHIN ROAD SIDETABLES

The technical requirements for roadside greenery provision shall be provided and constructed in
accordance with relevant Authorities (such as LTA and NParks) requirements and standard Code of
Practices.

(A) Roadside Verges

Proposed roadside verges are to be excavated to 1m deep, backfilled with approved soil mixture
(ASM) and closed turfed with 50mm thick Axonopus Compressus (cow grass). The Approved Soil
Mixture (ASM) shall comply with NParks’ specifications and requirements.

Disturbed roadside verges are to be reinstated with 50mm thick Axonopus Compressus (cow
grass) in close turfing with provision of 100mm depth planting mixture. The planting mixture
should be made up of ASM.

The component of Approved Soil Mixture (ASM) shall be in the ratio 3:2:1 of loamy soil, compost
and washed sand, respectively. The proportions are by volume.

CE21/S2.DOC(54)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-55

2.92 GREENERY PROVISION WITHIN ROAD SIDETABLES (CONT’D)

(B) Maintenance of Roadside verges

The Contractor shall allow in the Contract Sum for all costs and expenses for providing
maintenance services as specified hereunder, to the turfing Works, for a period of one year
commencing from the Date of Substantial Completion for the Works or phase or sub-phase of
the Works as certified by the Superintending Officer (hereinafter referred to as the "Defects
Liability Period" for the purposes of this clause).

Throughout the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed
under the Contract and during the Defects Liability Period, maintain the turves by cutting and
removing dead turves and weeds once every two weeks and replacing with new stock.

All turfing shall be regularly watered, weeded and maintained until growing satisfactorily in the
opinion of the SO’s Rep. The works for turfing shall include for such regular watering and tending
such as weeding, grass-cutting, rolling, etc. Fertilising should be done as required. Any badly
growing or otherwise unsatisfactory turf shall be removed and replaced with approved quality turf
by the Contractor at his own expense. This maintenance shall continue until the turf is properly
established in the opinion of the relevant Authorities / SO’s Rep.

The Contractor shall carry out routine grass cutting and maintenance, up till the date the work
area within contact boundary is being handed over to the relevant Authorities or any other
agencies as instructed by the SO’s Rep.

Before commencing necessary grass cutting, manually remove all weeds and undesirable
vegetation growing in the turfed areas. Close cut grass as short as possible following the general
contours of the ground. The stock or blade of the grass after each cutting shall not stand higher
than 20mm above the ground level. Approved mechanical cutters of various capacities to suit
site conditions shall be utilised to cut the grass. Remove all cut grass from the Site.

Cut back the edges of all sidetables and other turfed areas adjoining roadways, footpaths, kerbs,
dividers and concrete paved areas to proper straight lines or curves as the case may be, and
trim thereafter to produce a neat and tidy appearance. Carry out this work immediately after the
grass in the area has been cut or manually weed out and clear. Cut and manually weed out and
clear grass growing in the joints of footpaths, scupper drains, etc.

If the Contractor fails to maintain the turves, the Employer shall have the right to engage its own
workmen or other contractors to carry out such work and the cost incurred shall be recovered
from the Contractor. In addition, the SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance
and Irregularities" to impose charges against the Contractor.

CE21/S2.DOC(55)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-56

2.92 GREENERY PROVISION WITHIN ROAD SIDETABLES (CONT’D)

(C) Planting Verge

Tree planting reserve shall consist of a 1000mm deep trough of loamy soil throughout. Loamy
soil shall be considered to be within the following range of composition of Sand, Silt and Clay.

Sand : 30% to 60%


Silt : 10% to 70%
Clay : 0% to 30%

Testing of the soil composition at the rate of 1 test for every 200m of sidetable subject to a
minimum of 2 tests are to be carried out at an approved laboratory. The Test shall comply with
the relevant specification of BS 1377.

Where the existing soil does not conform to the above requirement, replace the existing soil with
loamy soil. Samples of the loamy soil may be required by the SO Rep for testing at an approved
laboratory.

Provide all the necessary Construction Equipment, tools, instruments and materials for carrying
out the tests including the provision of all necessary transportation of test materials, samples,
etc.

(i) Setting Out

(1) The Contractor shall set out the Works in accordance with the Drawings or as
directed by the SO Rep.

(2) Location of trees and palms shall be laid out and pegged by the Contractor on
the Site to be inspected by the SO Rep before commencement of the Works.

(ii) Hole For Planting

(1) All holes shall be inspected and approved by the SO Rep before backfill of soil
mixture. All excavated and unwanted materials shall be carted away.

(2) Holes for the planting of instant tree shall be 1.50m x 1.50m x 1.0m deep, unless
otherwise specified. Holes for the planting of palms shall be 1.0m x 1.0m x 1.0m
deep, unless otherwise specified.

(iii) Soil Mixture Used

The Approved Soil Mixture (ASM) shall comply with NParks’ specifications and
requirements.

All topsoil shall be of approved quality, free from rubbish, roots, stumps, subsoil or any
extraneous matter, be friable and porous in texture.

Unwashed sand shall be free of any debris, stones or other foreign material.

Soil conditioner shall have at least 50% organic matter, NPK of 1%: 2%: 1% and a
pH value of between 6 to 8. The Contractor shall provide a laboratory test report to the
SO Rep for approval before using the soil conditioner.

All planting holes shall be backfilled with 3: 1 topsoil, soil conditioner and 1 kg per m3 of
granular fertilizer NPK (15:15:6:4) or 4:2:1 subsoil, unwashed sand and soil conditioner
with 1kg per m3 of granular fertilizer NPK (15:15:6:4) well mixed to a level 250mm higher
than the adjacent ground level at the time of filling. The subsoil is defined as the strata
found below the topsoil layer.

(iv) Purchase Of Trees

The Contractor shall purchase the trees/palms from private nurseries. All costs of
purchasing, transplanting and maintenance of trees shall be included in the Contract Sum.

CE21/S2.DOC(56)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-57

2.92 GREENERY PROVISION WITHIN ROAD SIDETABLES (CONT’D)

(C) Planting Verge (Cont’d)

(v) Plant Quality

Unless otherwise specified, the plant quality of plants purchased from private nurseries
shall comply with the following specifications:

(1) All trees/palms delivered to the Site shall be of the specified size, free of pests and
diseases and undamaged. The trees shall be approved by the SO Rep before
planting.

(2) The SO Rep shall reserve the right to reject unhealthy, damaged, diseased, infested
trees during the entire Time for Completion and Defects Liability Period.

(3) The Contractor shall immediately remove and replace all rejected trees/palms at his
own cost and expense.

(4) The plant size shall be measured on the day of planting at the Site in accordance
with the Drawings or as directed by the SO Rep in writing.

(5) All trees/palms shall posses the natural characteristics and growth habit typical of its
variety and species to the satisfaction of SO Rep.

(6) All trees/palms where required under the Contract shall comply with the descriptions
and requirements specified hereunder :

(a) Instant Trees

All instant trees shall have a minimum of 2 m clear and upright straight trunk of
0.3m girth (measured at 0.5m height from the collar of the trunk) with at least
three (3) branches of minimum girth 0.08m each and 1.0m in length each. They
shall have a minimum rootball dimension of 750mm diameter x 600mm deep.

(b) Singled-Stemmed Palms

All palms shall have a single trunk of minimum 1.5m height or as specified and
measured from the collar to the tip of the youngest frond.

(c) Clustered Palms

All clustered palms shall have a minimum of 5 suckers per clump clustered
together and shall have a minimum of 3 main stems of minimum clear trunk
height of 1.2m measured from the root collar to the base of the leaf sheath or
otherwise described for each species.

(vi) Plant Protection

(1) All plant materials shall be carefully protected and if necessary wrapped in the
nursery during lifting, awaiting transportation, and unloading and during
storage on the Site. No plant shall be left on the Site unplanted for more than
two (2) days.

(2) Any evidence of unsatisfactory protection to roots, stems, branches and leaves
will result in the trees being rejected.

(3) The Contractor shall handle the plant in such a manner so that the ball of earth
surrounding the roots is not broken. This shall be firmly held by plastic or other
wrappings. All plastic and other imperishable wrappings shall be removed
before planting. Trees shall be planted with the ground level at the same level
as the soil mark on the stem. Water all trees thoroughly immediately after
planting.

CE21/S2.DOC(57)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-58

2.92 GREENERY PROVISION WITHIN ROAD SIDETABLES (CONT'D)

(C) Planting Verge (Cont’d)

(vii) Stakes, Ties, Tree Guards And Collar Protectors

Stakes shall be stout, straight, of good quality, properly treated with approved wood
preservative, and approved by the SO Rep. They shall be of a diameter of at least 40 mm
and at least 1.50m long for trees. Alternatively, the stakes can be of galvanised GI pipes
of diameter 25.4 mm and approximate length of 2.5m or 3.0m approved by the SO Rep.
They shall be firmly driven into the ground by using a mechanical device to be approved
by the SO Rep and suitable ties and pads are to be supplied and fixed for each tree. Tree
guards shall consist of 4 numbers of 50mm x 50mm x 1.50m poles vertically driven into
the ground to a depth of 0.50m and 8 numbers of 25mm x 50mm horizontal poles of
1000mm or 1500mm length as directed. All poles of the tree guards are to be fixed with
screws and nuts. The timber used shall be approved by the SO Rep and painted with
paint, the colour and quality of which shall be approved by the SO Rep.

Tree collar protectors are to be provided for all trees. A protector is made of a PVC tube
of length 200mm and diameter 100mm and thickness 2 mm with a slit cut along the full
length of the tube.

(viii) Watering Of Trees

Immediately after planting, the Contractor shall water the trees and continue to water them
at least once a day for at least 10 continuous days, or until the trees are well established
and need no further daily watering. The Contractor shall also water the trees at any time
during the Defects Liability Period whenever directed by the SO Rep at the Contractor's
cost and expense. The source of water shall be approved by the SO Rep.

(ix) Weeding

Weeding shall be carried out using garden forks approved by SO Rep. The Contractor
shall loosen the soil with the garden fork around and under the weeds and thereafter
remove the loosened weeds by hand.

(x) Fertilising

For ornamental instant trees, fertilizer NPK Mg (12:12:17:2) shall be inserted at a rate of
0.5kg per 250mm girth into holes 300mm deep and at 500mm apart along the dripline.
For other instant trees, the details of fertilising shall be submitted to the SO Rep for
approval.

CE21/S2.DOC(58)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-59

2.92 GREENERY PROVISION WITHIN ROAD SIDETABLES (CONT'D)

(C) Planting Verge (Cont’d)

(xi) Trimming

The Contractor shall provide only trained workmen or those experienced in pruning work.

The Contractor shall ensure that his workmen completely and explicitly comply with the
instructions of the SO Rep regarding pruning Works required, in particular, the height,
length and number of tree branches to be pruned or trimmed and the final height of tree
to be pollarded. A vertical clearance of 6m for tree branches is required for trees planted
on the roadside table and a vertical clearance of 4.5m for tree branches at the centre
divider. For horizontal clearance, the Contractor shall ensure that there is no tree
branches obstructing road users. As for street lighting, a clearance of 2m both horizontally
and vertically around the lamps are required.

The Contractor shall provide each of his pruning team with a measuring pole approved by
the SO Rep to measure and show to the SO Rep that the final height of tree pruning height
complies with the instructions of the SO Rep.

Trees shall be trimmed as directed by the SO Rep including performing and providing the
following :

(1) Trim and removed extra leader


(2) Trim and remove all side branches from the main trunk measured 3.0m from the
ground for trees along footpaths and roadside.
(3) Trim and remove all dead, broken, diseased and unwanted branches/shoots.
(4) Trim and remove overlapping branches rubbing each other.
(5) Remove and clear from site all trimmed vegetation.
(6) Paint all cut surfaces exceeding 25mm with 2 coats of anti-fungus wound sealant

(xii) Pest Control

For vegetative stage of trees, the top and bottom of the tree leaves shall be thoroughly
sprayed with approved pesticides. Re-spraying shall be done if it rains within 6 hours
after spraying. Approved pesticides are :

Dimethoate 40% EC
Deltamethrin 1.25% EC
White Summer Oil 80% EC
Abate 1% sand granules Benomyl 50% EC
Captan 50% UP
Thiram 50% UP
Terrazole 24% EC
Copper Fungicide (Metalic Copper) 50%
Mancozeb 80% WP
Captafol 39% EC
Omite Tenac (sticker) 30% WP

CE21/S2.DOC(59)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-60

2.92 GREENERY PROVISION WITHIN ROAD SIDETABLES (CONT'D)

(xiii) Maintenance Of Roadside Trees

The Contractor shall allow in the Contract Sum for all cost and expense for providing
maintenance services, as specified hereunder, to the tree/palm Works, for a period of one year
commencing from the Date of Substantial Completion for the Works or phase or sub-phase of
the Works as certified by the Superintending Officer. Planted trees/palms shall be maintained by
adjusting tree tie, adjusting tripod support including providing and / or performing the following
maintenance work or other reasonable work.

OPERATION FREQUENCY

Weeding
Monthly )
Watering
Daily ) and/ or to be carried out
Pest Control
Monthly ) as directed by the SO
Fertilizing
Monthly ) Rep
Pruning
Monthly )
Adjusting tree ties and supporters
Monthly )
Replace / repair of damaged/missing supporters /
As directed by SO Rep.
collars for trees

Replace unhealthy, damaged, diseased or


As directed by SO Rep.
infested trees

2.93 PLANTING OF INSTANT TREES IN CARPARKS

(a) Transplanting of Existing Trees (Instant Trees)

Purchase Instant Trees from the Nurseries. Arrange to transplant such trees from the Nurseries
to the proposed work. The cost of the whole transplanting operation including the purchase of
the trees shall be included in the Contract Sum.

(b) Transplanting Requirements and Procedures

Transplanting of existing trees shall be carried out as follows :

(i) Branch Pruning

Prune branches or pollard the tree as directed and paint all cuts with fungicidal sealant.

(ii) Rootballs

All trees to be transplanted shall have an earth rootball of a minimum diameter or a size
as specified by the SO Rep. This shall be done by excavating a trench about 0.5m deep
around the tree at an appropriate distance. Cut all protruding roots and paint with
fungicidal sealant.

Transplant excavated trees within the same working day unless otherwise directed.

(iii) Tree Pits

To avoid delay, make ready the new pit for the tree transplant before the tree is brought
to the planting site. Pit shall be at least 0.5m wider and 0.25m deeper than the rootball to
allow for incorporation of topsoil surrounding the roots. The minimum tree pit dimensions
shall be 1.5m x 1.5m x 1.0m. All planting holes for instant trees shall be backfilled with
good quality approved soil mixture to a level 250mm higher than the adjacent ground level
at the time of filling. Tripod shall be provided to keep it firmly in place, if required.

(iv) Tree Guards

Provide tree guards to Instant trees planted as specified.

CE21/S2.DOC(60)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-61

2.93 PLANTING OF INSTANT TREES IN CARPARKS (CONT’D)

(b) Transplanting Requirements and Procedures (Cont’d)

(v) Lifting and Transporting

Lift the tree by motor crane or other lifting machinery of appropriate capacity. Take every
precaution including wrapping rootball securely by moistened canvas and angle bar frame
or other approved materials to prevent damage to the rootball during the loading and
transporting of the tree to the work Site.

(vi) Before unloading the tree into position, measure the depth and diameter of the rootball
and made the necessary adjustment to the pit. Set and orientate the tree in the hole,
adjust the depth and plant to a depth corresponding to its former depth with minimum
delay. Firmly consolidate the backfilling to eliminate air pockets under and around the
roots.

(c) Fertilising of Instant Trees

Apply fertilizer NPK Mg (12:12:17:2) at a rate of 0.5 kg per 250 mm girth into holes 300mm deep
and 500mm apart along the dripline. Carry out the first fertilising at the end of 6 months after
planting. Thereafter, carry out fertilising twice in the next 6 months.

(d) Maintenance of Instant Trees

The Contractor shall allow in the Contract Sum for all costs and expenses for providing
maintenance services, as specified hereunder, to the instant tree Works, for a period of one year
commencing from the Date of Substantial Completion for the Works or phase or sub-phase of
the Works, as certified by the Superintending Officer (hereinafter referred to as the "Maintenance
Period" for the purposes of this subclause).

Maintain planted instant trees by carrying out the following works :

Operation Frequency

Watering (i) Daily watering for the 1st month.

(ii) Thereafter, water on alternate days for the 2nd month.

(iii) Thereafter, water once a week for the 3rd month.

(iv) Thereafter, water when necessary or as directed by the


SO Rep until the end of the Maintenance Period.

In addition, make good all damaged tree guards during the Maintenance Period.

2.94 LANDSCAPING OF PEDESTRIAN OVERHEAD BRIDGE

The Contractor shall allow in the Contract Sum for all costs and expenses for providing maintenance
services, as specified hereunder, to the planting Works for the pedestrian overhead bridge, for a period
of one year commencing from the Date of Substantial Completion for the Works or phase or sub-phase
of the Works, as certified by the Superintending Officer (hereinafter referred to as the "Maintenance
Period" for the purposes of this clause).

Plants for the pedestrian overhead bridge shall be of selected/approved stocks and shall be obtained
from the Contractor's own source, transported to the Site and planted according to the Drawings or as
directed.

Comply with the current requirements of planting of shrubs/palms/creepers etc as laid down by NParks.
The standards of the planting and maintenance of the plants may be obtained from NParks.

Ensure that the plants are established and grown to reasonable size at the end of the Maintenance
Period before handing over to NParks for their maintenance. The planting scheme shall strictly comply
with their requirements.

CE21/S2.DOC(61)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-62

2.94 LANDSCAPING OF PEDESTRIAN OVERHEAD BRIDGE (CONT’D)

The planting and maintenance of the shrubs/palms/creepers shall conform to the following
requirements :

(a) Soil Mixture for Planting

Excavate holes for planting as indicated in the planting scheme Drawings or as directed. Backfill
all planting holes beneath the staircases/ramps, around bridge columns and the entire planting
trough along the prestressed concrete beams with approved soil mixture. For planting holes,
carry out the backfilling to levels not exceeding 250mm higher than the adjacent ground level at
time of filling.

(b) Planting of Shrubs/Palms/Creepers

Handle the plants in such a manner that the ball of earth surrounding the roots is not broken.
This shall be firmly held by plastic or other wrapping. Remove all plastic and other imperishable
wrappings before planting. Plant with ground level at the same level as the soil mark on the
stem. Water all plants thoroughly immediately after planting.

(c) Watering

Use 10 litres of water per m2 for watering the plants. Additional watering may be required as
and when directed. Carry out watering by using rubber hose fitted with an adjustable spraying
head/gun to wet the soil thoroughly.

(d) Soil-Loosening

Spike the weeding area to a depth of 100mm using a garden fork.

(e) Weeding

Weed the landscaped area using hand trowel or weeding hoe.

(f) Fertilising

(i) Palms

Broadcast fertiliser NPK Mg (15:15:6:4) at a rate of 375 g per palm within the weeding
circle 120mm away from stem.

(ii) Landscaped Area

Broadcast Fertiliser NPK Mg (12:12:17:2) at 50 g per m2 as directed.

(iii) Climber/Creeper

Spray approved foliar fertiliser as directed.

(g) Pest Control

Spray approved pesticides immediately after the infestation is spotted until the infestation is
controlled.

(h) Maintenance

Maintain planted shrubs/palms/creepers by carrying out the following works :

Operation Frequency
Watering (1) Daily watering for the 1st month.
(2) Thereafter, water on alternate days for the 2nd month
(3) Thereafter, water once a week for the 3rd month
(4) Thereafter, water only as directed until the end of the
Maintenance Period

Soil Loosening Monthly till the end of the Maintenance Period


Weeding Monthly till the end of the Maintenance Period

CE21/S2.DOC(62)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-63

2.95 PRECAST R.C. AERATION SLABS

(a) General

Where indicated in the Drawings or as directed, precast R.C. aeration slabs shall be
manufactured and laid in the manner as specified. Submit details of the R.C. aeration slabs to
the SO Rep for approval.

75mm thick aeration slabs shall be used in the carparks while 100mm thick aeration slabs shall
be used in the lorry parks. The details of the slabs shall comply strictly with that shown in the
Drawings.

For purpose of identification, there shall be different types of slab arrangement used for the car
and lorry parks. Locations of a particular type of slab arrangement to be adopted in each car or
lorry park shall be as shown in the Drawings. The number of slabs per lot for each type of
arrangement shall be as shown in the Drawings.

(b) Singapore Quality Mark/Product Listing Scheme Certification Scheme/ISO 9000

Obtain the precast R.C. aeration slabs only from suppliers licensed under ISO 9000 or PSB
Singapore Quality Mark/Product Listing Scheme/Certification Scheme.

(c) Laying of Aeration Slabs

Roll the crusher run base to a level to allow the granite fines layer to be laid. The finished surface
level of the slabs after laying shall follow the gradient of the surface of the adjacent premix and
the straight edges of the slabs when formed shall be true to line and level.

Inspect each slab for stability after laying. If rocking takes place, remove from position and
regrade the granite fines to achieve the desired result.

(d) Turfing between Aeration Slabs

Fill the gaps between the slabs with approved good quality top soil to a level 10mm below the
top surface of the aeration slabs.

Tear or Cut the turves to a size slightly wider than the gaps and close plant into position followed
by light tamping with a piece of timber. Do not use excessive pressure produced by heavy
objects. Watering of the turf just planted shall immediately be followed up. Mix top soil with
sludge to a proportion of 3:1.

(e) Watering of Turves

Water the turves and trees at least twice daily once they are planted in position or otherwise
directed. This process shall continue for a period of not less than one month or until such length
of time when the plants have taken roots and show signs of growth.

Convey water through a hose connected to a tapped supply or where this is not available in the
vicinity, from water tanks of sufficient capacity and direct towards the gaps and voids where
turves are planted or at the pits where the trees are planted, at a distance not more than 150mm
away to avoid splashing.

(f) Water Absorption Tests

Select random samples of the precast RC aeration slabs for water absorption tests to be carried
out by an SAC accredited laboratory. The maximum average rates of water absorption (%)
calculated on the dry weight of three test pieces per sample shall not exceed 3% at 30 minutes.

0.5% of the total number of slabs from the stockpile subject to a minimum of three numbers of
slabs shall be taken for water absorption test. Break the selected slabs to be tested into three
test pieces each before transporting them to the laboratory.

(g) Failure of Water Absorption Tests

The SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose
charges against the Contractor for every sample of aeration slab whose average water
absorption exceeds 3% at 30 minutes,

CE21/S2.DOC(63)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-64

2.95 PRECAST R.C. AERATION SLABS (CONT'D)

(h) Transverse Strength Tests

Samples of RC aeration slabs at a rate of up to three pieces for every 1,000 pieces shall be
selected for transverse strength test performed in the manner as described in BS EN 1339 and
in an SAC accredited laboratory. For the purpose of this test, the supporting rollers shall be
spaced at 500mm apart for the 75mm slabs and 635mm apart for the 100mm slabs and the slabs
when subjected to a centrally placed vertical load shall not fail at a value of 40 KN and 48 KN for
the 75mm and 100mm thick aeration slabs respectively.

The SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose
charges against the Contractor for each sample that fails to comply with the above test
requirement. Each batch of slabs represented by the three sample whose combined average
results fail to attain 40 KN or 48 KN for the 75mm and 100mm thick aeration slabs respectively
may be accepted only at the sole discretion of the SO Rep after he has considered the degree
of failure and other related circumstances.

(i) Maintenance

The Contractor shall allow in the Contract Sum for all costs and expenses for providing
maintenance services, as specified hereunder, to the Precast RC Aeration Slabs and turfing
Works, for a period of one year commencing from the Date of Substantial Completion for the
Works or phase or sub-phase of the Works, as certified by the Superintending Officer (hereinafter
referred to as the "Maintenance Period" for the purposes of this subclauses).

Keep a schedule of completion date of work done in each and every car and lorry park and return
to the Site so as to carry out the necessary maintenance work of regular trimming, deweeding,
tending and watering the turves and plant at least once a month throughout the Time for
Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract and
the Maintenance Period.

Maintain all the aeration slabs in proper conditions once they have been laid. Keep a schedule
of completion dates and return to the Site at least once a month throughout the Time for
Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract and
the Maintenance Period to inspect and ensure that the slabs are stable and do not rock under
the loads of vehicles. Replace any slab found cracked or chipped to an extent which is
unsatisfactory.

2.96 PRECAST BG SLABS

(a) General

Manufacture precast B.G. slabs as indicated in the Drawings or where directed by the SO Rep
and in accordance to the requirement of BS 1339 or SS 214 whenever applicable. Random
samples of 3 for every order of 1000 precast B.G. slabs are to be taken for carrying out Water
Absorption Test and Transverse Strength Test as specified in BS 1339 or SS 214 at an SAC
accredited laboratory subject to a minimum of 3 numbers.

The maximum average rate of water absorption (%) calculated on the dry weight of three test
pieces per sample shall not exceed 3% at 30 minutes. For the Transverse strength test, the
supporting rollers shall be spaced at 450mm apart and the slabs when subjected to a centrally
placed vertical load shall not fail at a value of 19 KN.

The SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose
charges against the Contractor for each sample that fails to comply with the above test
requirement.

(b) Laying of B.G. Slabs

Inspect each B.G. slabs for stability after laying. If rocking takes place, remove it from position
and regrade and compact the base to achieve the desired result.

CE21/S2.DOC(64)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-65

2.96 PRECAST BG SLABS (CONT'D)

(c) Turfing between B.G. Slabs

Fill the gaps between the slabs with approved soil mixture to a level 10mm below the top surface
of the B.G. Slabs. Cut or tear turves to a size slightly wider than the gaps and close planted into
position and then tamping lightly with a piece of timber. Excessive pressure produced by heavy
objects shall not be allowed. Follow up immediately with watering of the turf just planted.

(d) Watering of Turves

Water the turves at least twice daily once they are planted in position or otherwise directed.
Continue watering for a period of not less than one month or until such length of time when the
plants have taken roots and show signs of growth.

Convey water through a hose connected to a tapped supply or where this is not available in the
vicinity, from water tanks of sufficient capacity and direct towards the gaps and voids where
turves are planted, at a distance not more than 150mm away to avoid splashing.

(e) Maintenance

The Contractor shall allow in the Contract Sum for all costs and expenses for providing
maintenance services, as specified hereunder, to the Precast B.G. Slabs and turfing Works, for
a period of one year commencing from the Date of Substantial Completion for the Works or
phase or sub-phase of the Works, as certified by the Superintending Officer (hereinafter referred
to as the "Maintenance Period" for the purposes of this subclause).

Keep a schedule of completion date of work done and return to the Site so as to carry out the
necessary maintenance work of regular trimming, deweeding, tending and watering the turves
and plant at least once a month throughout the Time for Completion and any time period where
liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract and the Maintenance Period.

Maintain all B.G. slabs in proper condition once they have been laid. Ensure that the slabs are
stable and do not rock throughout the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated
damages are imposed under the Contract and Maintenance Period. Replace any slab found
cracked or chipped to an extent which is unsatisfactory.

2.97 TESTING OF PREMIX

The quality and standard of premix for the road and carparks shall be in accordance with the Clause
and subclauses on premix bituminous surfacing. Should the bitumen content of the premix or the
grading of aggregate fall outside the specified limits, the premix shall be rejected. In these
circumstances, the Contractor shall be required to accept the corrective measures including
compensation by additional layer of premix or the payment of fines as maintenance fees as directed by
the SO Rep or LTA who shall be the final authority for the road.

2.98 TAKING OVER BY LTA AND THE EMPLOYER

All materials used for the roads and carparks such as concrete kerbs, channels, concrete pipes, etc are
to conform to the standard requirements of LTA and the SO Rep in strength, hydraulic, bearing, grading,
absorption tests, for taking over purposes.

2.99 LTA'S OR THE SO REP'S REQUIREMENTS

The Contractor's particular attention is drawn to all tests required by LTA or the SO Rep for premix and
such concrete precast units as roadside kerbs, dividers, road base and sub-base etc. Samples shall
be extracted from the Works actually incorporated for analysis to ensure compliance with the
Specifications. Provide the necessary labour in extracting the samples as requested by the SO Rep.
Make good and patch up all cavities caused by the removal of these samples.

CE21/S2.DOC(65)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-66

2.99 LTA'S OR THE SO REP'S REQUIREMENTS (CONT'D)

The number of test samples shall conform to LTA requirements or the relevant SS or BS.

For service roads and carparks to be taken over by the HDB, the number of samples for final testing
shall comply with the following :

Rate of Sampling Minimum Number

Kerbs 1 sample for every 120m length Two

Premix 1 sample for every 550m2 of carpark Two

1 sample for every 450m2 of service


road/driveway Two

Precast Footpath Slabs 1 sample for every 350m2 Two

Where any of the tests carried out by LTA or the SO Rep fails to pass the requirements, the decision
taken by them shall be final irrespective of whether the same samples had been passed by other
Authorities or not. The Contractor shall either :

(a) replace the sections of the rejected works as indicated by LTA or the SO Rep with the approved
ones, or

(b) pay to LTA or the Employer the sum of money determined by the LTA or SO Rep according to the
degree of failure.

The SO Rep shall determine whether item (a) or (b) of the above is to be adopted and reserves the right
to set off such bills and expenses against monies due or becoming due to the Contractor.

2.100 LTA'S ROAD TESTING REQUIREMENT

1. The Contractor shall engage the services of SAC/SINGLAS laboratories for plant, material, labour
and transport needed for cutting of samples and to carry out testing of the cut samples and shall
be responsible for the supervision of the cutting of samples and reinstatement after extraction.

2. Prior to road testing, the Contractor shall submit the following to the SO Rep for his approval and
subsequent submission to LTA:

(a) A copy of coloured site plan showing the road/roads to be tested and the location where
samples would be extracted.

(i) For premix, cut sample to be obtained from pavement at every 50m on each
carriageway.

(ii) For rigid pavement (concrete), cut sample to be obtained at every 50m3 of concrete
on each carriageway.

(iii) For precast kerbs, 3 test kerbs shall be taken at random for every 2000 units or less.

A minimum of 3 samples is required on each type of pavement and kerb of the road Works.
The test results endorsed by a PE are to be submitted to the SO Rep..

(b) Name of the SAC/SINGLAS laboratory

(c) Name of Supplier of premix

(d) Date of premix and concrete laid on site

(e) Type of premix and concrete mix laid on site

(f) Thickness of premix and concrete laid on site

(g) Date and Time of sample cutting.

CE21/S2.DOC(66)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-67

2.100 LTA'S ROAD TESTING REQUIREMENT (CONT'D)

3. The following Tests are to be carried out :

3.1 Water absorption test for precast kerb

- To conform to the requirements and criteria for acceptance specified in Section 9.18.8
of LTA Materials & Workmanship Specification.

3.2 Compressive strength test for concrete (core strength)

- the compressive strength of a core shall be prepared and tested in accordance with
BS 1881.

- to conform to the requirements and criteria for acceptance specified in Table 9.5 of
Section 9.9.7 of the LTA Materials & Workmanship Specification.

3.3 Aggregate gradations and bitumen contents of Wearing Course and Asphaltic Base Course

- to conform to the requirements and criteria for acceptance specified in the following
Sections of LTA Materials & Workmanship Specification :

- Graded Granite Aggregates - Section 13.3.2.3(f), (g) & (h)

- Aggregate Grading Requirement - Section 13.3.3.2 Table 13.17

- Requirement for Bitumen - Section 13.3.3.2 Table 13.17

4. The following are to be submitted together with the test results :

4.1 A record of the thickness of wearing course, base course and sub-base measured at the
locations where the samples are extracted.

4.2 Photographs showing the samples at each location during extraction.

4.3 Photographs showing the road after reinstatement.

4.4 Test results be endorsed by the SAC/SINGLAS Laboratory supervisor and a PE.

4.5 For road test for Asphaltic Concrete Mixes, the accredited laboratory certified by the PSB
has to compute the Deduction Factor (a factor used to determine whether the asphaltic
concrete used falls within the acceptable limit) and reflect it in the individual sample test
result and provide a summary of computation of laboratory test results for all the samples.

5. The LTA's road testing requirement is applicable for roads designed to LTA standard under
Section 18 of the Streets Work Act and in addition to other testing requirements specified in the
Specifications.

CE21/S2.DOC(67)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 2-68

2.101 NPARKS’S REQUIREMENTS FOR HANDING OVER OF GREENERY AND TREES MAINTENANCE
TO NPARKS

(A) HANDING OVER OF GREENERY (TURF AND TREES) MAINTENANCE TO NPARKS

(i) A list and description of the Land / TOL Land / Premises to be handed over to NParks,
identifying all areas with the Greenery that is to be handed over to NParks for Greenery
Maintenance;

(ii) A map or maps in GIS format and layer, as the case may be, showing (1) the boundaries of
the Land / TOL Land / Premises clearly marked out and demarcated; and (2) the trees to be
managed and maintained by NParks clearly marked and identified (the “Map”);

(iii) An inventory of trees within the Land / TOL Land / Premises containing at least the following
information:

(1) total number of trees on the land / TOL land / Premises;


(2) scientific name of each tree;
(3) girth size of each tree; and
(4) the individual unique tree identification number for each tree in the Land / TOL Land /
Premises.

Where the Land / TOL Land / Premises comprises forested land, the aforementioned
information contained in the inventory will only be required for trees growing within 50m from
any footpath, public road, or building;

(iv) The Contractor shall engage the services of Certified Arborists to perform the inventorisation
of all trees within the Land / TOL Land / Premises / any other sites / area within contract
boundary that to be handed over to NParks for management and maintenance.

(v) A copy of all maintenance records of the Greenery shall be submitted to NParks.

SECTION 3/.....

CE21/S2.DOC(68)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-1

SECTION 3

CONSTRUCTION AND WORKMANSHIP FOR ROADS AND DRAINS

3.1 SEQUENCE OF CONSTRUCTION

Commence construction of the road work with the excavation for and construction of stormwater drains
commencing at their outfalls. Excavation for and construction of roads shall not commence until the
construction of stormwater drains is sufficiently advanced in the opinion of the SO Rep to permit free
drainage of the road formation.

3.2 GENERAL REQUIREMENTS OF DRAINAGE DEPARTMENT, PUB

The Contractor's attention is drawn to the following general requirements of Drainage Department, PUB,
failure to comply with these requirements may render him liable to prosecution under the Water Pollution
Control and Drainage Act :

(a) The execution of any work shall not change, disrupt, fill, block or disturb the existing overland
flow or the existing system of drains unless an alternative approved drainage system has been
provided and permission for use has been given by the Drainage Department, PUB.

(b) Close turf all earth slopes adjacent to any drain.

(c) Obstruction of any kind shall not be placed, laid or erected within drainage reserves and drains
both of which shall remain accessible at all times.

(d) No temporary structures such as cofferdams, crossings, stagings, etc shall be constructed in or
over an existing drain without the prior approval of the Drainage Department, PUB.

(e) Remove any temporary structures if approved within the drainage reserve immediately on
Substantial Completion.

(f) Bunds of stockpiled earth from trench work shall not be longer than 10m long and gaps of at
least 1 m wide shall be provided between the bunds to allow the free flow of surface runoff.

(g) Material from any stockpile shall not be allowed to fall or be washed into drain. Adequate
preventive measures, including the provision of proper and stable barricades or screens where
necessary, shall be provided.

(h) Scupper inlets shall not be blocked by excavated or stockpiled material.

(i) Drains shall not be covered without the approval of the Drainage Department, PUB.

(j) Report any damage to existing drains arising out of any work immediately to the Drainage
Department, PUB. Any obstruction to flow arising from the damage shall be immediately and
completely cleared, and repair & reconstruct the damaged drain to the requirement of the
Drainage Department, PUB.

(k) Reclamation work, earthwork, roadwork, development work or any other construction work shall
not be carried out unless a system of temporary lined perimeter cut-off drains and silt traps or
other approved alternative measures are provided to prevent overflowing of surface runoff and
silt from the work Site to the drains and adjacent premises.

(l) Desilt and maintain regularly all temporary lined perimeter cut-off drains and silt traps to ensure
that the discharge from the silt trap is free of silt.

CE21/S3.DOC(1)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-2

3.3 ADDITIONAL REQUIREMENTS OF DRAINAGE DEPARTMENT, PUB

Ensure and take all necessary precautions and actions for preventing silt from being washed into drains
and canals and comply with the following requirements strictly :

(a) Treatment Of Silt-laden Water

Ensure that silt-laden water is not discharged directly or by pumping into drains or canals.
Channel the silt-laden water to silt traps, sedimentation tanks or other measures for removal of
silt before discharging into drains or canals.

(b) Provision Of Silt Traps And Perimeter Cut-Off Drains

(i) Provide silt traps, perimeter cut-off drains and other facilities to ensure that earth, silt,
mud, etc are not discharged into drains or canals. Details of these facilities shall be duly
designed and endorsed by a Professional Engineer. Construct these facilities before the
commencement of the Works.

(ii) Desilt silt traps, perimeter cut-off drains and other facilities and maintain at least once a
week or more often if necessary to effectively prevent the discharge of silt from the work
Site.

(c) Protection Of Exposed Earth Surfaces

Carry out close turfing promptly to prevent soil erosion at the Site. Plant all exposed earth
surfaces not affected by construction activities with turfing on an immediate basis. Where
necessary to prevent soil erosion effectively, carry out progressive turfing on the Site. In cases
where turfing is not practical or not effective in protecting exposed earth surfaces which are left
bare and undisturbed for more than one month, protect such surfaces from soil erosion by
spraying with bitumen based emulsion or other effective methods to be approved by the SO Rep.
Notwithstanding the approval of the SO Rep, ensure that the methods are effective in the
prevention of soil erosion.

(d) Excavated Material

(i) Cart away all surplus excavated materials to own disposal ground immediately. The
surplus excavated material shall not be stockpiled on the Site.

(ii) Earth materials stockpiled on the Site for construction Works shall be within properly
contained areas and covered to prevent the earth from washing into drains or canals. The
locations for stockpiling the earth shall be subject to approval by the SO Rep.
Notwithstanding the approval of the SO Rep, the Contractor shall ensure that earth is not
washed into drains or canals.

(iii) Only carry out trench excavation work as the rate of construction keeps pace with the rate
of excavation.

(e) Treatment Of Mud Slurry

Ensure that mud slurry from drilling, tunnelling, diaphragm wall construction and jet grouting, etc.
is not discharged into drains or canals.

3.4 EXCAVATION

Carry out the excavation in accordance with Clauses 2.5 to 2.8 (inclusive) of the Specifications.

3.5 PIPE CONDUIT DRAINS

Excavation of trenches shall be to straight lines and gradients required for the pipes and beds as
specified. The trench bottom shall be of sufficient width to allow adequate working space but beyond
these requirements, the width shall be kept to a minimum.

CE21/S3.DOC(2)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-3

3.5 PIPE CONDUIT DRAINS (CONT'D)

Maintain the setting out of sufficient length of pipe lines in advance of pipe laying and carry out such
exploratory excavation as may be necessary.

For lengths of pipelines, which are curved in plan, the curve shall be obtained by deflecting the pipes at
each joint. Set the inverts of the drains by wooden pegs with the help of boning rod or other means at
regular intervals of not more than 5 metres. Thoroughly compact the bedding for the pipes and lay the
pipes evenly on the barrel at the required level. There shall be no hollows, voids or foreign material
under the pipe. Take particular care to ensure that proper bedding is obtained at either side of the pipe
joints.

When concrete bed foundation is specified it shall consists of concrete or reinforced concrete as shown
in details on the Drawings.

In all cases, well ram or vibrate and work the concrete under and around the pipes. No concrete shall
be placed around the pipes until the pipe joints have been inspected and approved.

At approximately every four pipes or 6 metre length whichever is the lesser interval, form a joint in the
concrete bed or surround by vertically shuttering the bed or surround with 25mm thick fibreboard, timber
or other approved material. The shuttering material shall be left in to form a permanent joint. Where
the concrete bed is required to be reinforced all reinforcement shall stop on either side of the joint.

At every point of loading, or unloading, handle pipes or castings by approved lifting tackle. Do not
unload by roll down planks or any other form of inclined ramp unless the consent of the SO Rep has
been obtained. Carefully stacked pipes on the Site with timber packings under and between the pipes.
Where pipes are stacked, the height shall not exceed 2m.

All pipes shall be carefully brushed out inside and shall be tested for soundness before being laid. Lay
the pipes separately to true inverts, straight lines and falls, each pipe being separately boned between
sight rails and bearing evenly upon the solid ground or concrete for its full length.

Where pipes are laid without a concrete bed, cut holes in the bottom of the trench of such size and
depth so as to allow the joints to be properly made and the barrel of the pipe to bear evenly on the solid
ground for its full length.

Where pipes are to be laid on rock formation, take the excavation down to 100mm below bed level and
take great care to ensure that there are no projecting pieces of rock on which the pipe will ride. Make
up the bed to its true line and level and refill with either 100mm of consolidated, selected material from
the excavations, well rammed, and watered if necessary or with 100mm of grade 15 concrete as
directed by the SO Rep.

Ensure that all blocks and wedges are of sufficient size and strength to prevent settlement of the pipes.

Push home each well positioned concrete pipe with rebated joint into the previously laid pipe by means
of uniformly applied pressure. Then carry out jointing by filling the opening at the joint with cement
mortar and finish off flush.

Gauge mortar for jointing pipes and precast concrete units in the proportions of one part of cement to
three parts of sand.

Mix cement mortar in small quantities sufficiently only for 30 minutes work and do not remix or work up
again after setting or hardening; any mortar that has become set or hard shall be rejected and removed
from the Works.

In the event of pipes being fractured after being to all appearances properly laid whether due to
imperfect beds having been formed or the material for refilling having been improperly selected or to
any other cause, the Contractor in every instance, shall be held responsible and shall be called upon to
replace such defective pipes, if such Defect appears before the expiry of the Defects Liability Period.

CE21/S3.DOC(3)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-4

3.6 CULVERTS AND PROTECTIVE COATING TO INNER WALL

Construct pipe culverts of precast reinforced concrete pipes as specified herein all in accordance with
the Drawings.

Lay and joint pipes as described in Clauses 2.70 "Pipe Laying" and 2.73 "Jointing Concrete Pipes".

Where box culverts are to be cast-in-situ reinforced concrete, Construct them in accordance with
Clause 2.39 "Concrete" and to the approval of the SO Rep. For box culverts within the road reserve to
be handed over to LTA for maintenance, protective coating to inner walls of the culverts is required.
The protective coating shall contain Alkylalkoxy silane component. When the concrete has been
properly cured, the water repellent but vapour permeable coating shall be applied to its surface. The
protective coatings shall be capable of resisting the ingress of water and aggressive atmosphere
influences including chloride ions, carbon dioxide and sulphur dioxide in accordance with the
specification and as directed by the SO Rep.

When applied outside shelter, the protective coating shall have resistance against heat and ultra violet
ray.

The Contractor shall submit details of all proprietary materials for the protective coating to the Client for
acceptance. The Contractor shall submit proven track record and relevant test data of the proposed
material used in any country with weather condition that is similar to Singapore. The proposed material
shall comply with this specification.

All approved proprietary materials shall be used strictly in accordance with the manufacturers'
recommendations.

Protective coating used shall comply with the following standards :

BS Date Title
3177 1959(1995) Method for determining the permeability to water vapour
of flexible sheet materials used for packaging.

3900:Part C5 1992 Method of test for paints.

EN 2431 1995 Ethylene-propylene rubber (EPM / EPDM).


Hardness 80 IRHD.

EN 24624 1993 Paints and Varnishes Pull off test.

ASTM Date Title


D4138` 1982 Standard method of measurement of dry film thickness
of protective coating systems by destructive means.

E96-94 "Water Vapour Transmission of Materials".

The Contractor shall submit the testing reports when directed by the SO Rep. All the cost and expense
incurred in testing shall be borne by the Contractor.

3.7 BACKFILLING FOR CULVERTS

When backfilling the excavation after the completion of the culvert, carefully place the quarry dust, in
layers of not more than 600mm deep; each layer shall be thoroughly rammed and watered to achieve
adequate compaction and consolidation.

Note carefully that proper backfilling of trenches shall be required and measures shall be taken as may
be necessary to enforce compliance with this Clause.

Maintain all backfilled surfaces including existing roads until they are completely reinstated.

CE21/S3.DOC(4)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-5

3.8 FILL ADJACENT TO BRIDGE ABUTMENTS, CULVERTS AND RETAINING WALLS

Before backfilling, place a filter drain against weepholes in all structures. The filter drain shall consist
of clean, hard and durable broken stones or hardcore. The large stones shall be placed adjacent to the
weepholes and the smaller particles behind and above the larger particles.

Extend the length of the filter drain horizontally throughout the whole width of the structures or as shown
in the Drawings. Unless otherwise stated, it shall have a width of 300mm and shall vertically cover the
weephole by at least 300mm.

Place granular material adjacent to all structures in accordance with Table 3.1. Other approved
materials may be used as backfill outside the limits as specified in the same Table.

Table 3.1 Fill Adjacent To Abutments, Culverts And Retaining Walls


Structure Minimum Width Of Granular Fill Material
Bridge abutment & wingwalls 2.0 m
Culvert wingwalls H/3
Retaining walls H/3
Barrels of box culverts H/3
Barrels of pipe culverts H
where H = height of structure

Place backfill in horizontal layers of thickness appropriate to the compacting plant used. Compact
backfill with care to the required density but avoid excessive compaction.

For framed structures, bringing fill at both ends of the structure up simultaneously and equally, with the
difference in levels of fills at both ends limited to 600mm.

No fill shall be placed against concrete structures within 21 days after placing the concrete unless the
Contractor has provided sufficient supports to the walls to the approval of the SO Rep.

The supply, filling and compaction of the granular material shall form part of the Contract and the
Contractor shall allow for such Works in the Contract Sum.

3.9 COFFERDAMS

Any proposal for cofferdams shall not be implemented without the prior written approval of the SO Rep.
The proposal shall include the method of construction, materials used, width, height, length and location
of the cofferdams.

3.10 PREPARATION OF ROAD FORMATION

Where the bearing capacity of the soil is determined by the SO Rep as adequate and where the road
is in cut, carry out excavations to the required levels as required by the thickness of construction and
the levels of the finished road. Excavate the formation to the required level of the camber or cross-fall
shown for the finished road and trim to an even surface. Thoroughly roll the formation with 10 tonne
rollers or similar equipment until thoroughly compacted.

Where the road is on previously filled ground or where excavation has to be carried deeper than normal
formation level on account of weakness in the subsoil as may be shown on the Drawings or determined
by the SO Rep during the progress of the work, bring up the formation to the correct level with filling as
specified in Clause 5.5 "Filling Generally".

Properly compact such filling up to formation level by rolling successively with compaction equipments
as detailed in Clause 5.9 "Compaction" and bring to proper shape and camber as is the case of the
formation where the road is in cut.

CE21/S3.DOC(5)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-6

3.10 PREPARATION OF ROAD FORMATION (CONT'D)

Trim off all high spots and reconsolidate the section. Should any depressions appear in the formation
during compaction, fill in, level and compact with material as specified, before crusher run laying can
commence.

The SO Rep may require fill materials to be tested by an SAC accredited laboratory in accordance with
BS 1377 to determine its maximum dry density and optimum moisture content for compaction. One
test will be conducted to determine the maximum dry density and optimum moisture content for each
class of material to be compacted.

Maintain the moisture content of the in-situ material during compaction as close to the optimum moisture
content as possible. If necessary, this shall be adjusted by wetting or drying on the Site to enable the
required in-situ field densities of the fill material to be obtained consistently.

Following the compaction process, carry out in-situ field density tests in accordance with BS 1377:1990
Test No. 15(A) (Sand Replacement Method) or Test No. 15(F) (Water Displacement Method). The in-
situ field density may also be determined using nuclear density meters. At least one in-situ field test
shall be made for every 300 m2 of surface area of each compacted layer.

Obtain the following in-situ field densities of compacted materials given as percentage of the maximum
dry density derived from BS 1377 Test No. 13 (4.5kg rammer) :

(a) Within 500mm of formation level (sub-grade or foundation)


- 95% of maximum dry density

(b) From 500mm below formation level


- 90% of maximum dry density

The Contractor may choose to establish by site trials the relationship among the in-situ material for
compaction, compaction plant used, thickness for each layer, and compacting effort in terms of number
of passes. If so established and agreed by the SO Rep the Contractor shall allow the same compaction
arrangement for each and every subsequent layers in compaction. However, the SO Rep may at any
time carry out in-situ field density tests to determine whether the degree of compaction is satisfactory.

The agreed compaction arrangement as mentioned above shall be adjusted when the compaction is
found inadequate.

3.11 SUB-GRADE OF CARRIAGEWAY

(a) Sub-grade Formation

In addition to Clause 3.10 "Preparation Of Road Formation", trim the finished level of sub-grade
along the road centre-line and finish to the lines, grades and cross-sections as shown on the
Drawings.

On straight lengths of roads, trim the sub-grade to a cross-fall as shown in the Drawings on each
side of the road's centre-line. Where the alignment is curved the cross-fall of the sub-grade shall
be the same as that of the pavement on both super-elevations and transitions.

Trim the sub-grade so that the level does not vary more than 25mm above or 50mm below the
levels shown on the Drawings.

(b) Sub-grade Material

Fill material for the last 500mm of the sub-grade shall be the best selected material which shall
have a soaked CBR (California Bearing Ratio) value of not less than the value shown on the
Drawings or the Specifications or given by the SO Rep in writing.

In cut or natural ground where the soaked CBR value of the last 500mm of sub-grade material
is less than the required minimum value and if directed in writing, remove 500mm of this material
and replace it with an approved selected fill material which conforms to the minimum value
required at the Contractor's cost and expense.

Compact the last 500mm of the sub-grade material in layers not exceeding 150mm to the
required density given below.

CE21/S3.DOC(6)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-7

3.11 SUB-GRADE OF CARRIAGEWAY (CONT'D)

(c) Compaction Of Sub-Grade

Carry out compaction of the sub-grade by mechanical means using the approved type of
compaction equipment such as smooth-wheel roller, tamping roller, pneumatic typed roller and
vibrating smooth drum roller, to the required density as specified in Clause 5.9 "Compaction".
For undisturbed natural ground, compaction shall be the required dry density for a depth of not
less than 200mm.

Compact the last 500mm layer of sub-grade material below the level of the granite base course
to a density as shown in the Drawings or the Specifications.

The location of the samples and the field measurement of the dry density of the compacted
material shall be carried out in-situ with a standard instrument approved by the SO Rep.

At the time of compaction of each layer, adjust the moisture content of the material by spraying
water uniformly or allowing the material to dry out sufficiently to obtain the required compaction.

No base course material shall be laid on the carriageway until the sub-grade has been approved
by the SO Rep. Any material laid on the sub-grade before the sub-grade has been approved by
the SO Rep shall be removed from the Site, if directed by the SO Rep.

The location where test is required shall be determined and approved by the SO Rep. The
laboratory test shall be carried out at an SAC accredited laboratory.

During construction, the SO Rep may take samples from the compacted sub-grade for CBR
tests, the location of which shall be determined by the SO Rep depending on the uniformity of
the soil type encountered. The number of samples to be taken shall be at a rate of one sample
for every 50m of carriageway or 500 m2 of carpark area subject to a minimum of 3 samples.
However, if the soaked CBR values fail to achieve the standard required, further tests shall be
carried out.

(d) Improved Sub-grade Course Of Carriageway

No sub-grade material or granite base material shall be laid on the carriageway until the sub-
grade has been approved by the SO Rep for the laying of the improved sub-grade or base course
materials.

Unless specified otherwise, the thickness of the base and sub-base course shown in the
Drawings shall be the compacted thickness.

3.12 CONCRETE HAUNCHED UPVC SCUPPER DRAINS

Concrete haunch 250mm diameter upvc pipe to SS272 (with no joint) and lay within the side-tables to
the details shown on the Drawings.

Provide drop inlets to the details shown in the Drawings and the connection to the scupper pipes/drains
neatly joint in cement mortar.

3.13 ROADSIDE KERBS, CHANNELS, ETC

All precast concrete roadside kerb channels (gutters), dividers and drain channels shall comply with BS
EN 1339 and/or SS 214:1979. Set the kerbs, dividers etc in cement mortar on a bed of concrete and
haunched with concrete all as shown on the Drawings. Great care shall be taken to ensure the trueness
of the line and level of the kerbs. Trim, cut or cast end units squarely to suit required dimensions.

The composite and other drain channels shall conform entirely to the shape and dimensions shown in
the Drawings.

All joints between kerb units shall be pointed in 1:3 cement-sand mortar and of a uniform thickness of
20mm unless site condition requires otherwise.

Cast the kerbs to the necessary radii to suit sharp curves on plan and the required proportion shall have
shaped insets to suit the entrances to scupper drains.

CE21/S3.DOC(7)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-8

3.14 CRUSHER RUN BASE COURSE

Crusher run material shall consist of hard, clean, durable, and angular aggregate with a nominal size of
100mm and maximum size of not more than 125mm.

If the required compacted depth of the base course exceeds 150mm, construct the base in two or more
layers of approximately equal thickness compacted and blinded as specified or indicated in the
Drawings. The maximum compacted thickness of any layer shall not exceed 150mm irrespective of the
type of compacting equipment employed.

Mechanically spread the crushed granite or by any other means approved by the SO Rep to a uniform
thickness.

Roll each layer of the crushed granite base course with a smooth steel wheeled roller of at least
10 tonnes until a uniform surface is attained. Spread 20mm granite aggregate and brush into the
surface voids and rolling shall continue until a smooth and uniform surface is attained and there is no
movement in the crushed granite layers. Begin rolling at the sides and progress gradually towards the
centre parallel to the longitudinal axis of the road, with a uniform over-lap of each succeeding trip of the
roller. Make good irregularities of the compacted crusher run layer before the next course is laid.

Blind the surface of each layer with granite dust or an approved blinding material. Brush these blinding
materials into the interstices of the granite base course and water with a watering cart. Roll and water
the whole surface sweep and roll repeatedly until all the interstices in the granite base course have
been filled and the granite base course forms a dense and compact layer.

On completion the surface of the base course shall present a smooth and compact appearance, true to
levels and camber or cross-fall and shall be sufficiently water-bound to withstand traffic.

3.15 PLANT MIXED CRUSHED GRANITE AGGREGATE BASE COURSE

All crushed granite base course shall consist of graded crushed, clean and hard angular aggregate.
The grading of the materials is as shown in Table 3.2 below :

Table 3.2 Grading Requirements For Plant Mixed Crushed Granite Base Course

BS Sieve Size % Passing (by weight)

50 mm 100
38.0 mm 95 to 100
19.0 mm 60 to 80
9.5 mm 40 to 60
4.8 mm 25 to 45
2.4 mm 15 to 35
425 Φm 6 to 18
75 Φm 0 to 10

Mix the aggregates at a mixing plant by continuous mixing using a pug-mill mixer, or batch type mixing
using a revolving blade, rotary pan, or rotary tilting drum mixer. The plant shall be in sound mechanical
condition and shall consistently produce a uniform mixture or aggregates and water at optimum
moisture content or at a moisture content as directed by the SO Rep.

To achieve the desired grading, the use of any sand, granite dust or approved filler such as laterite, the
quality of such materials and the amount to be added into the mixing plant shall be subject to the
approval of the SO Rep.

Water used for mixing shall be clean and substantially free from detrimental impurities such as oil, salts,
acids, alkali and vegetable substance.

The method of loading and unloading of material shall be such that segregation shall be minimised.
Remove from the Site material which does not comply with the Specifications.

CE21/S3.DOC(8)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-9

3.15 PLANT MIXED CRUSHED GRANITE AGGREGATE BASE COURSE (CONT'D)

During delivery, cover the material with canvas, or other approved material to prevent loss of moisture
during transport. Vehicles used for delivery of material to the hoppers of spreading machines shall have
bodies or discharge equipment which shall enable the load to be discharged direct into hopper without
spillage and in such a way that segregation shall be minimised.

The Contractor is required to furnish information on the following :

(a) Date and time of loading


(b) The name of the supplier
(c) The registered number of the vehicle
(d) The nature and source of the material

The record book shall be kept by the SO Rep on the Site.

Spreading of the pavement material shall not commence without the prior consent of the SO Rep.
Complete spreading within 3 hours of the time of loading the delivery vehicle.

Spread the whole of the mixture by an approved self propelled mechanical spreader with an automatic
tamping device. Each layer shall be spread in an uniform layer not exceeding 200mm consolidated
thick.

After the final rolling which shall be carried out with a self propelled steel-wheeled roller of at least 12
tonnes in weight, the whole surface shall then be allowed to "cure" by opening the carriageway to traffic
for a period of at least two weeks or longer if required by the SO Rep.

When used in a pavement which is not to carry a bituminous surfacing, that portion of the material which
will pass a 425 Φm sieve shall have the following properties :

Liquid Limit - not more than 25%


Plasticity Index - not more than 6%
Linear Shrinkage - not more than 3%

The sand equivalent of the material passing the 4.8mm sieve shall not be less than 30.

When used in a pavement which is to carry a bituminous surfacing, the portion of the material which
will pass a 425 Φm sieve shall have the following properties :

Liquid Limit - not more than 35%


Plasticity Index - between 4 and 9%
Linear Shrinkage - between 2 and 4%

3.16 PREMIX BITUMINOUS SURFACING

(a) General

Where indicated in the Drawings or where directed, lay the road with hot Asphalt Premix
Surfacing to a consolidated thickness of either 25mm, 50mm or thicker as shown in the Drawings
and as detailed below.

The Works under these clause and sub-clauses shall include the following :

(i) Sweeping and brushing surface prior to applying tack coats or asphalt surfacing.
(ii) Supply and application of suitable tack coats wherever required.
(iii) Supply and unloading of hot mix asphalt paving mixes as directed.
(iv) Supply, lay by mechanical spreader/finisher, and rolling and finishing of hot mix
asphalt paving mixes.

On receipt of instructions from the SO Rep, the Contractor shall proceed promptly with such work
within 48 hours. Carry out the Works continuously and complete within such time as is specified
by the SO Rep, having due regard to the output capacity of the Contractor's mixing plant and
allowing for unavoidable lost time because of any inclement weather during the course of such
Works.

CE21/S3.DOC(9)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-10

3.16 PREMIX BITUMINOUS SURFACING (CONT'D)

(b) Materials

All bitumen supplied shall comply with SS 84 and SS 85 and shall be approved type asphaltic
bitumen of either 60/70 penetration and/or 80/100 penetration, as directed by the SO Rep
(measured at 25ΕC in both cases). All bitumen shall be straight-run bitumen prepared only by
the refining of asphaltic-base petroleum and such refining shall not involve the "cracking
process". No mineral matter other than that naturally contained in such bitumen shall be present.
The bitumen shall be of uniform quality, free from water and shall not foam when heated to
175ΕC. When required by the SO Rep, submit all necessary information on the country of origin
of all bitumen supplied, and the price paid for such bitumen, all at the Contractor's cost and
expense prior to its use in the Works.

Test for the properties of bitumen shall be carried out whenever required in accordance with the
methods set out in SS 86.

Mineral Filler shall consist of crushed rock fines, Portland Cement to SS 26 and/or granite fines
of appropriate grading. At least 85% of cement filler shall pass BS Sieve No. 200 and the filler
shall be thoroughly dry and shall be free from organic matter and clay particles.

Fine Aggregate shall consist of approved clean well-graded granite fines produced in a
secondary crushing plant, or approved clean natural sand properly washed free from all
impurities. Fine aggregate shall be taken as materials mainly passing a BS Sieve 4.76mm and
retained on BS Sieve No. 200.

Coarse Aggregate shall consist of clean, well-graded, angular, crushed granite of approved
quality free from dust, dirt, and/or deleterious materials, and free from excess of flat, elongated
or weathered pieces. Coarse aggregate shall be taken as material mainly retained on BS Sieve
4.76mm.

(c) Rollers

Rolling equipment shall, consist of steel wheel and pneumatic type rollers.

Steel Wheel Rollers shall be of the following types unless otherwise approved by the SO Rep:

(i) three-wheel rollers of 10 to 12 tonnes in weight.


(ii) two-axle tandem rollers of 8 to 12 tonnes in weight.

These rollers shall, under working conditions, develop a compression in the rear-wheels of 44 N
per mm to 59 N per mm of roll width. Rollers shall be in good working condition and be free from
backlash, faulty steering mechanism, or worn parts. Rollers shall be equipped with adjustable
scrappers to keep the rollers clean and with efficient means of keeping the wheels wet to prevent
mixes from sticking to the rolls. Rollers shall also be free of flat areas, openings or projections
which will mar the surface of the pavement.

Pneumatic Tyre Rollers shall be self-propelled or towed type, single or double-axle, having an
effective rolling width of not less than 1.2 metres. The rollers shall be equipped with smooth-
thread pneumatic tyres of equal size and diameter. The wheels of the roller shall be so spaced
that two passes of a single-axle roller or one pass of a two-axle roller shall accomplish one
complete coverage equal to the rolling width of the machine. There shall be a minimum of 7mm
over-lap of the tracking wheels of a double axle roller. The wheels shall not wobble. The roller
shall be uniform for all wheels. Pneumatic-tyred rollers shall be constructed with ample ballast
space to provide an operating weight per tyre of between 54 to 76 N per mm of tyre track width.
The total operating weight of the roller may be varied by the SO Rep. The towing vehicle for
towed-typed rollers shall be equipped with smooth-thread pneumatic tyres.

(d) Preparation of Area to be Paved

The area to be paved shall be true to line and grade, having a dry and properly prepared surface
prior to the start of paving operations. It shall be brushed until the stone aggregate surfaces are
exposed and the whole area shall be swept free of all excess granite dust or blinding material
and other loose chippings or foreign material.

Patch or correct all depressions and other irregularities to the complete satisfaction of the
SO Rep.

CE21/S3.DOC(10)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-11

3.16 PREMIX BITUMINOUS SURFACING (CONT'D)

(d) Preparation of Area to be Paved (Cont’d)

Apply a tack coat complying with SS 85 on the prepared crushed stone base before the Hot
Asphalt premix surfacing is laid. The rate of application of the tack coat shall be 0.55 litre per
m2.

Paint the surface of kerbs, gutters, vertical faces of existing pavements and all structures in
actual contact with the asphalt mixes with a thin uniform coating of approved bituminous
emulsion complying with SS 85 to provide a closed bonded watertight joint.

(e) Tack Coat

Supply and lay a suitable tack coat of cationic emulsion of 40% bitumen content as directed, to
any surface, prior to the spreading of the asphalt thereon, and after such surface has been
thoroughly cleaned and dried.

Apply the bitumen emulsion by means of an approved type of mechanical sprayer only, and at
the specified rate of application uniformly. Remove any excess or unevenly distributed bitumen
from the road surface.

The bitumen emulsion shall be allowed a period of 10 minutes "to break" before laying premix
over it.

(f) Asphalt Mixing & Delivery

Furnish the SO Rep in advance with full details of all asphalt mixing plant to be used, including
average output capacity, type, age, maintenance facilities and all other relevant particulars
whenever required by the SO Rep. The mixing plant to be used shall have an output capacity of
not less than 50 tonnes per hour.

The appropriate mix required for each work shall be in accordance with the Table of Mix as
specified in subclause 3.16(n) "Table of Mixes" of the Specifications. Wherever considered
advisable, the SO Rep may vary the specified proportions of coarse and fine aggregate within a
range of ±10% and there shall be no cost adjustment to the Contract Sum.

The SO Rep may vary the percentage of filler to be used, within a range of 2% and there shall
be no cost adjustment to the Contract Sum.

The SO Rep may likewise vary the percentage of bitumen to be used, whereupon the price paid
for the work shall be adjusted by him in accordance with the change in bitumen content ordered,
based only on the nett purchase price paid by the Contractor for the bitumen being used. If this
price is greater than the ruling nett purchase price of bitumen at the time of the variation, then
the latter price shall be adopted for the purpose of calculating the value of any such variation.

Thoroughly dry all aggregate of the requisite sizes and grading and feed at a temperature of
149ΕC to 190ΕC into a mechanical mixer of approved type. Install an accurate registering
pyrometer at a suitable point at the discharge end of the drier with a registering device so located
as to indicate clearly the temperature of the coarse and fine aggregate when discharged.

Heat the bitumen in an approved type boiler, to a temperature of 136ΕC to 163ΕC, and thereafter
add, together with the required proportion of filler, to the coarse and fine aggregate, and all
ingredients thoroughly and effectively mixed together until complete coating of all aggregate and
filler with the bitumen has been achieved. The SO Rep shall have access at all times to the
asphalt mixing plant and shall at liberty take such samples of materials as considered necessary
from time to time to verify the proper operation thereof.

It is particularly important to avoid excessive heating of the bitumen binder as this will lead to
hardening of the binder and result in a shortening of the useful life of the pavement. In all cases
keep temperatures as low as is consistent with proper mixing and laying.

CE21/S3.DOC(11)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-12

3.16 PREMIX BITUMINOUS SURFACING (CONT'D)

(f) Asphalt Mixing & Delivery (Cont’d)

Discharge the asphalt, after proper mixing, from the mixer direct into a tipping truck, for
transportation to the work Site. The temperatures of the mix on arrival at the work Site shall not
be less than 121ΕC. Cover asphalt in transit when required, with suitable canvas cover to
minimise heat loss. When required, provide an adequate number of accurate thermometers for
checking the temperature.

Vehicles used for transporting the asphalt shall be thoroughly cleaned, free of all foreign
materials immediately prior to loading with asphalt. The use of dirty or otherwise unsatisfactory
vehicles shall render the load(s) of asphalt liable to rejection.

(g) Spreading and Finishing

Furnish the SO Rep in advance with full details of the mechanical spreader/finisher to be used
whenever required by the SO Rep. The mechanical self-propelled spreader/finisher shall be
capable of laying an asphalt carpet of not less than three metre width, unless otherwise
permitted, and of being operated at varying rates of travel consistent with the rate of delivery and
the type of asphalt mixture to be laid.

On arrival at the Site, tip the asphalt mix into the hopper of the mechanical self-propelled
spreader/finisher and thereupon spread, level, tamp and finish to correct profile, camber or cross-
fall, without causing segregation, dragging, burning or other surface Defect or irregularities.
Follow the SO Rep instructions on the rate of travel of such machine at all times.

Operate the spreader at a uniform rate of travel and feed the mixer to the spreader at such a rate
as to permit continuous laying, in so far as the supply and site conditions allow.

The spreader/finisher shall not operate on any type of side forms, but shall employ mechanical
devices to adjust the grade and confine the edges of the asphalt to true lines. Immediately after
laying, and before rolling, check the surface with a straight edge of not less than 3.0 m and a
spirit level (both to be supplied by Contractor when required) to determine the proper crossfall or
camber required. Correct all irregularities and Defect in alignment, grade, texture, etc in an
approved manner.

The surface, after final rolling, when tested with a straight edge 3.0 m long placed parallel to the
centre line of the carriageway shall show no depression greater than 9mm. Carry out preliminary
rolling with steel wheel rollers of the type approved by the SO Rep as soon as the asphalt mix
has cooled sufficiently to support such roller without lateral flow of the mix. Carry out finishing
rolling with an 8 to 12 tonnes tandem roller or other suitable type of roller acceptable to the SO
Rep, as soon as practicable after the preliminary rolling, and proceed until no further compaction
of the asphalt can be obtained. All rolling shall proceed at a sufficiently slow speed so as to
avoid pushing or shoving of the asphalt carpet. The rollers shall not remain stationary on the
warm asphalt carpet for any appreciable length of time. Do not use oil on the wheels of any roller
to prevent adhesion of asphalt. Protect sections of newly compacted asphalt carpet from traffic
for at least six hours, or until properly hardened by cooling. The requirements of the SO Rep in
this matter shall be final.

Clean all manholes, kerbs, channels and other projections against which the asphalt mix is to be
laid, and apply a thin coating of bitumen emulsion applied prior to the laying of the asphalt.
Carefully tamp the mixture around and against all projections by means of mechanical tampers
and the finished surface left flush, or, if required, up to a maximum of 3mm above such projection.

Where existing manholes are lower than the new premixed surface, provide wooden frames to
demarcate its position during the process of the laying and premix, so that the manhole can be
raised subsequently by the respective service departments.

(h) Laying Hot Asphalt Premix

Lay all asphalt premix against a timber batten laid and pegged into the stone base along the
longitudinal joint if it is not laid against a kerb, gutter or against a paving. The battens shall be
of a thickness not less than the specified compacted thickness of the asphalt paving.
Immediately cut back all joints both longitudinal and transverse squarely prior to laying of further
asphalt in contact with such joints.

CE21/S3.DOC(12)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-13

3.16 PREMIX BITUMINOUS SURFACING (CONT'D)

(i) Compaction of Asphalt Premix

General

At least two rollers shall be required at all times and as many additional rollers as necessary to
provide specified pavement density. When plant production exceeds 75 tonnes per hour, at least
one additional roller shall be required for each additional 50 tonnes or fraction thereof.

During rolling, keep the roller wheels moist with only sufficient water to avoid picking up the
material.

After the longitudinal joints and edges have been compacted, start rolling longitudinally at the
sides and gradually progress towards the centre of the pavement, except on super-elevated
curves, begin rolling on the low side and progress to the high side. There shall be over-lapping
on successive trips by at least one-half the width on tandem rollers and uniformly lapping each
preceding track or covering the entire surface with the rear wheels where three-wheel rollers are
used.

The rollers shall move at a slow but uniform speed (not exceeding five kilometres per hour) with
the drive roller wheel nearest the paver. The line of rolling shall not be suddenly changed or the
direction or rolling suddenly reversed, thereby displacing the mix. If rolling causes displacement
of the materials, the affected areas shall be loosened at once and restored to the original grade
of the loose material before being re-rolled. Heavy equipment or rollers shall not be allowed to
stand on the finished surface until it has thoroughly cooled.

Rolling of the mix shall consist of six separate operations in the following order :

(i) transverse joints;


(ii) longitudinal joints;
(iii) edges;
(iv) initial or breakdown rolling;
(v) second rolling;
(vi) finish rolling

The edges shall not be exposed for more than fifteen minutes without being rolled. Particular
attention shall be given to the construction of transverse and longitudinal joints in both base and
wearing courses.

Transverse Joints

Carefully construct transverse Joints in both base and wearing course and thoroughly compact
to provide a smooth riding surface over these joints in the pavement. If the joint is formed with
a bulkhead, such as a board, to provide a straight line and vertical face, the joint face need not
be trimmed before fresh material is placed against it to complete the joint. If a bulkhead is not
used to form the joint and the roller is permitted to roll over the end of the new material, locate
the line of joint at the back of the rounded edge a sufficient distance to provide a true surface
and cross-section. Paint the joint with a thin coat of asphalt before fresh material is placed
against it. To obtain thorough compaction tightly crowd the joint against its vertical face. Continue
rolling until a thoroughly compacted neat joint is obtained.

Longitudinal Joints

Roll longitudinal joints directly behind the paving operation. The first lane placed shall be true to
line and grade and have a vertical face.

Tightly crowd the material being placed in the abutting lane against the vertical face of the
previously placed lane. Position the machine such that in spreading, the material overlaps the
edge of the lane previously placed by 25mm to 50mm and is sufficiently high to allow for
compaction. Before rolling, carefully move the material over-lapping the joint by brooming onto
the surface of the unrolled lane.

When rolling is accomplished with a three-wheel roller, shift over into the previously placed lane
so that no more than 150mm of the rear roller wheel rides on the edge of the fine material left by
brooming. Continue rolling until a thoroughly compacted, neat joint is obtained. If only tandem
rollers are used they shall be similarly operated to complete the joint.

When the abutting lane is not placed on the same day or the joint is distorted during the day's
work by traffic or by other means, carefully trim the edge of the lane to line and paint with a tack
coat of bitumen before the abutting lane is placed.

CE21/S3.DOC(13)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-14

3.16 PREMIX BITUMINOUS SURFACING (CONT'D)

(j) Density, Thickness and Surface Requirements

The completed pavement shall have a density equal to or greater than 95% of a laboratory
specimen made in the proportions of the approved job-mix formula and the Marshall test when
required.

Carefully control both density and thickness during construction and ensure they comply with the
approved plans, Drawings and the Specifications.

The checking of compacted thickness shall be carried out by the SO Rep by cutting test holes
after he is fully satisfied that the asphalt layer has been fully compacted. As a guide each test
hole shall be cut at 60 metres interval along each carriageway. Each test hole shall be 150mm
diameter and the average thickness of four readings shall be taken as the depth of the asphalt
at the test hole. Provide all the necessary labour and Construction Equipment for carrying out
both density and thickness tests including the reinstatement of the test holes.

Carry out tests for the densities of the asphalt base course and wearing course if required, using
an Automatic Asphalt Density Recorder or any other method which the SO Rep may approve.
The decision on whether or not the asphalt laid has been compacted to the required density shall
be made by the SO Rep based on the above tests and his decision shall be final. If the tests
carried out by the SO Rep show that the asphalt surface has not been compacted to the required
density the Contractor shall immediately continue to roll the asphalt layer until the SO Rep is
satisfied that the required density has been obtained.

In addition to the use of a straight edge to check the asphalt surface finish, when necessary, also
use a `Rolling Straight edge' to check for any surface irregularity.

The decision of the SO Rep on whether or not the asphalt surface has been finished to the
regularity required shall be final. Take immediate steps to rectify Defect as directed by the SO
Rep.

(k) Sampling & Testing

Samples of asphalt premix shall be taken as, when and where considered necessary, by the SO
Rep and testing shall, as far as practicable, be in accordance with SS 86 and BS 598.

The number of samples required to be tested shall be one sample for every 550m2 of
carpark/450m2 of roadway subject to a minimum of two samples.

Extract all test samples of 150mm diameter by coring method. The sampling and testing
processes shall be conducted by an SAC accredited laboratory.

Where test results are unsatisfactory, the SO Rep may condemn all the asphalt represented by
such unsatisfactory sample(s).

The Contractor or the Contractor's Representative may be present during the carrying out of any
tests, provided he has given one day's clear notice, on each occasion, of such intention.

The Contractor shall be responsible for the immediate reinstatement of all cored holes on the
road surface where samples have been extracted for testing purposes. Clean the cored holes
and dry before backfilling with hot asphalt premix which shall be kept at the required temperature.
Properly compact all reinstated cored holes in layers to achieve perfect match between the old
and new surfaces.

(l) Extraction Test

(i) Grading Analysis

All aggregates shall be well graded to conform to the proportions specified in the various
sieves and the grading curve of the mix shall fall within the approved design envelope
bounded curves demarcating the maximum and minimum limits.

Any grading falling outside these limits shall be considered as having failed the test and
the premix so represented by the sample shall be rejected. The Contractor shall be
required to accept the corrective measures including the payment of fees or charges as
required by the SO Rep or LTA.

CE21/S3.DOC(14)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-15

3.16 PREMIX BITUMINOUS SURFACING (CONT'D)

(l) Extraction Test (Cont’d)

(ii) Bitumen Content

The percentage (%) of soluble bitumen in the mix of any sample shall not be less than the
minimum percentage specified. Where any of the test samples fail to comply with the
requirement as specified, all the asphalt surfacing represented by such unsatisfactory
samples shall be rejected, and the Contractor shall be charged according to the
Maintenance Fees imposed by the SO Rep or LTA.

Where the bitumen content of any sample exceeds the maximum percentage specified,
the entire premix represented by the samples tests shall be rejected and similar
Maintenance Fees as specified shall also be imposed.

The average percentage of soluble bitumen of all the samples tested shall also be not
less than the average percentage specified. Similar Maintenance Fees as specified shall
be imposed for failure to comply.

(m) Marshall Test

Result of all Marshall tests of the premix samples if required, shall comply strictly with the under-
mentioned critical limits :

(i) Marshall stability (KN) - not less than 7.1 KN

(ii) Flow value - not more than 4.05mm

(iii) Voids in mix (%) : 3 to 5

(iv) Percentage of aggregate voids filled with bitumen binder - 75 to 82

As a guide, for the purpose of carrying out Marshall Tests, a set of minimum number of three
samples shall be taken for each 150 linear metre of each carriageway or part thereof of premix
laid. The samples shall be taken from positions as directed. Samples for Marshall Tests if
required, shall be taken in conjunction with Grading Analysis and Bitumen Test or taken
separately as directed.

(n) Table Of Mixes

Mix the premix bitumen in the proportions as shown on the attached Table of Mixes.

(o) Reinstatement Of Test Holes

Immediately reinstate all holes on the road surface where samples have been extracted for
testing purposes.

CE21/S3.DOC(15)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-16

TABLE OF MIXES

Mix Classification W1 & W2 W3 & W4 W5 & W6 B1 & B2

Type of Mix 20mm Wearing Course 25mm - 40mm Wearing 50mm Wearing Course Base or Binder Course
Course (Type "C") (Type "A") (Type "B")

Thickness of course (vary) 15mm to 20mm 25mm to 45mm 45mm to 64mm 50mm to 100mm

Max size of stone aggregate used 10mm 20mm 25mm 38mm

Sieve size Total Percentage Passing Including Filler

Passing 50 mm - - - -
38 mm - - - 100
25 mm - - 100 95 to 100
19 mm - 100 95 to 100 84 to 92
13 mm - 95 to 100 76 to 90 65 to 82
9.5 mm 100 - - -
6.4 mm 90 to 100 70 to 83 54 to 70 48 to 62
3.2 mm 65 to 82 50 to 65 39 to 55 35 to 50
1.2 mm (BS 14) 39 to 55 29 to 44 27 to 41 22 to 35
0.3 mm (BS 52) 22 to 32 15 to 24 15 to 22 12 to 19
0.075 mm (BS 200) 3 to 8 3 to 8 3 to 8 3 to 8

Mix Min Max Mix Min Max Mix Min Max Mix Min Max

% Soluble Bitumen (by weight of total mix)


60/70 penetration ) W1 5.5 6.5 W3 5.5 6.5 W5 5.5 6.5 B1 4.5 6.0
80/100 penetration ) W1 5.5 6.5 W4 5.5 6.5 W6 5.5 6.5 B2 4.5 6.0

Overall requirements :
% graded coarse aggregates retained on 3.2mm
BS Sieve (by wt of total aggregate & filler) 31 42 52 57

% graded fine aggregates passing 3.2mm BS


Sieve but retained on 0.075 (BS 200) Sieve (by
wt of total aggregate & filler) 63 52 43 39

% mineral filler passing BS 200 Sieve


(by wt of total aggregate & filler) 6 6 5 4

% Soluble Bitumen by weight of total mix 6 6 6 5

CE21/S3.DOC(16)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-17

TABLE OF MIXES

Mix Classification AI-IIIb AI-IVa AI-IVb AI-IVc AI-IId AI-IIe AI-IIId AI-IIIe AI-A AI-B

Type of Mix Wearing Wearing Wearing Wearing Base Course Base Course Base Course Base Course Skip Skip Gradation
Course Course Course Course Gradation

Thickness of 25mm to 20mm to 25mm to 45mm to 45mm to 50mm to 45mm to 50mm to 25mm to 50mm to
Course (vary) 45mm 45mm 45mm 64mm 64mm 100mm 75mm 100mm 45mm 100mm

Max size of stone


aggregate used 20mm 13mm 20mm 25mm 25mm 38mm 25mm 38mm 20mm 38mm

Sieve Size
Passing Total Percentage passing including filler

50 mm - - - - - - - - - -
38 mm - - - - - 100 - 100 - 100
25 mm - - - 100 100 70 to 100 100 75 to 100 - 95 to 100
19 mm 100 - 100 83 to 100 70 to 100 50 to 80 75 to 100 60 to 85 100 -
13 mm 75 to 100 100 80 to 100 - - - 61 to 82 50 to 71 95 to 100 60 to 80
9.5 mm 60 to 85 80 to 100 70 to 90 62 to 78 35 to 60 25 to 50 47 to 68 40 to 60 - -
4.75 mm 35 to 55 55 to 75 50 to 70 50 to 65 15 to 35 10 to 30 32 to 48 30 to 47 50 to 70 30 to 50
2.36 mm 20 to 35 35 to 50 35 to 50 35 to 50 5 to 20 5 to 20 20 to 35 20 to 35 30 to 50 20 to 40
600 Φm 10 to 22 18 to 29 18 to 29 19 to 30 - - 5 to 20 5 to 20 - -
300 Φm 6 to 16 13 to 23 13 to 23 13 to 23 - - 3 to 12 3 to 12 5 to 25 5 to 25
150 Φm 4 to 12 8 to 16 8 to 16 7 to 15 - - 2 to 8 2 to 8 - -
75 Φm 2 to 8 4 to 10 4 to 10 0 to 8 0 to 4 0 to 4 0 to 4 0 to 4 2 to 10 1 to 10

% Soluble Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Max
Bitumen
(60/70 4.5 5.5 4.5 5.5 4.5 5.5 4.5 5.5 3.5 5.0 3.5 5.0 3.5 5.0 3.5 5.0 4.5 5.5 4.5 5.5
Penetration
Grade)*
(% by weight of
total mix)

* When required 80/100 Penetration Grade Bitumen shall be used instead of 60/70 Penetration Grade Bitumen at the Contractor's
own cost and expense. No Claims for extra payment shall be allowed for using 80/100 Penetration Grade Bitumen.

CE21/S3.DOC(17)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-18
TABLE OF MIXES

Road Mixes

Mix Classification WSS W1 W3 B1 W5 W3B W5B

Type of Mix Wearing Course Binder Course Wearing Course

Thickness of Course 50 to 75 mm 15 to 25 mm 30 to 50 mm 50 to 100 mm 45 to 65 mm 45 to 65 mm 50 to 80 mm

Max. Size of Stone 19 mm 10 mm 19 mm 35 mm 25mm 19 mm 25 mm

(BS) Passing 50 mm - - - - - - -

37.5 mm - - - 100 - - -

25 mm - - - 95 to 100 100 - 100

19 mm 100 - 100 84 to 92 95 to 100 100 89 to 97

13.2 mm 80 to 90 - 90 to 100 65 to 82 76 to 90 85 to 95 73 to 83

9.5 mm 63 to 77 100 - - - - -

6.3 mm - 90 to 100 70 to 83 48 to 62 54 to 70 58 to 68 50 to 60

3.35 mm - 65 to 82 50 to 65 35 to 50 39 to 55 40 to 50 40 to 50

2.36 mm 46 to 56 - - - - - -

1.18 mm - 39 to 55 29 to 44 27 to 41 27 to 41 21 to 31 25 to 35

600 Φm 16 to 26 - - - - - -

300 Φm - 22 to 32 15 to 24 15 to 22 15 to 22 11 to 17 13 to 16

212 Φm 8 to 18 - - - - - -

75 Φm 6.5 to 10.5 3 to 8 3 to 8 3 to 8 3 to 8 4 to 8 4 to 8

% Soluble Bitumen (60/70 Penetration Grade)


(% by Wt of Total Mix) 5 ± 0.5 6 ± 0.5 6 ± 0.5 5 ± 0.5 5.5 ± 0.5 5 ± 0.5 4.8 ± 0.5

Void in Mix 3.0 to 5.0 4.5 to 6.5

*When required 80/100 Penetration Grade Bitumen shall be used instead of 60/70 Penetration Grade Bitumen at the Contractor's own cost and expense.
No Claims for extra payment shall be allowed for using 80/100 Penetration Grade Bitumen.

CE21/S3.DOC(18)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-19

3.17 INTERLOCKING CONCRETE PAVING BLOCKS

(a) General

The concrete blocks shall comply with the requirements of BS EN 1338, unless otherwise
specified.

The interlocking concrete paving blocks shall be precast, vibrocompacted blocks. The maximum
dimensional deviations from the standard work sizes for the paving blocks, measured in
accordance with BS 6717 : Part I or SS 76M, shall be as follows :

Length : ±2mm
Width : ±2mm
Thickness : ±3mm

Any pigment used shall comply with BS 1014.

(b) Sampling And Testing For Compressive Strength

A total of 16 concrete blocks shall be tested for each 550m2 of interlocking concrete pavement.

The average compressive strength of the paving blocks, tested in accordance with BS 6717 or
SS 76M, shall not be less than 49N per mm2, and the crushing strength of any individual block
shall be not less than 40N per mm2.

(c) Failure Of Test On Compressive Strength

The SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance & Irregularities" to impose
charges against the Contractor for :

(i) each batch of 16 concrete blocks for which the average compressive strength
is less than 49N per mm2; or
(ii) each individual block of which the compressive strength is less than 40N per mm2.

In addition, the consignment represented by the test sample shall be accepted only at the sole
discretion of the SO Rep, after he has considered the degree of failure and other related
circumstances. Any consignment rejected by the SO Rep shall be removed from the Site
immediately.

(d) Sampling And Checking Of Surface Layer Thickness In Composite Concrete Paving Blocks

Coloured concrete paving blocks formed by the addition of pigments may be either
homogeneous or non-homogeneous in colour. Non-homogeneous coloured concrete paving
blocks are considered as composite concrete paving blocks. In composite concrete paving
blocks, the coloured surface layer shall be formed as an integral part of the block and shall not
be less than 5mm thick.

A total of 5 composite concrete blocks shall be checked for surface layer thickness compliance
for each 550m2 of interlocking composite concrete pavement. The checking shall be carried out
at an SAC accredited laboratory.

Each concrete block to be checked shall be cut neatly at the mid-span of the length of the
composite concrete block, cutting of the blocks shall only be carried out at the accredited
laboratory. The average surface layer thickness of each composite block shall be derived from
the measured thickness at the left edge, middle and right edge of the surface layer thickness on
the cross-sectional face of the cut-off block. The thickness shall be measured by a caliper. The
measured thickness shall be to the nearest 0.1mm accuracy.

The Contractor shall ensure that the cut samples are collected back from the accredited
laboratory and returned to HDB for verification. These cut samples shall be kept at the site office
and only disposed off at the sole discretion of the SO Rep.

CE21/S3.DOC(19)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-20

3.17 INTERLOCKING CONCRETE PAVING BLOCKS (CONT'D)

(e) Failure To Comply With The Minimum Surface Layer Thickness Requirement In Composite
Concrete Paving Blocks

The SO Rep shall exercise its right under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose
charges against the Contractor for each composite concrete block for which the average surface
layer thickness is less than 5mm.

In addition, the consignment represented by the samples checked for surface layer thickness
compliances shall be accepted only at the sole discretion of the SO Rep, after he has considered
the degree of failure and other related circumstances. Any consignment rejected by the SO Rep
shall be removed from the Site immediately.

(f) Marking

Before laying, divide the paving blocks into consignments designated for each area of not more
than 550m2. A sample of 16 blocks shall be taken from each such consignment. In the case of
composite concrete paving blocks, an additional 5 blocks shall be taken from each such
assignment. Clearly mark the sample at the time of sampling in such a way that the consignments
represented by the sample are clearly defined.

(g) Inspection

Before commencing the placing of the sand bedding course and the laying of units, the sub-base
shall be inspected and approved by the SO Rep.

(h) Edge Restraints

Provide adequate edge restraint along the perimeter of all paving in the form of integral kerb and
gutter, concrete kerb or edge strip or established structure. The face of the edge restraint, where
it abuts paving units, shall be vertical down to the sub-base.

(i) Bedding Sand

(i) Material

Bedding sand shall be a well-graded sand passing a 4.75mm sieve and suited for concrete
manufacture. The grading limits are :

A.S. Sieve % Passing


9.52 mm 100
4.75 mm 95 to 100
2.36 mm 80 to 100
1.18 mm 50 to 85
600 Φm 25 to 60
300 Φm 10 to 30
150 Φm 5 to 15
75 Φm 0 to 10

The bedding sand shall be free of deleterious soluble salts or other contaminants likely to
cause efflorescence or lead to reduced skid resistance.

(ii) Moisture Content

The sand shall be of uniform moisture content when spread and shall be protected against
rain when stockpiled on the Site prior to spreading.

(iii) Spreading Bedding Sand

Spread the sand bedding loose and in a uniform layer. Determine the precise depth in
the field prior to spreading.

Screed the sand bedding in a loose condition to the nominated design profile and levels
plus the necessary surcharge to achieve a uniformly thick layer, following compaction to
the thickness specified in the Drawings.

CE21/S3.DOC(20)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-21

3.17 INTERLOCKING CONCRETE PAVING BLOCKS (CONT'D)

(i) Bedding Sand (Cont'd)

(iv) Screeding Of Bedding Sand

Carefully maintain the spread sand in a loose condition and protect against precompaction
both prior to and following screeding. Loosen any precompacted sand or screeded sand
left overnight before further paving units are placed. Lightly screed sand in a loose
condition to the predetermined depth only, slightly ahead of the laying of the paving units.
Under no circumstances shall the sand be screeded in advance of the laying face to an
extent to which paving will not be completed on that day.

Protect screeded sand against accidental precompaction including compaction by rain or


dew. Remove any screeded sand which is precompacted prior to laying of units and bring
back to profile in loose condition.

(j) Laying Of Paving Units

(i) General

Place paving units on the uncompacted screeded sand bedding to the nominated laying
pattern, care being taken to maintain the specified bond throughout the job. Place paving
units to achieve a positive gap of 3mm between the units. Under no circumstances shall
units be allowed to touch nor should the gap between units exceed 5 mm. Correctly place
all joints to suit the laying pattern and bond.

The first row shall abut an edge restraint with a gap of 2 to 4 mm and shall be laid at a
suitable angle to the edge restraint to achieve the required visual orientation of paving
units in the completed pavement.

In each row all full units shall be laid first. Cut closure units and fit subsequently. Such
closure units shall consist of not less than 25% of a full unit. Units may be cut using a
mechanical or hydraulic guillotine, bolster, or by power sawing.

Except where it is necessary to correct any minor variations occurring in the laying bond
hammer the paving units into position. Where adjustment of position is necessary take
care to avoid premature compaction of the sand bedding.

Any foot or barrow traffic shall use boards overlaying paving to prevent disturbance of
units prior to mechanical compaction. No other construction traffic shall be allowed on
the pavement at this stage of construction.

CE21/S3.DOC(21)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-22

3.17 INTERLOCKING CONCRETE PAVING BLOCKS (CONT'D)

(j) Laying Of Paving Units (Cont’d)

(ii) Compaction

The subgrade within the driveway is to be constructed in the manner as described in this
Clause.

The last layer of 500 mm thick subgrade material should have a minimum soaked
California Bearing Ratio (CBR) value of 5% and compacted to a minimum of 95% of
maximum dry density obtainable using the modified AASHTO compaction test (heavy
hammer) or Test No.13 BS 1377.

Samples are to be taken and tests such as CBR test, compaction test and in-situ field
density test are to be carried out at:

(a) Every Central Refuse Chute and Drop-Off Porch location.


(b) Every road bend at turning along the driveway.
(c) Every 50 m along the straight stretch of the driveway

subject to a minimum of 3 tests.

The tests may not be limited to the above locations and the SO Rep reserves the right to
conduct additional tests where necessary. All testing costs are to be borne by the
contractor.

After laying the paving units they shall be compacted to achieve consolidation of the sand
bedding and brought to design levels and profiles by not less than two and preferably
three passes of a suitable plate compactor.

The compactor shall be a high-frequency, low-amplitude mechanical flat plate vibrator


having a plate area sufficient to cover a minimum of 12 paving units.

Compaction shall proceed as closely as possible following laying and prior to the
acceptance of any traffic.

Compaction shall not be attempted, however, within one metre of the laying face.
Compaction shall continue until lipping has been eliminated between adjoining units.
Joints shall then be filled and compacted as hereinafter described.

All Works to within one metre of the laying face shall be left fully compacted at the
completion of each day's laying.

(iii) Damaged Units

Immediately remove and replace any units which are structurally damaged during
compaction.

CE21/S3.DOC(22)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-23

3.17 INTERLOCKING CONCRETE PAVING BLOCKS (CONT'D)

(j) Laying Of Paving Units (Cont’d)

(iv) Filling Joints

As soon as practical after compaction, and in any case prior to the termination of work on
that day and prior to the acceptance of construction traffic, spread sand for joint-filling over
the pavement. The joint-filling sand shall conform to the following grading limits :

A.S. Sieve % Passing

2.36 mm 100
1.18 mm 90 to 100
600 Φm 60 to 90
300 Φm 30 to 60
150 Φm 15 to 30
75 Φm 10 to 20

and shall be as dry as possible prior to spreading and brooming into the joints. At least
one pass of the vibrating-plate compactor is necessary to achieve compaction of the
jointing-filling sand. After the first pass joints shall be checked for adequacy of filling and
any shortfall shall be made good prior to a further pass of the compactor.

(v) Pavement Preloading

Where directed by the SO Rep the pavement shall receive not less than 5 and up to 10
passes of a pneumatic-tyred roller having a gross weight not less than 10 tonnes.

(vi) Excess Sand

Excess surface sand shall be removed by brooming prior to handing over the pavement.

(vii) Tolerance To Design Profile

All surfaces and pavement structures shall be true to line and levels, grades, thicknesses
and cross sections shown on the Drawings. Finish all pavements to lines and levels to
ensure positive drainage at all drainage outlets and channels.

3.18 CLAY PAVERS (TYPE PB) FOR FLEXIBLE PAVEMENT

(a) General

The clay pavers (Type PB) shall comply with requirements of BS 6677 Part 1, unless otherwise
specified.

The maximum and minimum value for the overall measurement of 24 clay pavers (for commonly
available work sizes) shall be as follows :

Work Size
Maximum Minimum
(in mm)
Length 215 5216 5104
210 5095 4985
200 4852 4748

Width 105 2555 2485


102.5 2494 2426
100 2433 2367
Thickness 65 1594 1526
50 1226 1174

Other work sizes may be used if permitted by the SO Rep.

CE21/S3.DOC(23)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-24

3.18 CLAY PAVERS (TYPE PB) FOR FLEXIBLE PAVEMENT (CONT’D)

(b) Sampling And Testing For Transverse Breaking Load

A total of 10 clay pavers shall be tested for each 200 m2 of clay pavers used for flexible pavement.

The mean transverse breaking load of 10 clay pavers shall be not less than 7 kN and the
transverse breaking load of each clay paver shall be not less than 4 kN.

(c) Failure Of Test On Transverse Breaking Load

The SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance and Irregularities" to impose
charges against the Contractor for :

(i) Each batch of 10 clay pavers for which the mean transverse breaking load is
less than 7 kN, or

(ii) each individual paver of which the transverse breaking load is less than 4 kN.

In addition, the consignment represented by the test sample may be accepted only at the sole
discretion of the SO Rep, after he has considered the degree of failure and other related
circumstances. Any consignment rejected by the SO Rep shall be removed from the Site
immediately.

(d) Sampling, Testing And Failure Criteria For Wet Skid Resistance

A total of 5 clay pavers shall be tested for each 200m2 of clay pavers used for flexible pavement.
The Mean Wet Skid Resistance of the 5 clay pavers shall not be less than 60. The SO Rep shall
exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 "Nuisance And Irregularities" to impose charges against the
Contractor for each batch of 5 clay pavers whose mean wet skid resistance fails to attain the
above criteria.

In addition, the consignment represented by the samples may be accepted only at the sole
discretion of the SO Rep, after he has considered the degree of failure and other related
circumstances. Any consignment rejected by the SO Rep shall be removed from the Site
immediately.

(e) Marking

Before laying, divide the pavers into consignment designated for each area of not more than 200
m2 for Transverse Breaking Load Test and Wet Skid Resistance Test. A sample of 15 pavers
shall be taken from each such consignment. Clearly mark the sample at the time of sampling in
such a way that the consignments represented by the sample are clearly defined.

(f) Laying of Interlocking Clay Paving Blocks

The method for the laying of clay pavers shall comply with the requirements as specified in
subclause 3.17 (g) to subclause 3.17 (j) inclusive for interlocking concrete paving blocks.

(g) Colours and laying patterns

The Contractor shall submit workshop drawings to the SO Rep showing the range of colours and
laying patterns of the clay pavers for selection and approval. The SO Rep reserves the right to
change the colours and laying patterns and his decision shall be final.

3.19 CONCRETE FOOTPATH

The paving slabs shall be properly bedded on a layer 25mm thick of unwashed sand and 100mm thick
hardcore well compacted and special care shall be taken to ensure that the earth formation of the
footpath is fully compacted and free from any vegetable matter or roots before footpath construction is
commenced.

Footpaths shall be laid true to the lines and levels of the roadside kerbs or divider and shall be given a
slight fall as shown on the Drawings transversely towards the carriageway.

For cast-in-situ concrete footpath panels of approximately 3m length shall be cast. The surface of each
panel shall be floated smooth with a wooden float or similar appliance. Provide
Construction/Contraction joints at the intervals between panels.

CE21/S3.DOC(24)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-25

3.20 BUS BAYS AND SHELTERS

Construct all bus bays shown in the Drawings to proper lines and levels, in reinforced concrete.
Complete construction of bus bays before the carriageway base course metalling is commenced and
protect the edges of the concrete slabs during carriageway construction. Make good any damage to
such concrete to the satisfaction of the SO Rep.

Roll the bed for the bus bay with a 10 tonne roller to the satisfaction of the SO Rep before receiving
crushed granite 100mm thick and blinded.

Install all bus shelters adjacent to the bus bays as shown in the Drawings.

3.21 TRAFFIC AND ROAD DIRECTIONAL SIGNS

The design, fabrication and installation of traffic signs and road directional signs shall comply with the
following general requirements and the LTA general guidelines laid down in the SIGNS MANUAL -
INFORMATION SIGNS, prepared by the Traffic Management Department, LTA, and/or revised LTA
guidelines on materials, support, letter types, colour codes, sign legibility, dimension etc. as and when
applicable.

Fabricate the signs with aluminium sheeting of thickness No. 14 SWG. The reflective sheeting shall be
diamond grade consisting of prismatic lens that are formed in a transparent synthetic resin and sealed
or other approved equivalent to LTA standard for all traffic and Road Directional Signs; The reflective
sheeting shall be durable and remain sharp during its expected service life under local weather
conditions. Submit a test report on the reflective sheeting from an SAC accredited laboratory and/or
from the manufacturer and/or any other independent laboratory approved by the SO Rep together with
the Tender and/or as and when required by the SO Rep. The test shall conform with ASTM D4956-90
for diamond grade and the report shall carry technical information on the reflectivity factors' durability of
the reflective surface; and adhesive, corrosion and abrasion resistance, colour tests etc. and any other
technical information outlined in the LTA general guidelines and/or required by the SO Rep. The
diamond grade reflective sheeting shall be guaranteed by the supplier and/or the Contractor against
any Defect such as discolouring, peeling, cracking, shrinking or any other apparent or latent Defect for
a period of seven years commencing from the Date of Substantial Completion.

Generally, joints shall not be permitted for aluminium sheeting and reflective sheeting. Where the size
of the sign requires joints, they shall be positioned horizontally at the dividing line between the legends
or as directed by the SO Rep. Joints of reflective sheeting shall coincide with those of aluminium
sheeting and the joints shall be rivetted.

Use only round block script letters and numerals in all the traffic and road directional signs. The letter
size and word spacing shall conform to the LTA standard and/or Specifications and/or Drawings and/or
specified by the SO Rep.

Support the signs either by 80mm diameter GI pipe or 125mm x 125mm x 6mm SHS supports and
embedded in concrete foundations, all in accordance with the LTA standard and/or Specifications
and/or Drawings and/or specified by the SO Rep. Give the supports one coat of red lead primer
undercoat and two finishing coats of enamel paint.

3.22 VEHICULAR IMPACT GUARDRAILS

Erect the guardrail to the alignment specified in the Drawings or as directed by the SO Rep. Connect
the adjacent rails by lap joints and the erection of the guardrail shall proceed in the direction of traffic
flow to avoid vehicles striking rail ends.

The nominal thickness of base metal for guardrails shall be 3.0mm formed into corrugated cross-section
of width 300mm minimum and trough depth 75mm conforming to the requirement of AASHTO:M180-
74. When simply supported over a span of 3.54 metres with its traffic face uppermost, the mid-point
deflection of the rail shall not exceed 75mm under a concentrated load of 1000 kg at mid-span.

The mechanical properties of the base metals for the rails shall conform to the following :

Minimum yield point - 345N per mm2


Minimum tensile strength - 483N per mm2
Elongation - 50mm, maximum 12%

CE21/S3.DOC(25)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-26

3.22 VEHICULAR IMPACT GUARDRAILS (CONT’D)

All fabricated rails shall be hot-dip galvanised at shop in accordance with BS 729 and shaped in the
workshop in standard length and assembled on the Site by galvanised oval shoulder button headed
bolts and nuts of 16mm nominal diameter.

All guardrail posts and spacers, unless otherwise specified shall be Mild Steel Channels or Steel Hollow
Sections.

3.23 ILLUMINATED SIGNBOARDS

(i) Materials and Workmanship

All materials used in the manufacture of the signboards shall be new and of the required quality,
correct dimensions, sizes and gauges as approved by the SO Rep and free from any Defect or
damage on completion of the fabrication, assembly and delivery of the signboards. If any of the
materials used is found to be defective or below the acceptable standard, the SO Rep may
instruct the Contractor to cease all work and replace those materials with proper and suitable
materials in accordance with the specifications or conform to British Standards or equivalent PSB
Standards.

The Contractor shall submit details of the components used for the proper fabrication and fixing
of the various components and parts of the signboards to the SO Rep for his approval before the
Works are carried out.

(ii) Electrical Installation

The Contractor shall employ a licensed electrical worker of the appropriate grade to carry out the
Works. A licensed electrical worker shall mean a qualified competent person to perform electrical
works under the Electrical Workers and Contractors Licensing Act 1974.

The electrical installation shall comply with all regulations issued by PowerGrid. All parts of the
installation shall where applicable, be to the complete satisfaction of the SO Rep, PowerGrid, all
Government Authorities and Fire Officers and shall be in strict accordance with all bye-laws,
rules and regulations of such Authorities.

(iii) Bolts and Nuts

All galvanised bolts and nuts for fixing signboards shall be provided with galvanised washers.

(iv) Painting to Metal Surfaces

Apply one coat approved lead and chromate free primer to the surfaces of mild steel angles,
hollow sections, brackets, weldings, nuts and bolts, etc. All primed metal surfaces shall be
finished with two coats of approved paint.

(v) Fluorescent Luminaries

The signboard luminaries shall be fluorescent luminaries with:

(a) 1200mm - 36W tubes and 600mm - 18W tubes

All luminaries shall be pre-wired and completed with tubes, power factor corrected
electronic ballasts and lampholders.

The Contractor shall provide and wire the luminaries to a termination block within the
signage box for termination purpose.

Where applicable, the fluorescent luminaries shall comply with the following Standards :

(1) IEC 81 : 1984 Tubular fluorescent lamp for general lighting service.
(2) IEC 400 : 1991 Lampholders for tubular fluorescent lamps and
starterholders.
(3) IEC 928 : 1995 Auxiliaries for lamps - A.C. supplied electronics ballasts for
tubular fluorescent lamps. General and safety requirements.
(4) IEC 929 : 1994 A.C. supplied electronic ballasts for tubular fluorescent
lamps. Performance requirements.
CE21/S3.DOC(26)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-27

3.23 ILLUMINATED SIGNBOARDS (CONT’D)

(v) Fluorescent Luminaries (Cont’d)

(b) Ballasts supplied shall be suitable for local use and separate ballasts shall be provided
for each lamp. The ballasts shall have a protection features to cut off the supply if it sense
a faulty fluorescent tube and restart automatically when the faulty tube is replaced.

(c) Fluorescent tubes installed shall be 'Philips' (Daylight), or other approved, of 26mm
nominal diameter type with lamp wattage of 36W and/or 18W.

All tubes shall have to pass batch tests conducted by PSB.

(vi) Wiring and Electrical Accessories

The wirings from the termination block in the illuminated signboards shall be 2 x 1.5mm2
PVC/PVC completed with 2.5mm2 PVC earth run in 20mm diameter Class 4 G.I. conduits
including accessories and terminated at the weather proof termination box. The termination box
shall be of steel construction not less than 2mm thickness and protected against corrosion by
hot dip galvanizing internally and externally.

The termination box shall be provided with the following wiring and electrical accessories:

(a) a 25 Amp 440V cut-off with provision of looping in of two numbers of phase, neutral and
earth conductors and looping out of one number of phase, neutral and earth conductors
of up to 25mm2 and a 5 Amp HRC fuse as shown in the Drawings.

(b) internal wiring of minimum size of 2 x 1.5mm2 PVC/PVC complete with 2.5mm2 PVC
(green) earth connecting the cut-off to the luminaries.

(c) brass compression glands for armoured PVC insulated cables, complete with brass
locknuts, earth tags, earthing tap and shroud.

(vii) Bonding

All exposed conductive parts shall be effectively bonded to the circuit protective conductor.

(viii) Electrical Testing & Completion Certificate

Upon completion of the Works, the Contractor's licensed electrical workers of the technician
grade shall test the installation to ensure that it complies with PowerGrid requirements and
CP5:1988. The Contractor shall furnish all data in the Electrical Testing & Completion Certificate
as shown in Appendix A2 and attached the single-line diagram to the SO Rep.

3.24 WORKS ON ROADS

(a) Works On Roads With Speed Limit Below 70 Km Per Hour

For any Works on roads with speed limit below 70 kph, the Contractor shall provide adequate
signboards, blinker lights, cones, etc, in accordance with LTA Code of Practice For Temporary
Traffic Control. The Contractor shall be deemed to have considered and allowed for all costs
and expenses for the temporary precautions and measures in the Contract Sum.

(b) Works On Roads With Speed Limit 70 Km Per Hour And Above

For any Works on roads with speed limit 70 kph and above, the Contractor shall provide adequate
signboards, blinker lights, cones, etc, in accordance with LTA Code of Practice For Temporary
Traffic Control. The Contractor shall note that he is required to provide a collison attenuator or
truck mounted attenuator (TMA) attached/fitted/mounted onto an appropriate shadow vehicle
with the necessary equipment for traffic control and road safety in accordance with LTA Code of
Practice For Temporary Traffic Control. The TMA provided shall comply with LTA specification
and requirements. The Contractor shall be deemed to have considered and allowed for all costs
and expenses for the temporary precautions and measures in the Contract Sum.

(c) For road openings on public streets, the Contractor shall comply with LTA Code of Practice For
Road - Opening Works. The Contractor shall be deemed to have considered and allowed for all
costs and expenses.

CE21/S3.DOC(27)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-28

3.25 SEALANT USED FOR EXPANSION JOINT IN RIGID PAVEMENT

(a) General

Expansion joints shall be of an approved shape and be provided in the positions as shown in the
Drawings or as directed.

Suitable joint filler material is placed between the pavement slabs to allow the slabs to expand
and contract.

Joints shall be sealed using appropriate joint sealant.

(b) Joint Sealant

(i) Type of Sealant

The type of sealant used shall be cold applied, fuel resistant. Cold applied sealant capable
of accommodating high movement.

(ii) Requirements

The sealant shall comply with the British Standard BS 5212 : 1990 "Cold applied joint
sealant systems for concrete pavements" Type F.

Cold applied, high duty pavement sealant shall possess the following properties :

Form : Two part compound


Base compound - viscous liquid
Curing agent - liquid
Colour : Black
Movement accommodation : Butt joints 25%
Factor (BS 6093)
Physical or Chemical change : Chemical cure
Setting time : After 16 to 24 hours, sealant will be tacked free
and accepted traffic. Full cure and maximum
hardness are attained in approximately 3 to 4
days at 25ΕC.
Application temperature : To avoid unacceptably prolonged cure time, do
do not apply to temperatures below 5ΕC.
Hardness shore 'A' at 25ΕC : 12 to 17
Chemical resistance to : Dilute acids - resistant
Occasional spillage Mild alkalis - resistant
Petrol - resistant
Aviation fuels - resistant
Diesel fuels - resistant
Synthetic oils - resistant
Mineral oils - resistant
Hydraulic fluids - resistant
Kerosene - resistant
Solid content : 100%
Density : 1.36 kg per litre
Flash point : Over 65ΕC
Flammability : Burns but does not readily support combustion

CE21/S3.DOC(28)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-29

3.25 SEALANT USED FOR EXPANSION JOINT IN RIGID PAVEMENT (CONT'D)

(c) Method for application of sealant

(i) Joint Preparation

Joint sealing slots shall be accurately formed and shall be dry, clean and sound. All
grease, water and dust shall be removed from the joint before applying the primer.

Ensure that any expansion joint filler is tightly packed in the joint and at the required depth
to provide the seal dimensions specified.

(ii) Priming

Primers shall be applied only to sealant contact surfaces which must be clean, dry, sound
and free of contaminants.

Prime joint sealing slot surface with appropriate prime for the type of sealant approved by
the SO Rep. Allow primer to air dry prior to applying sealant. Drying time also depends
on the type of primer used and ambient temperature.

The surface shall be touch dry. The approved sealant shall be applied within the time
period after priming before the primer film has completely reacted. Primed surfaces not
sealed with sealant within the required time period shall be re-primed before applying
sealant.

(iii) Application of sealant

Dried primer is free of any residue and prepared joints are free of any foreign matter or
contaminations. Apply sealant into the sealing slot so that the finished level of the seal is
recessed below the trafficked surface as specified.

(d) Information of product to be supplied by manufacturer

Obtain from the manufacturer the following information of the sealant/primer proposed for use
for the Works :

Maximum safe heating temperature of the material.


Temperature range of application.
Flash point of sealant and primer.
Composition of the mixture.
Type of primer required.
Application instructions.
Health and Safety Data Sheets on sealant and primer for additional information concerning
usage, handling precautions, first aid procedures, warranty including shelf life.

The foregoing information shall be provided to the SO Rep one week before the start of the
sealant application.

3.26 PRECAST CONCRETE PERFORATED INTERLOCKING PAVING SLABS

Where precast concrete perforated interlocking paving slabs are included in the Works, the Contractor
shall comply with the requirements for sand bedding preparation and laying as specified in clause 3.17
'Interlocking Concrete Paving Blocks" including all subclauses under it. The colour of the interlocking
paving slabs shall be decided by the SO Rep. For sampling and testing of the interlocking paving slabs,
the Contractor shall comply with the following :

(a) Sampling and Testing

(i) Transverse Strength Test

The transverse strength for each paving slab shall not be less than 19kN. Samples of
paving slabs at a rate of 3 paving slabs for every 1,000 paving slabs delivered to the Site,
shall be selected for transverse strength test to be performed in the manner as described
in BS EN 1339 and in an SAC accredited laboratory. If the overall quantity of paving slabs
in the Works is less than 1,000 pieces, a minimum of 3 numbers of paving slabs shall be
chosen for the transverse strength test.

CE21/S3.DOC(29)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 3-30

3.26 PRECAST CONCRETE PERFORATED INTERLOCKING PAVING SLABS (CONT'D)

(a) Sampling and Testing (Cont'd)

(ii) Water Absorption Test

The maximum average rate of water absorption test (%) calculated on the dry weight of 3
test pieces per paving slab shall not exceed 3% at 30 minutes. 5 numbers of paving slabs
for every 1,000 paving slabs delivered to the Site, shall be selected for water absorption
test to be performed in the manner as described in BS EN 1339 and in a SAC accredited
laboratory. If the overall quantity of paving slabs in the Works is less than 1,000 pieces, a
minimum of 5 numbers of paving slabs shall be chosen for the water absorption test.

(iii) Surface Layer Thickness in Composite Paving Slabs

Coloured concrete paving slabs formed by the addition of pigments may either be
homogenous or non-homogenous. Non-homogenous coloured paving slabs are
considered as composite paving slabs. The coloured surface layer of each composite
paving slab shall be formed as an integral part of the paving slab and shall not be less
than 12mm thick.

For every 550m2 of interlocking composite paving slabs laid on the Site, 5 numbers of
paving slabs shall be checked for surface layer thickness. If the overall quantity of paving
slabs in the Works is less than 550 m2, a minimum of 5 numbers of paving slabs shall be
chosen for checking on surface layer thickness. The checking shall be conducted in a
SAC accredited laboratory.

Each paving slab shall be cut neatly at mid-span of its length. Cutting the paving slab shall
only be carried out in the accredited laboratory. The average surface layer thickness of
each composite paving slab shall be derived from the measured thickness at the left,
middle and right edges of the surface layer thickness on the cross-sectional face of the
cut-off paving slab. The thickness shall be measured to the nearest 0.1mm accuracy.

The Contractor shall ensure that the cut samples are collected back from the SAC
accredited laboratory and returned to HDB for verification. These cut samples shall be
kept at the site office and disposed off only at the sole discretion of the SO Rep.

The SO Rep shall exercise his rights under Clause 1.6 ‘Nuisance and Irregularities’ of Standard
Specifications to impose charges against the Contractor for each sample that fails to comply with
the above test requirements.

Each consignment of slabs represented by the sample testing may be accepted only at the sole
discretion of the SO Rep after he has considered the degree of failure and other related
circumstances. Any consignment rejected by the SO Rep shall be removed from the site
immediately.

SECTION 4/.....

CE21/S3.DOC(30)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 4-1

SECTION 4

CONSTRUCTION AND WORKMANSHIP FOR SEWERS

4.1 ADDITIONAL WATER RECLAMATION (NETWORK) DEPARTMENT, PUB’S REQUIREMENTS FOR


SEWERS AND MANHOLES

Use approved flexible joints thickwall concrete pipes and vitrified clay pipes with flexible joints in
accordance with the current Standard Specification and tests of the Water Reclamation (Network)
Department, PUB.

Comply with the clauses laid down in the current "Standard Specification for Sewerage Works"
published by Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB. The Standard specification may be
obtained from the Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB.

4.2 EXCAVATION AND REFILLING

Carry out the excavation in accordance with Clauses 2.5 to 2.14 (inclusive) of the Specifications.

Carefully excavate and install timbering in accordance with the Drawings in such a manner that the toes
of the runners are always at least 150mm below the bottom of the excavation.

Where necessary in order to keep the road open to vehicular and foot traffic, cart away excavated
material from the trench as may be necessary so to keep the road open.

Should any of the sewer trenches be excavated to a greater depth than is necessary for the proper
execution of the Works, fill in the part over-excavated with Grade 15 concrete or other approved hard
material.

4.3 TIMBERING OF EXCAVATION

Brace all excavation adequately and securely with suitable timber using the methods indicated in the
Drawings where necessary or otherwise approved by the SO Rep.

Notwithstanding the approval given, the SO Rep shall, where necessary, instruct the Contractor to
improve, alter or strengthen the timbering from time to time. The Contractor shall be responsible for
any injury to the Works and any consequential damages caused and any permission given by the SO
Rep shall not relieve the Contractor from this responsibility.

In the particular case of timber to be left in trenches the class of timbering shall be approved by the SO
Rep and this timber shall be cut off only after backfilling is completed, as indicated in the Drawings.

Take every precaution against slips and falls or other disturbances to both the temporary and permanent
work in the excavations. If however any slips, falls etc should occur, at once make good the same
including all surface restoration all to the satisfaction of the SO Rep. If any slip or fall disturbs or
weakens any foundation or support of the Works or to existing structures mains etc or cause a space
to be left outside the new work itself or causes excessive surface cracks to appear in the ground
surrounding the excavation, execute such additional works or take such additional precautions as the
SO Rep may require in consequence thereof and fill up the space so caused with concrete if necessary,
as the SO Rep may direct. The Contractor shall be fully responsible for the reinstatement or repair to
the disturbances or damages caused.

4.4 PILING OF FOUNDATIONS

Where bakau piles are indicated in the Drawings, they shall be of approved lengths and driven straight
and in approved positions and to the full length of the piles or to the required set as determined by the
SO Rep and any pile not correctly driven shall be duplicated. Where other types of piles are indicated
in the Drawings, they shall be installed in the approved manner.

Where horizontal bakau rollers are specified they shall be laid horizontally in the bottom of the
excavations to correct gradients in approved positions.

CE21/S4.DOC(1)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 4-2

4.5 SEWER FOUNDATION

Lay pipes and concrete in every instance on an even and solid foundation. The pipes shall be laid
evenly on the barrel at the required level. Hollows, voids or foreign material under the pipe shall not be
allowed. Complete the bedding to the correct profile as shown in the Drawings.

Provide all sections of the sewer with either hard filling, concrete base with/without piling as specified.
However, should the SO Rep decide to change the type of foundation after the close of the Tender,
such change shall constitute a variation to the contract and shall be valued in accordance with the
Contract provisions.

4.6 SEALING COAT

Where indicated in the Drawings and immediately after a sufficient length of trench has been bakau
piled and/or passed by the SO Rep, lay a seal coat of Grade 15 concrete, 75mm thick across the
complete width of the trench, including filling with concrete to the temporary drainage channel. Finish
the seal coat neatly such that the bakau pile heads, if any, are left projecting 25mm.

4.7 CONCRETE BED FOUNDATION

The concrete bed formation for the sewer pipes shall consist of a concrete foundation using Grade 30
concrete as shown in the Drawings according to the different Type Sections.

4.8 GRANOLITHIC CONCRETE

Granolithic concrete shall consist of one part of Portland Cement, two parts of fine aggregate and three
parts of 10mm granite chippings free from dust. In all other respects it shall comply with the remainder
of the Specifications for concrete.

4.9 PIPE LAYING

Lay pipes for sewers true to line and grade as shown in the Drawings and all in accordance with Clause
2.70 "Pipe Laying".

4.10 CLEARING PIPELINES OF OBSTRUCTION

After testing the pipelines as specified and at a time to be directed by the SO Rep, inspect the interior
of the pipelines to ascertain that the pipes are entirely clear of obstruction and that the invert is smooth.

The outside diameter of the ends of the plug shall not be smaller than the diameter of the pipe through
which it is to be passed by 25mm and its length shall not be less than its diameter.

The SO Rep may not instruct for this test until he is satisfied that the lengths concerned are complete
and ready for operation.

Remove any obstruction in the pipelines and make good any unevenness of the invert.

If, as a result of the removal of any obstruction, the SO Rep considers that any damage may have been
caused to the pipelines, the Contractor shall be required to re-test again the length of such pipelines.
Should such re-test prove unsatisfactory, amend the work and carry out such further tests as required
by the SO Rep.

CE21/S4.DOC(2)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 4-3

4.11 TESTING OF GRAVITY SEWERS

(i) General

(a) All gravity sewers of 600 mm or less in diameter shall be tested by filling with water to an
internal pressure of 1.5 metre head of water above the invert of the pipe at the highest
end of the pipeline.

(b) Testing shall be carried out for the whole length of the pipeline between manholes and
before the pipeline is concreted and covered. The Contractor shall bear the cost and
expense for the testing of gravity sewers to comply with the requirements of PUB.

(ii) Testing Procedure

(a) Ensure that the following equipment is available :

(i) A plug of appropriate size to be fitted at the downstream end of the pipeline.

(ii) A measuring cylinder to measure the actual loss of water.

(iii) A 90 degree elbow bend and vertical pipe of equal diameter to be fitted at the
highest end of the pipeline. For minor sewers, the elbow bend and the vertical pipe
shall be of the same diameter of the sewer. For main sewers, the minimum
diameter of the elbow bend and vertical pipe shall be 225mm although the same
diameter as that of the pipeline is always preferable.

(b) Ensure that the pipeline is properly anchored.

(c) Fit the plug at the downstream end of the pipeline and the elbow bend with the vertical
pipe at the highest end of the pipeline.

(d) Fill the pipeline with water through the vertical pipe up to its brim making sure that there
are no pocket of trapped air.

(e) Ensure that the pipeline is completely filled with water by allowing the water to drain away
at the downstream end and topping up with water again to the brim of the vertical pipe.

(f) Allow the pipeline to stand for a minimum of 2 hours for absorption and topping up as
necessary before carrying out the water test.

(g) Test the pipeline at the required head of 1.5 metres head of water. Top up the vertical
pipe using the measuring cylinder at intervals of 5 minutes and noting the quantity of water
needed to maintain the test head over a period of 30 min.

(h) On completion of the test, remove the plug at the end of the pipeline and observe the
water level at the vertical pipe to ensure that the level drops freely and the water in the
pipeline drains away.

(iii) Acceptance Criteria

(a) The pipeline shall not be accepted until they have withstood the required pressure head
of 1.5 metres head of water for 30 minutes without loss of water in excess of 1.5 litres for
100m length of pipe for each 300mm in diameter.

(b) Formula to calculate permissible loss of water for 30 minutes is as follows :

Permissible Loss (ml) = Diameter of Pipe (mm) X Effective Length of Pipeline (m) X 1500ml
300 (mm) 100 (m)

Gravity sewer of 600 mm and above in diameter need not be hydraulically tested. They shall be
inspected by Closed-Circuit Television (CCTV) inspection or for man-entry sewers, manual
inspection shall be carried out. The Contractor shall make appropriate arrangements to install
the CCTV and keep proper records of the sewer inspection. The Contractor shall bear the cost
and expense for the CCTV and man-entry inspection in accordance with the requirements of
PUB.

Do not cover the pipes until they have been inspected and passed.

CE21/S4.DOC(3)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 4-4

4.12 BUILT-IN PIPES

At all points where pipes are built into concrete walls or floors, take great care that the joint is watertight.
If found to be otherwise, cut away and replace the concrete to make a watertight joint to the satisfaction
of the SO Rep.

4.13 JUNCTIONS AND CONNECTIONS

The junctions where provided shall be securely stoppered, such temporary stopper being secured with
cement mortar.

4.14 CONCRETE AROUND PIPES

After each length of pipes has been tested and passed, bed haunch and surround the pipes with
concrete as shown in the Drawings.

At approximately every four pipes or 6m whichever is the lesser interval, form a joint in concrete bed or
surround by vertically shuttering the bed or surround with 25mm thick fibre board, timber or other
approved material. Leave the shuttering material in to form a permanent joint. Where the concrete bed
is required to be reinforced, stop all reinforcement on either side of the joint.

The whole of the concrete shall be thoroughly set before any work of refilling is commenced.

4.15 TUMBLING BAYS AND BACKDROPS

Where required, construct tumbling bays and backdrops in accordance with the details of the approved
Drawings.

Use special spigot and socket junctions in the junction between the two lines of pipes. For backdrops
and tumbling bays above 300mm diameter the junction shall be cast iron to approved dimensions and
shape.

Lay the tumbling bays or backdrop pipes on a concrete foundation and completely encase in concrete
surround as shown in the Drawings.

Where indicated in the Drawings, build tumbling bay pipes into the walls of the manhole by cutting a
neat hole sufficient for building in the pipes and finish flush with the inside of the manhole and neatly
splay on the outside to form a watertight joint.

4.16 BRICK MANHOLES

Where detailed, build brick manholes in positions shown and in accordance with details in the Drawings.
Construct the brickwall in accordance with Clauses 2.58 "Bricks" and 2.59 "Brickwork Generally".

Set the reinforced concrete slabs covering the chambers of the manhole and joint in cement mortar as
specified to form watertight joints.

Form channels and benching to the concrete floors of the manholes as detailed in Grade 30 concrete
as specified and render in cement mortar 20mm thick.

Build ends of pipes into the walls of the manholes and finish off in cement mortar. Set manhole covers
and frames in cement mortar and covers left flush with the road surface or the finished ground level.

Flush point internal and external joints of brick manholes in 1:3 cement mortar and finish off to a smooth
surface.

CE21/S4.DOC(4)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 4-5

4.17 PRECAST CONCRETE MANHOLES

Where indicated, precast reinforced concrete ring manholes shall be built in the positions shown in the
Drawings. Submit details of the supply of this item to the SO Rep for approval.

Set the rings forming the chambers of the manholes on a reinforced concrete foundation comprising a
base of concrete and a built-up section, sufficient to completely build in the ends of the pipes.

Construct the base, benching and pointing of all precast and in-situ concrete manholes in Ordinary
Portland Cement, unless otherwise directed. Form the benching at the soffit level of the out-going
sewer pipe rising by 75mm to the manhole walls. Form curves and junction benchings to a radius in
the centre line of the channel not less than one and a half times the diameter of this pipe.

Set the reinforced concrete slabs covering the chambers and the shafts of the manholes in 1:3 cement
mortar to form watertight joints.

Form channels and benching to the concrete floors of concrete manholes in Ordinary Portland Cement
concrete.

Set manhole covers and frames as specified in Clause 2.80 "Manhole Cover And Frame" in cement
mortar and surrounded with concrete and covers left flush with the road surface or the finished ground
level.

4.18 CLEANING OF SEWERS

Thoroughly clean all sewers to the requirements of Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB
before final inspection prior to acceptance.

Throughout the Time for Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under
the Contract, when required by the SO Rep, provide without charge one number aluminium ladder, two
numbers powerful lamp of at least six cells, two pairs of keys for lifting manhole covers and one number
spirit level, two numbers mirrors all to the approval of the SO Rep.

4.19 INSPECTION AND APPROVAL OF SEWERS BY WATER RECLAMATION (NETWORK)


DEPARTMENT, PUB

Before their acceptance, thoroughly clean the sewers and made ready for inspections by the SO Rep
and by the Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB's representative. No sewer or part of a
sewer may be put into use until a final inspection has been carried out and the sewers and manholes
found to be satisfactory. Provide and install all the necessary plugs to the manholes before the sewers
are put into use and remove the plugs when the lines are to be in use all to the requirements and
satisfaction of the SO Rep and Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB. The Works shall only
be certified satisfactory when both the SO Rep and the Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB
have approved all the sewers and manholes.

4.20 CONNECTION OF HOUSE DRAIN TO SEWER MANHOLE

No final connections may be made from the house drain/s to a sewer manhole until the sewer has been
passed as satisfactory, after a final inspection has been carried out.

4.21 CONNECTION OF SEWERS TO EXISTING MANHOLE

All sewer connection to existing manholes shall be included in the Contract, unless otherwise indicated
in the Drawings.

CE21/S4.DOC(5)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 4-6

4.22 PIPE JACKING

(a) General

(i) Where specified in the Drawings, sections of the sewer shall be laid by pipe jacking.

(ii) Submit details of Construction Equipment, materials and the method of construction to
perform and complete the work for approval by the SO Rep before commencing these
operations. Approval by the SO Rep shall not relieve the Contractor of his sole
responsibility for the efficacy, reliability, soundness of the method employed in completing
the work in a satisfactory manner.

(iii) The general soil profile along the route of the sewer shall be given in the borelogs, for the
Contractor's information only. The Employer accepts no responsibility for the accuracy,
reliability or completeness of this information. The Contractor shall satisfy himself as to
the soil conditions along the pipe jacking route and carry out additional soil investigations
at his own cost and expense.

(iv) In general, the soil is usually of an unstable nature and the ground water table is usually
high. Maintain stable soil conditions at the jacking face to prevent loss of ground above
the jacking operation and movement of the surrounding earth. The methods of
maintaining face stability and preventing ground movement and subsidence shall be by
means of compressed air or other plenum methods where fluid slurry or earth pressure is
applied-to the tunnel face. Alternatively, stabilise unstable ground ahead of the jacking
face by the injection of suitable chemicals. Methods which require dewatering of the
ground and methods which may lead to significant ground loss shall not be accepted.
Submit soil stabilization method to the SO Rep for approval.

(v) Monitor movement or settlement of structures, utilities and pavement during the jacking
operation and report to the SO Rep. If movement or settlement occurs which, in the
opinion of the SO Rep may cause damage, take immediate action to prevent further
movement, settlement or damage. Repair any damage and restore structures or
pavements to the satisfaction of the SO Rep.

(vi) Inspect the location and familiarise himself with the conditions under which the work shall
be performed and with all necessary details as to the orderly execution of the work. The
omission of any details shall not relieve the Contractor's full responsibility for the
satisfactory installation of the work in its entirety. No monetary or other claims made by
the Contractor on the grounds of want of knowledge shall be entertained by the Employer.

(b) Materials

(i) The pipes for jacking operation shall be precast reinforced concrete pipes. The pipes
shall be manufactured by a centrifugal or other equivalent process to be approved by the
SO Rep. Design, manufacture and factory testing of the pipes and specials shall be to SS
183 or BS 5911 or AS 1342 or other acceptable standard. The clear cover of concrete
over steel reinforcement shall not be less than 50mm.

(ii) All pipes shall be manufactured with two sets of grout holes. Each set shall consist of
three grout holes spaced at 120 degrees on centres circumferentially located at the
quarter points from either end of the pipe.

(iii) The precast reinforced concrete pipes shall be sufficiently reinforced with steel to
withstand all stresses induced by handling, jacking, earth and water pressures and all
working loads at the depths at which they are to be used without cracking, spalling or
distortion. The pipes shall be of at least strength Class `H'. A load factor of not larger
than 1.5 shall be used in the calculations to determine the strength of the pipes required.
The strength of the pipes shall be tested by the three edge bearing test. When subjected
to the design load in such a test, the maximum crack width developed on the pipe shall
not exceed 0.25mm.

(iv) Submit full details of his proposals for the pipes, giving detailed drawings showing sizes,
reinforcement and type of joints, calculations, together with the name of the proposed
manufacturer, the place of manufacture, and the manufacturing processes to the SO Rep
for approval. All workmanship and materials used in the manufacture shall be subject to
the approval of the SO Rep who shall from time to time be permitted to inspect materials
at source and the manufacturing processes in the factory.

CE21/S4.DOC(6)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 4-7

4.22 PIPE JACKING (CONT'D)

(b) Materials (Cont'd)

(v) The pipes shall be sufficiently matured before they are used in the construction of the
Works. Handle the pipes with extreme care to prevent the edges of the pipes from
chipping. Repaired pipes shall not be allowed for use in the Contract. The SO Rep may
reject any pipes he considers not suitable for the Works and these rejected pipes shall be
removed from the Site immediately. After factory testing and before despatch, every pipe
and special shall be marked in accordance with the Standard used. In addition, each pipe
shall be marked with a number corresponding with the order of manufacture. Test
certificates from the manufacturers or other relevant authority shall be submitted to the
SO Rep.

(vi) Where steel shield is utilised during the jacking operation, bolt this steel shield to or by
other approved means jointed to the first piece of pipe which is being jacked.

(vii) Use a jacking ring. The jacking ring may be either of steel or concrete construction and
shall be used at all times when a pipe is being jacked. This jacking ring shall allow the
jacking pressure to be distributed evenly around the wall of the pipe.

(viii) Use a jacking frame during all operations. The jacking frame shall be designed to
distribute the stresses from the jacks evenly to the jacking ring.

(c) Jacking Operations

(i) The Contractor shall be fully responsible for the materials, Construction Equipment and
facilities required in conjunction with jacking the reinforced concrete pipe.

(ii) Before starting work, submit to the SO Rep for approval, a detailed schedule of the entire
jacking operation. Approval of such schedule shall not relieve the Contractor of his
responsibility to provide a fully satisfactory installation. Provide together with his
submission, evidence that he has successfully completed a jacking installation using
procedures similar to those proposed.

(iii) Where the Contractor proposes to use compressed air, his proposal shall comply with the
requirements of the specifications for "Working in Compressed Air" and "Work in
Compressed Air".

(iv) Where chemical stabilization of soil is used, pressure inject a chemical grout into the soil
over and ahead of the pipe jacking to stabilise the soil. The chemical grout used shall
have a demonstrated history of success for stabilizing soils similar to that through which
the pipe is to be jacked.

(v) Where a mechanical shield is used, provide proof that the particular model of shield has
been used successfully in soils similar to that on the Site. The crew for the operation of
the shield shall be specialists, with experience in the use of that particular type of machine.

(vi) After the jacking operation has begun, work continuously (24 hours per day) until the
complete length of jacked pipe is installed.

(vii) Jack the pipes into place true to line and level. The maximum tolerance allowable in the
displacement of the centreline of the laid pipe from the designed centreline is 50mm in
the horizontal plane and 25mm in the vertical plane but there shall be no backfall at any
point. Any pipe which is not laid in its correct position shall be removed and relaid or
adjusted to obtain its correct position.

(viii) There shall be provision to prevent the relative movement between pipes at the joints by
the use of steel gaiters or other approved methods during jacking operation. Provide a
packing piece of compressible material at each joint to be securely held before the pipes
are lowered into the thrust pit. Submit details of proposals to the SO Rep for approval.

(ix) Furnish and install and remove to the extent required, thrust blocks or whatever provisions
that may be required for backing up the jacks employed in driving the pipe forward. Equip
the jacking pit with steel rails or beams embedded in concrete. Use these rails or beams
for placement and alignment of each pipe during the jacking operation.

CE21/S4.DOC(7)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 4-8

4.22 PIPE JACKING (CONT'D)

(c) Jacking Operations (Cont’d)

(x) The Contractor shall be responsible for the design and construction of the jacking and
receiving pits, thrusting wall, installation of jacking equipment, sheeting, bracing, etc, and
for the efficient execution of the jacking operation. Submit full details of the proposals,
including Construction Equipment, shield machine, equipment, operating procedures,
jacking pit and intermediate jacking stations etc, for approval by the SO Rep before
construction. However, approval by the SO Rep and review of the plans shall not relieve
the Contractor from his responsibility to provide a safe and satisfactory jacking pit.

(xi) Monitor closely the progress of the jacking operation. Daily site records of thrusting
pressures and the line and level measurements shall be properly maintained and shall be
made available to the SO Rep at all times.

(xii) Ensure that the completed tunnels are watertight. If leakage occurs before Substantial
Completion or during the Defects Liability Period, carry out any remedial work that may
be necessary to make the Works watertight.

(d) Cement Grouting

(i) Prevent the occurrence of voids outside the pipe and if they occur, fill them with cement
grout.

(ii) Immediately following the jacking operation, pressure grout the jacked section to fill all
voids existing outside of the pipe. Grouting shall be from the interior of the pipe through
grouting holes as specified.

(iii) Provide systems of standard pipe, fittings, hose, and special grouting outlets embedded
in the pipe walls. Ensure that all parts of the system are maintained free from dirt.
Carefully force grout composed of cement, sand and other approved compound and water
under pressure into the grouting connections at the invert and proceed until grout begins
to flow from upper connections. Make connections to these holes and continue the
operation to completion.

(iv) Apparatus for mixing and placing grout shall be of a type approved by the SO Rep and
shall be capable of mixing effectively and stirring the grout and then forcing it into the grout
connections in a continuous uninterrupted flow.

(v) After grouting is completed, maintain pressure by means of stop cocks, or other suitable
devices until the grout has set sufficiently. After the grout is set, completely fill grout holes
with dense concrete and finish neatly without evidence of voids or projections.

(vi) For pipes with PVC or HDPE linings, carry out grouting and ensure that the pipeline is
watertight before proceeding with the jointing of the linings of the pipes and the patching
of the lining over the filled grout holes

4.23 JOINTING COLLARS FOR JACKED-IN-PLACE REINFORCED CONCRETE SEWER PIPES

Where steel collars are used for pipe joints, it shall be made of austenitic stainless steel of Type 316
with minimum chrome content of 17% and minimum nickel content of 8%. The jointing collar shall be of
the dimensions and thickness in accordance with the Water Reclamation (Network) Department, PUB's
requirements.

SECTION 5/.....

CE21/S4.DOC(8)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 5-1

SECTION 5

CONSTRUCTION AND WORKMANSHIP FOR EARTHWORKS

5.1 DEFINITION AND CLASSIFICATION OF EARTHWORKS MATERIALS

The following definitions of earthworks materials shall apply to this Section including all clauses and
subclauses under it :

(a) 'Top Soil' shall mean the top layer of soil that can support vegetation.

(b) 'Approved Material' shall comprise those that are acceptable in accordance with the Contract for
use in the Works and those which are capable of being compacted in the manner specified in
Clause 5.9 "Compaction" to form a stable fill.

(c) 'Unsuitable Material' shall mean those other than the Approved Material and shall include :

(i) material from swamps;

(ii) peat, logs, stumps and perishable material;

(iii) material susceptible to spontaneous combustion;

(iv) soil of liquid limit exceeding 70 and/or plasticity index exceeding 35;

(v) material having an in-situ moisture content greater than the maximum permitted for such
materials in the Contract, unless otherwise permitted by the SO Rep.

(d) 'Rock' shall mean hard material whose geological nature is to be regarded as such and individual
boulders exceeding 0.20 cu m in size or other masses of hard material which necessitate the
use of blasting or approved pneumatic tools for their removal.

(e) 'Special Filling Material' shall mean "Approved Material" as defined in the foregoing definition but
shall all pass a 75 mm BS sieve. The fraction passing a 75µm BS sieve shall have the following
characteristics :

(i) Liquid limit not exceeding 35;

(ii) Plasticity index not exceeding 12;

(iii) Coefficient of uniformity shall be greater than 10;

(iv) The percentage passing 75µm BS sieve shall be less than 20% by weight.

(f) 'Cohesive Soil' shall include clays with up to 20% of gravel and having a moisture content not
less than the value of the plastic limit minus 4.

(g) 'Well-Graded Granular And Dry Cohesive Soils' shall include clays containing more than 20% of
gravel and/or having a moisture content less than the value of plastic limit minus 4, well-graded
sands and gravels with a uniformity coefficient exceeding 10.

(h) 'Uniformly-Graded Material' shall include sands and gravels with a uniformity coefficient of 10 or
less, and all silts. Any soil containing 80% or more of material in the particle size range from
60µm to 2µm shall be regarded as silt for this purpose.

CE21/S5.DOC(1)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 5-2

5.2 EARTHWORKS GENERALLY

Carry out all earthworks in such a manner as to prevent erosion or slips, limit working faces to safe
slopes and height, and ensure that all surfaces have at all times sufficient gradients to enable them to
shed water without causing erosion.

At the end of each day, all surfaces shall be left with no area that can retain water. If necessary, provide
and maintain temporary and approved surface or subsurface drainage system to ensure minimum delay
in work progress due to wet weather. Alternatively, adequate means, such as covering all surfaces with
polythene paper, shall be provided and maintained.

Provide and maintain all necessary temporary access roads and divert and reinstate permanent
drainage system. Submit the proposed alignments and levels of temporary access roads to the SO Rep
for approval prior to their construction. Provide all temporary roads with drainage ditches over full
length. The Contractor is required to take out a Temporary Occupation Licence (TOL) and pay TOL
fees for the use of State Land for erection of site offices and other temporary facilities within the Site
contract boundary of earthworks.

5.3 CUTTINGS INCLUDING SLOPES

Unless otherwise specified or shown in the Drawings, neatly round the top edges of all cuttings to the
dimensions shown in the Drawings or as directed by the SO Rep.

Unless otherwise specified or shown in the Drawings, slopes to cuttings shall conform with the
following :

Table 5.1 Allowable Slopes In Cutting

Slope
Material
(Horizontal Distance To Vertical Rise)

Sand Two to One to Five to One 2 : 1 to 5 : 1


Loose gravel or clay Two to One 2:1
Loam, shale or similar soft Rock One to One 1:1
Rock with clay seams Three-quarter to One ¾:1
Jointed Laminated or soft Rock One-half to One ½:1
Massive Rock One-quarter to One ¼:1

Where the location of unsuitable soil is shown in the Drawings or specified to be removed, the
Contractor shall remove such unsuitable soil. Where the SO Rep re-determines the slopes, the
Contractor shall not be entitled to any claim whatsoever or to adjustment to the Contract Sum except
where such re-determination of slopes by the SO Rep results in a difference in work quantities, either
addition or omission, which shall constitute a variation to the Contract.

In all cuttings, whether in earth or Rock, undulations in the general plane of the slope shall not be
permitted.

The SO Rep may direct that any overhanging, loose or unstable material, whether outside or behind
the specified slope, be removed. Any additional cost so involved shall be paid as a variation to the
Contract.

Arrange the excavation such that the working areas are adequately drained throughout the Time for
Completion and any time period where liquidated damages are imposed under the Contract.

CE21/S5.DOC(2)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 5-3

5.4 FOUNDATION FOR FILLS

Embankment construction shall include the preparation and compaction to the degree as specified
under Clause 5.9 "Compaction" of the areas upon which embankments are to be placed, the placing
and compacting of Approved Material within areas from which Unsuitable Material has been removed
as specified hereunder, and the placing and compacting of embankment material in holes, pits, and
other depressions within the foundation area.

Unless otherwise specified, clear the natural ground over which filling is to be placed of all loose
boulders, grass, topsoil, bushes, trees, roots and other vegetation. If the SO Rep considers that any
underlying material is unstable or unsuitable, he may direct it to be removed and replaced with Approved
Material, the cost of which shall be valued in accordance with the Contract provisions and be borne by
the Employer.

Remove any overhanging Rock ledges or caves within the foundation area before the placing of fill
commences.

Where ground water or extensive seepage are encountered in the foundation area, and no special
drainage arrangements are shown in the Drawings, the SO Rep may direct that suitable pipe drains be
installed in the fill area, or that deep open drains be excavated clear of the fill. All these drainage Works
shall form part of the Contract and the Contractor shall not be entitled to any extra claim.

The construction of any section of a fill shall not commence until the foundation for that section has
been approved by the SO Rep.

5.5 FILLING GENERALLY

Carry out filling in layers compatible with the compaction plants used. End tipping of fill shall be allowed
provided the end tipped material is compacted to the requirements as specified in Clause 5.9
"Compaction".

When the state of the weather is such that, in the opinion of the SO Rep, it would adversely affect the
placing of specially compacted fill, all such work shall be stopped.

Remove and replace all filling material, whether placed and/or compacted or awaiting placing and/or
compaction which, in the opinion of the SO Rep does not comply with the Specifications or has been
damaged by weather or in any other way.

5.6 HILLSIDE FILLS

Where an embankment is to be constructed on a hillside, or where the natural surface falls away at the
toe of the fill at a slope steeper than one vertical to four horizontal, cut a horizontal bench to support the
toe. The minimum width of the bench shall be equal to one third of the vertical height of the fill (measured
from the toe) provided that the width shall not be more than 3.70m nor less than 600mm. Material
excavated in benching may be used in fills, if it has satisfied the requirement of Approved Material as
afore defined.

Where embankments are to be constructed on hillsides or on the slopes of existing embankments, or


where embankments are to be constructed in part-widths, cut the existing slope, if it exceeds one
vertical to four horizontal, in the form of horizontal terrace over the full area to be covered by new fill.
As each layer of new embankment is constructed, step the existing slope in successive terraces, each
at least 600mm in width and progressively cut the terraces as the embankment is placed. Recompact
materials thus excavated as part of the new embankment material. No adjustment shall be made to
the Contract Sum for material removed in the construction of benches and terraces, which shall be
regarded as part of the earthworks in the Contract.

If, in preparing hillsides, the Contractor removes material outside the limits specified in this Clause in
order to facilitate his operations, no adjustment to the Contract Sum shall be made for the removal of
this extra material, and the Contractor shall be required to make good at his own cost and expense any
scars created by him.

CE21/S5.DOC(3)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 5-4

5.7 PLACING FILLS IN EMBANKMENTS

Construct embankments in even horizontal layers over the full width, laid in thickness appropriate to the
compaction plant used and compacted to satisfy the requirement specified in Clause 5.9 "Compaction".
At all times maintain the embankments with a sufficient camber and a surface sufficiently even to enable
surface water to drain readily from them.

If the material deposited as fill subsequently reaches a condition such that it cannot be compacted in
accordance with the requirements of the Contract, the Contractor shall be required either :

(a) make good by removing the material off the embankment either to tip or elsewhere until it is in a
suitable physical condition for re-use, and replacing it with suitable materials; or

(b) make good the material by mechanical or chemical means to improve its stability; or

(c) cease work on the material until its physical condition is again such that it can be compacted as
specified in the Contract.

Rock material shall be broken down to dimensions not exceeding the compacted thickness of the layer
in which it is placed. Rock material shall be well distributed in layers extending the full width of the fill,
and sufficient fine material shall be placed around the larger material as it is deposited to fill the voids
and produce a dense compact fill. Where insufficient fine material is present to fill the voids, additional
fine material shall be obtained from the Contractor's own sources.

Unless otherwise specified or shown in the Drawings, the top edges of embankments shall be neatly
rounded to the dimensions shown in the Drawings or as directed by the SO Rep. Such work shall be
deemed to have been included as part of the earthworks in the Contract.

5.8 FILL SLOPES

The slope faces of embankments or other fill areas shall be formed by overfilling, cutting back and
trimming neatly to the desired profile. Unless otherwise specified or shown in the Drawings, the slopes
shall conform to the following :

Table 5.2 Allowable Slopes In Cutting

Slope
Material
(Horizontal Distance To Vertical Rise)

Sand loam, soft clay and loose sand Between Two to One and 2 : 1 and
Five to One 5:1

Ordinary earth Two to One 2:1

Rock One and One-quarter to One 1¼ : 1

Rock filling - hand pitched One to One 1:1

Where the SO Rep re-determines a slope, the Contractor shall not be entitled to claim whatsoever or
to adjustment to the Contract Sum except where such re-determination of slopes by the SO Rep results
in a difference in work quantities, either addition or omission, which shall constitute a variation to the
Contract.

When completed, the average planes of the slopes of embankments shall conform to those determined
by the SO Rep or as specified in the Drawings.

CE21/S5.DOC(4)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 5-5

5.9 COMPACTION

All materials shall be compacted in layers as soon as practicable after deposition. The thickness of
each layer shall be compatible with the compaction plant used and shall be agreed by the SO Rep.

Table 5.3 may be used as a guide for the Contractor in establishing compaction arrangement. However
site trials shall be carried out to ensure that the density requirement is achieved.

The Contractor shall allow in the Contract Sum for all costs and expenses incurred in executing
compaction by whichever method he has adopted and any subsequent alteration as directed.

The various types of compaction plants, and their compacting capabilities, are shown in Table 5.3.
The definitions and requirements associated with the Table are given below :

(a) "Number of passes" shall mean the number of times that each point on the surface of the layer
being compacted has been traversed by the compaction plant (or struck in the case of power
rammers or dropping weight compactors). The effective width of a pneumatic-tyred roller, for
this purpose, is the sum of the widths of the individual wheel tracks together with the sum of the
spacing between the wheel tracks provided that each spacing does not exceed 225mm. When
the spacing exceeds 225mm the effective width shall be taken as the sum of the width of the
individual wheel tracks only.

(b) The force per 100mm width shall mean the total weight on the roll divided by the total roll width.
Where a smooth-wheeled roller has more than one axle the machine shall be assessed on the
basis of the axle giving the highest value of force per 100mm width.

(c) Wheel load shall mean the total weight of the roller divided by number of wheels.

(d) Vibratory rollers shall mean self propelled or towed rollers having means of applying mechanical
vibration to one or more rolls.

(i) The requirements for vibratory rollers shall be based on the use of the lowest gear on a
self propelled machine and a towing speed of 1800 to 2400m/hour for a towed machine.
If higher gears or speeds are used an increased number of passes shall be provided in
proportion to the increase in speed of travel.

(ii) Vibratory rollers operating without their vibration mechanism in use shall be classified as
smooth-wheeled rollers.

(iii) Vibratory rollers shall only be operated with their vibration mechanism operating at the
frequency of vibration recommended by the manufacturers. All such rollers shall be
equipped with a device automatically indicating the frequency at which the mechanism is
operating.

(e) Vibrating-plate compactors or machines having a base-plate to which is attached a source of


vibration consisting of one or two eccentrically-weighted shafts.

(i) The static pressure under the plate of a vibrating-plate compactor shall be calculated by
dividing the total weight of the machine in working order by the area in contact with
compacted material.

(ii) Vibrating-plate compactors shall be operated at the frequency of vibration recommended


by the manufacturer.

They shall normally be operated at travelling speeds of less than 900m per hour but, if
higher speeds are necessary, the number of passes shall be increased in proportion to
the increase in speed of travel.

(f) Vibro-tampers shall mean machines in which an engine-driven reciprocating mechanism acts on
a Spring system, through which oscillations are set up in a base-plate.

(g) Power rammers shall mean machines which are actuated by explosions in an internal
combustion cylinder, each explosion being controlled manually by the operator.

CE21/S5.DOC(5)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 5-6

5.9 COMPACTION (CONT'D)

The depth of compacted layer shall mean the height by which an embankment is raised by each
successive compacted layer.

Where combinations of different types of categories of compaction plant are used, the compaction
requirements shall be as follows :

(a) the depth of layer shall be that for the type of compaction plant requiring the least depth of layer;
and

(b) the number of passes shall be that for the type of compaction plant requiring the greatest number
of passes.

However, where the Contractor uses a lighter type of compaction plant to provide some preliminary
compaction only to assist the use of heavier compaction plant, this shall be disregarded in assessing
the above requirements.

CE21/S5.DOC(6)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 5-7

Table 5.3 Compaction Requirements

Well-Graded Granular Uniformly-Graded


Cohesive Soil
And Dry Cohesive Soils Materials
Type Of
Compaction Category Max depth Max depth Max depth
Min no.
Plant of Min no of of Min no of of
of
compacted passes compacted passes compacted
passes
layer layer layer
(mm) (mm) (mm)
Smooth- Force per 100mm
wheeled width in kN
roller 2.1 to 2.6 125 8 125 10 125 10*
2.61 to 5.2 125 6 125 8 125 8*
More than 5.2 150 4 150 8 Unsuitable
Grid-roller Force per 100mm
width in kN
2.6 to 5.2 150 10 Unsuitable 150 10
5.3 to 7.8 150 8 125 12 Unsuitable
More than 7.8 150 4 150 12 Unsuitable
Pneumatic Wheel Load
tyred roller in tonnes :
1 to 1.5 125 6 Unsuitable 150 10*
1.5 to 2 150 5 Unsuitable Unsuitable
2 to 2.5 175 4 125 12 Unsuitable
2.5 to 4 225 4 125 10 Unsuitable
4 to 6 300 4 125 10 Unsuitable
6 to 8 350 4 150 8 Unsuitable
8 to 12 400 4 150 8 Unsuitable
More than 12 450 4 175 6 Unsuitable

Vibratory Force per 100mm


roller width in kN

0.25 to 0.45 Unsuitable 75 16 150 16


0.46 to 0.70 Unsuitable 75 12 150 12
0.71 to 1.25 100 12 125 12 150 6
1.26 to 1.75 125 8 150 8 200 10*
1.76 to 2.3 150 4 150 4 225 12*
2.31 to 2.8 175 4 175 4 250 10*
2.81 to 3.5 200 4 200 4 275 8*
3.51 to 4.2 225 4 225 4 300 8*
4.21 to 4.9 250 4 250 4 300 8*

Vibratory Static pressure


plate under base plate
compactor in kN per mm2
8.6 to 10.3 Unsuitable Unsuitable 75 6
10.3 to 12.1 Unsuitable 75 10 100 6
12.1 to 13.8 Unsuitable 75 6 150 6
13.8 to 17.2 100 6 125 6 150 4
17.2 to 20.7 150 6 150 5 200 4
More than 20.7 200 6 200 5 250 4

Vibro- Mass Kilogramme


tamper 50 to 65 100 3 100 3 150 3
65 to 75 125 3 125 3 200 3
More than 75 200 3 150 3 225 3
Power Mass Kilogramme
rammer
100 150 4 150 6 Unsuitable
More than 500 275 8 275 12 Unsuitable

For items marked with * the rollers shall be towed by track laying tractors. Self propelled rollers are unsuitable.

SECTION 6/.....

CE21/S5.DOC(7)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 6-1

SECTION 6

LIST OF APPENDICES

Appendix

A1 RESERVED

A2 Electrical Testing & Completion Certificate

CE21/S6.DOC(1)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
CE Spec
Page 6-2

APPENDIX A2

ELECTRICAL TESTING & COMPLETION CERTIFICATE

To: The Superintending Officer's Representative


Housing & Development Board

Illuminated Signboards For


_______________________________________________________________________

__________________________________________________________________________________________
___

in the Name of : ______________________________________________________

I _____________________________________, a licensed electrical worker and authorised small


installation tester hereby certify that the abovementioned has been inspected and tested by me in accordance with
the Singapore Standard CP 5 1988: Code of Practice for Wiring of Electrical Equipment of Buildings, and that to
the best of my knowledge and belief the abovementioned complies with the Singapore Standard CP 5 1988 and
other relevant Regulations. The said has been tested on ___________________________.

Description Brand/Model/Supplier Quantity

Lamp (18 W)

Lamp (36 W)

Ballasts

Polarity Check Satisfactory : Yes/No

Approved Method of Installation : Yes/No

All Lamp Circuit Functional : Yes/No

___________________________________________ __________________________________
Signature of Electrical Worker Date

Name of PowerGrid
Electrical Worker : ____________________________ License No : _______________________

Rubber Stamp of Licensed PowerGrid


Electrical Contractor : __________________________ License No : 3/_____________________

End/...
CE21/S6.DOC(2)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
Page 1

SUMMARY OF UPDATES TO
STANDARD SPECIFICATIONS
FOR CIVIL ENGINEERING WORKS

(2021 EDITION)

DISCLAIMER

This Summary of Updates is prepared for the information of the tenderers and shall not form part of the
contract documents. This Summary Of Updates is a non-exhaustive indication of the major changes
implemented to the Standard Specifications for Civil Engineering Works (2021 Edition). Whilst every effort has
been made to ensure the accuracy of the information, HDB is not responsible for any errors or omissions
contained in this Summary Of Updates. HDB expressly disclaims all and any liability and responsibility to any
person, in respect of anything, and of consequences of anything, done or omitted to be done by any such
person in reliance, whether wholly or partially, upon the whole or part of the contents of this Summary Of
Updates.

CE21/SOU.DOCX(1)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)
Page 2

Summary of Updates To
Standard Specifications for Civil Engineering Works (2021 Edition)

Section No./
S/N Title Changes
Clause No.

New clause on the computation of


EOT in calendar days to be added
1 1.1.50 Extension of Time in CE Standard Specification.
Whereby all EOTs, including EIW,
to be in Calendar Days.

Assessment Of Extension Of Time Update on the average number of


2 1.1.51 Due To Exceptionally Inclement “wet days” for the period from Jan
Weather 2010 to Dec 2019.

To remove Appendix A1 -
Insurance for Work Injury
3 1.1.52 Instruction on Work Injury
Compensation
Compensation Policy

Approval For Use of Ready-Mix


4 1.2.6 Minor updating.
Concrete

To include requirement of Stability


5 1.4 Construction Equipment
Control System for all lorry crane

6 2.46 Premix and Ready-Mix Concrete Minor updating.

7 3.17 Interlocking Concrete Paving Blocks Minor updating.

CE21/SOU.DOCX(2)
OYM(040121)
(DPG)

You might also like

pFad - Phonifier reborn

Pfad - The Proxy pFad of © 2024 Garber Painting. All rights reserved.

Note: This service is not intended for secure transactions such as banking, social media, email, or purchasing. Use at your own risk. We assume no liability whatsoever for broken pages.


Alternative Proxies:

Alternative Proxy

pFad Proxy

pFad v3 Proxy

pFad v4 Proxy